Yamaha HTR 6180 Owner's Manual U

User Manual: Yamaha HTR-6180 Owner's Manual

Open the PDF directly: View PDF PDF.
Page Count: 152

DownloadYamaha  HTR-6180 Owner's Manual U
Open PDF In BrowserView PDF
HTR-6180_U-cv.fm Page 1 Monday, December 10, 2007 1:32 PM

U

HTR-6180

HTR-6180
AV Receiver

© 2008
YAMAHA ELECTRONICS CORPORATION, USA 6660 ORANGETHORPE AVE., BUENA PARK, CALIF. 90620, U.S.A.
YAMAHA CANADA MUSIC LTD. 135 MILNER AVE., SCARBOROUGH, ONTARIO M1S 3R1, CANADA
YAMAHA ELECTRONIK EUROPA G.m.b.H. SIEMENSSTR. 22-34, 25462 RELLINGEN BEI HAMBURG, GERMANY
YAMAHA ELECTRONIQUE FRANCE S.A. RUE AMBROISE CROIZAT BP70 CROISSY-BEAUBOURG 77312 MARNE-LA-VALLEE CEDEX02, FRANCE
YAMAHA ELECTRONICS (UK) LTD. YAMAHA HOUSE, 200 RICKMANSWORTH ROAD WATFORD, HERTS WD18 7GQ, ENGLAND
YAMAHA SCANDINAVIA A.B. J A WETTERGRENS GATA 1, BOX 30053, 400 43 VÄSTRA FRÖLUNDA, SWEDEN
YAMAHA MUSIC AUSTRALIA PTY, LTD. 17-33 MARKET ST., SOUTH MELBOURNE, 3205 VIC., AUSTRALIA

Black process 45.0° 240.0 LPI

All rights reserved.

OWNER’S MANUAL
Printed in Malaysia

WN24840

IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS

IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
10
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN

CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF
ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE
COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE
PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO
QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.

•

Explanation of Graphical Symbols

The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an
equilateral triangle, is intended to alert you to the
presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within
the product’s enclosure that may be of sufficient
magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to
persons.
The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle
is intended to alert you to the presence of important
operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in
the literature accompanying the appliance.

1
2
3
4
5
6
7

8

9

Read Instructions – All the safety and operating instructions
should be read before the product is operated.
Retain Instructions – The safety and operating instructions
should be retained for future reference.
Heed Warnings – All warnings on the product and in the
operating instructions should be adhered to.
Follow Instructions – All operating and use instructions
should be followed.
Cleaning – Unplug this product from the wall outlet before
cleaning. Do not use liquid cleaners or aerosol cleaners.
Attachments – Do not use attachments not recommended by
the product manufacturer as they may cause hazards.
Water and Moisture – Do not use this product near water –
for example, near a bath tub, wash bowl, kitchen sink, or
laundry tub; in a wet basement; or near a swimming pool;
and the like.
Accessories – Do not place this product on an unstable cart,
stand, tripod, bracket, or table. The product may fall,
causing serious injury to a child or adult, and serious
damage to the product. Use only with a cart, stand, tripod,
bracket, or table recommended by the manufacturer, or sold
with the product. Any mounting of the product should
follow the manufacturer’s instructions, and should use a
mounting accessory recommended by the manufacturer.
A product and cart combination should be moved with care.
Quick stops, excessive force, and uneven surfaces may
cause the product and cart combination to
overturn.

Caution-i En

11

12

13

14

15

16

17

18

19

Ventilation – Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided
for ventilation and to ensure reliable operation of the
product and to protect it from overheating, and these
openings must not be blocked or covered. The openings
should never be blocked by placing the product on a bed,
sofa, rug, or other similar surface. This product should not
be placed in a built-in installation such as a bookcase or rack
unless proper ventilation is provided or the manufacturer’s
instructions have been adhered to.
Power Sources – This product should be operated only from
the type of power source indicated on the marking label. If
you are not sure of the type of power supply to your home,
consult your product dealer or local power company. For
products intended to operate from battery power, or other
sources, refer to the operating instructions.
Grounding or Polarization – This product may be equipped
with a polarized alternating current line plug (a plug having
one blade wider than the other). This plug will fit into the
power outlet only one way. This is a safety feature. If you
are unable to insert the plug fully into the outlet, try
reversing the plug. If the plug should still fail to fit, contact
your electrician to replace your obsolete outlet. Do not
defeat the safety purpose of the polarized plug.
Power-Cord Protection – Power-supply cords should be
routed so that they are not likely to be walked on or pinched
by items placed upon or against them, paying particular
attention to cords at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the
point where they exit from the product.
Lightning – For added protection for this product during a
lightning storm, or when it is left unattended and unused for
long periods of time, unplug it from the wall outlet and
disconnect the antenna or cable system. This will prevent
damage to the product due to lightning and power-line
surges.
Power Lines – An outside antenna system should not be
located in the vicinity of overhead power lines or other
electric light or power circuits, or where it can fall into such
power lines or circuits. When installing an outside antenna
system, extreme care should be taken to keep from touching
such power lines or circuits as contact with them might be
fatal.
Overloading – Do not overload wall outlets, extension
cords, or integral convenience receptacles as this can result
in a risk of fire or electric shock.
Object and Liquid Entry – Never push objects of any kind
into this product through openings as they may touch
dangerous voltage points or short-out parts that could result
in a fire or electric shock. Never spill liquid of any kind on
the product.
Servicing – Do not attempt to service this product yourself
as opening or removing covers may expose you to
dangerous voltage or other hazards. Refer all servicing to
qualified service personnel.
Damage Requiring Service – Unplug this product from the
wall outlet and refer servicing to qualified service personnel
under the following conditions:
a) When the power-supply cord or plug is damaged,
b) If liquid has been spilled, or objects have fallen into the
product,
c) If the product has been exposed to rain or water,

IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS

d)

20

21

22

23

If the product does not operate normally by following
the operating instructions. Adjust only those controls
that are covered by the operating instructions as an
improper adjustment of other controls may result in
damage and will often require extensive work by a
qualified technician to restore the product to its normal
operation,
e) If the product has been dropped or damaged in any
way, and
f)
When the product exhibits a distinct change in performance - this indicates a need for service.
Replacement Parts – When replacement parts are required,
be sure the service technician has used replacement parts
specified by the manufacturer or have the same
characteristics as the original part. Unauthorized
substitutions may result in fire, electric shock, or other
hazards.
Safety Check – Upon completion of any service or repairs to
this product, ask the service technician to perform safety
checks to determine that the product is in proper operating
condition.
Wall or Ceiling Mounting – The unit should be mounted
to a wall or ceiling only as recommended by the
manufacturer.
Heat – The product should be situated away from heat
sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other
products (including amplifiers) that produce heat.

24

Outdoor Antenna Grounding – If an outside antenna or
cable system is connected to the product, be sure the antenna
or cable system is grounded so as to provide some
protection against voltage surges and built-up static charges.
Article 810 of the National Electrical Code, ANSI/NFPA 70,
provides information with regard to proper grounding of the
mast and supporting structure, grounding of the lead-in wire
to an antenna discharge unit, size of grounding conductors,
location of antenna discharge unit, connection to grounding
electrodes, and requirements for the grounding electrode.
EXAMPLE OF ANTENNA GROUNDING

MAST

ANTENNA
LEAD IN
WIRE

GROUND
CLAMP

ANTENNA
DISCHARGE UNIT
(NEC SECTION 810–20)

ELECTRIC
SERVICE
EQUIPMENT

GROUNDING CONDUCTORS
(NEC SECTION 810–21)
GROUND CLAMPS

Note to CATV system installer:
This reminder is provided to call the CATV system
installer’s attention to Article 820-40 of the NEC that
provides guidelines for proper grounding and, in
particular, specifies that the cable ground shall be
connected to the grounding system of the building, as
close to the point of cable entry as practical.

POWER SERVICE GROUNDING
ELECTRODE SYSTEM
(NEC ART 250. PART H)

NEC – NATIONAL ELECTRICAL CODE

FCC INFORMATION (for US customers)
1 IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS
UNIT!
This product, when installed as indicated in the
instructions contained in this manual, meets FCC
requirements. Modifications not expressly approved by
Yamaha may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to
use the product.
2 IMPORTANT: When connecting this product to
accessories and/or another product use only high quality
shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this product MUST
be used. Follow all installation instructions. Failure to
follow instructions could void your FCC authorization to
use this product in the USA.
3 NOTE: This product has been tested and found to comply
with the requirements listed in FCC Regulations, Part 15
for Class “B” digital devices. Compliance with these
requirements provides a reasonable level of assurance that
your use of this product in a residential environment will
not result in harmful interference with other electronic
devices.
This equipment generates/uses radio frequencies and, if
not installed and used according to the instructions found
in the users manual, may cause interference harmful to the
operation of other electronic devices.

Compliance with FCC regulations does not guarantee that
interference will not occur in all installations. If this
product is found to be the source of interference, which
can be determined by turning the unit “OFF” and “ON”,
please try to eliminate the problem by using one of the
following measures:
Relocate either this product or the device that is being
affected by the interference.
Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit
breaker or fuse) circuits or install AC line filter/s.
In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient
the antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon lead,
change the lead-in to coaxial type cable.
If these corrective measures do not produce satisfactory
results, please contact the local retailer authorized to
distribute this type of product. If you can not locate the
appropriate retailer, please contact Yamaha Electronics
Corp., U.S.A. 6660 Orangethorpe Ave., Buena Park, CA
90620.
The above statements apply ONLY to those products
distributed by Yamaha Corporation of America or its
subsidiaries.

Caution-ii En

CAUTION: READ THIS BEFORE OPERATING YOUR UNIT.

Caution: Read this before operating your unit.
1 To assure the finest performance, please read this manual
carefully. Keep it in a safe place for future reference.
2 Install this sound system in a well ventilated, cool, dry, clean
place – away from direct sunlight, heat sources, vibration,
dust, moisture, and/or cold. Allow ventilation space of at least
30 cm on the top, 20 cm on the left and right, and 20 cm on
the back of this unit.
3 Locate this unit away from other electrical appliances, motors,
or transformers to avoid humming sounds.
4 Do not expose this unit to sudden temperature changes from
cold to hot, and do not locate this unit in an environment with
high humidity (i.e. a room with a humidifier) to prevent
condensation inside this unit, which may cause an electrical
shock, fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
5 Avoid installing this unit where foreign objects may fall onto
this unit and/or this unit may be exposed to liquid dripping or
splashing. On the top of this unit, do not place:
– other components, as they may cause damage and/or
discoloration on the surface of this unit.
– burning objects (i.e. candles), as they may cause fire,
damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
– containers with liquid in them, as they may fall and liquid
may cause electrical shock to the user and/or damage to
this unit.
6 Do not cover this unit with a newspaper, tablecloth, curtain,
etc. in order not to obstruct heat radiation. If the temperature
inside this unit rises, it may cause fire, damage to this unit,
and/or personal injury.
7 Do not plug in this unit to a wall outlet until all connections
are complete.
8 Do not operate this unit upside-down. It may overheat,
possibly causing damage.
9 Do not use force on switches, knobs and/or cords.
10 When disconnecting the power cable from the wall outlet,
grasp the plug; do not pull the cable.
11 Do not clean this unit with chemical solvents; this might
damage the finish. Use a clean, dry cloth.
12 Only voltage specified on this unit must be used. Using this
unit with a higher voltage than specified is dangerous and may
cause fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury. Yamaha
will not be held responsible for any damage resulting from use
of this unit with a voltage other than specified.
13 To prevent damage by lightning, keep the power cord and
outdoor antennas disconnected from a wall outlet or the unit
during a lightning storm.
14 Do not attempt to modify or fix this unit. Contact qualified
Yamaha service personnel when any service is needed. The
cabinet should never be opened for any reasons.

Caution-iii En

15 When not planning to use this unit for long periods of time
(i.e. vacation), disconnect the AC power plug from the wall
outlet.
16 Install this unit near the AC outlet and where the AC power
plug can be reached easily.
17 Be sure to read the “Troubleshooting” section on common
operating errors before concluding that this unit is faulty.
18 Before moving this unit, press L SYSTEM OFF to set this
unit to the standby mode, and then disconnect the AC power
plug from the AC wall outlet.
19 The batteries shall not be exposed to excessive heat such as
sunshine, fire or like.
20 Excessive sound pressure from earphones and headphones can
cause hearing loss.

WARNING
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC
SHOCK, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS UNIT TO RAIN
OR MOISTURE.
As long as this unit is connected to the AC wall outlet,
it is not disconnected from the AC power source even
if you turn off this unit by L SYSTEM OFF. In this
state, this unit is designed to consume a very small
quantity of power.
FOR CANADIAN CUSTOMERS
To prevent electric shock, match wide blade of plug to
wide slot and fully insert.
This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian
ICES-003.
POUR LES CONSOMMATEURS CANADIENS
Pour éviter les chocs électriques, introduire la lame la
plus large de la fiche dans la borne correspondante de
la prise et pousser jusqu’au fond.
Cet appareil numérique de la classe B est conforme à
la norme NMB-003 du Canada.
IMPORTANT
Please record the serial number of this unit in the space
below.
MODEL:
Serial No.:
The serial number is located on the rear of the unit.
Retain this Owner’s Manual in a safe place for future
reference.

Contents
Features ................................................................... 2
Supplied accessories .................................................. 2

Notice ....................................................................... 3
Getting started ........................................................ 4
Quick start guide .................................................... 5

Connections ........................................................... 10
Optimizing the speaker setting for your listening
room (YPAO) .................................................... 32
Using AUTO SETUP .............................................. 32

BASIC OPERATION
Selecting the SCENE templates........................... 37

Playback ................................................................ 42

Selecting sound field programs ............................... 48
Sound field program descriptions............................ 48
Enjoying unprocessed input sources
(Straight decoding mode) .................................... 51

Using audio features ............................................. 52
Adjusting the speaker level...................................... 52
Enjoying pure hi-fi sound ........................................ 52
Adjusting the tonal quality....................................... 52

FM/AM tuning ...................................................... 53

Using HD Radio™ features
(U.S.A. model only)........................................... 57
Selecting HD Radio™ audio programs ................... 57
Displaying HD Radio™ information....................... 58

XM Satellite Radio tuning ................................... 59

ADVANCED OPERATION
Advanced sound configurations...........................74
Changing sound field parameter settings................. 74
Selecting decoders ................................................... 79

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP).........82
Using SET MENU................................................... 86
1 BASIC MENU...................................................... 87
2 VOLUME MENU ................................................ 91
3 SOUND MENU.................................................... 92
4 INPUT MENU...................................................... 95
5 OPTION MENU................................................... 98

Remote control features......................................102
Controlling this unit, a TV,
or other components .......................................... 102
Setting remote control codes ................................. 104
Resetting all remote control codes......................... 105

Using multi-zone configuration..........................106
Connecting Zone 2................................................. 106
Controlling Zone 2................................................. 107

Advanced setup....................................................109
Using the advanced setup ...................................... 109

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
Troubleshooting...................................................113
Resetting the system............................................122
Glossary................................................................123
Sound field program information......................126
Specifications .......................................................127
Index .....................................................................129

APPENDIX
(at the end of this manual)
Front panel................................................................i
Remote control ....................................................... ii
List of remote control codes ................................. iii
“ASPEAKERS” or “4DVD” (example) indicates the name
of the parts on the front panel or the remote control. Refer to
the attached sheet or the pages at the end of this manual for
the information about each position of the parts.

1 En

English

Connecting the XM Mini-Tuner Dock .................... 59
Activating XM Satellite Radio ................................ 60
Basic XM Satellite Radio operations....................... 60
Setting the XM Satellite Radio
preset channels .................................................... 62
Displaying the XM Satellite Radio
information .......................................................... 63

Recording ...............................................................73

APPENDIX

Overview.................................................................. 53
Basic tuning operations............................................ 53
Using station preset feature ..................................... 54

Pairing the Bluetooth™ adapter and your Bluetooth
component ........................................................... 72
Playback of the Bluetooth™ component ................. 72

ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION

Sound field programs .......................................... 48

Controlling iPod™................................................... 70

Using Bluetooth™ components............................72

ADVANCED
OPERATION

Basic procedure ....................................................... 42
Selecting the MULTI CH INPUT component......... 43
Selecting the front speaker set ................................. 43
Selecting audio input jacks (AUDIO SELECT)...... 44
Displaying the current status of this unit on a video
monitor ................................................................ 44
Using your headphones............................................ 45
Muting the audio output........................................... 45
Playing video sources in the background
of an audio source................................................ 45
Displaying the input source information ................. 46
Using the sleep timer ............................................... 47

Using iPod™ ..........................................................70

BASIC
OPERATION

Selecting the desired SCENE template
to the SCENE buttons.......................................... 37
Creating your original SCENE templates................ 40
Using the remote control
for the SCENE feature......................................... 41

Connecting the SiriusConnect™ tuner .................... 64
Activating SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ subscription.......... 65
Basic SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ operations ............ 65
Setting the SIRIUS Satellite Radio™
preset channels .................................................... 67
Setting the Parental Lock......................................... 67
Displaying the SIRIUS Satellite Radio™
information .......................................................... 69

PREPARATION

PREPARATION

SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ tuning .........................64

INTRODUCTION

INTRODUCTION

FEATURES

Features
Built-in 7-channel power amplifier

HDMI™ (High-Definition Multimedia Interface)

◆ Minimum RMS output power
(1 kHz, 0.7% THD, 8 Ω)
Front: 120 W + 120 W
Center: 120 W
Surround: 120 W + 120 W
Surround back: 120 W + 120 W

◆ HDMI interface for standard, enhanced or
high-definition video as well as multi-channel digital audio
based on HDMI version 1.3a (HDMI is licensed by HDMI
Licensing, LLC.)
– Automatic audio and video synchronization (lip sync)
information capability
– Deep Color video signal (30/36 bit) transmission capability
– “x.v.Color” video signal transmission capability
– High refresh rate and high resolution video signals
capability
– High definition digital audio format signals capability
◆ HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection System)
licensed by Digital Content Protection, LLC.
◆ Analog video to HDMI digital video up-conversion
(composite video ↔ S-video ↔ component video → HDMI
digital video) capability for monitor out
◆ Analog video up-scaling from 480i (NTSC)/576i (PAL) or
480p/576p to 720p, 1080i or 1080p

SCENE function
◆ Preset SCENE templates for various situations
◆ SCENE templates for customizing capability
◆ Controlling Yamaha SCENE control signal support
component (some models only) working with the SCENE
function

Sound field programs
◆ Proprietary Yamaha technology for the creation of sound
fields
◆ Compressed Music Enhancer mode
◆ Virtual CINEMA DSP
◆ SILENT CINEMA

Digital audio decoders
◆ Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus decoder
◆ DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
decoder
◆ Dolby Digital/Dolby Digital EX decoder
◆ DTS/DTS-ES Matrix 6.1, Discrete 6.1, DTS 96/24 decoder
◆ Dolby Pro Logic/Dolby Pro Logic II/Dolby Pro Logic IIx
decoder
◆ Neural Surround decoder
◆ SRS CS II decoder (U.S.A. model only)

Radio tuners
◆ FM/AM tuning capability
◆ HD Radio™ digital broadcast reception capability (U.S.A.
model only)
◆ XM Satellite Radio tuning capability (using XM Mini-Tuner
and Home Dock, sold separately)
◆ SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ tuning capability (using
SiriusConnect tuner, sold separately)

DOCK terminal
◆ DOCK terminal to connect a Yamaha iPod universal dock
(such as YDS-10, sold separately) or Bluetooth adapter (such
as YBA-10, sold separately)

Other features
◆ YPAO (Yamaha Parametric Room Acoustic Optimizer) for
automatic speaker setup
◆ 192-kHz/24-bit D/A converter
◆ OSD (on-screen display) menus that allow you to optimize
this unit to suit your individual audiovisual system
◆ 5.1 or 7.1-channel additional input jacks for discrete multichannel input
◆ Component video input/output capability includes
(3 COMPONENT VIDEO INs and 1 MONITOR OUT)
◆ Digital video signal conversion (composite video ↔ S-video
↔ component video) capability for monitor out
◆ Pure Direct mode for pure hi-fi sound for all sources
◆ Adaptive dynamic range controlling capability
◆ Adaptive DSP effect level controlling capability
◆ iPod controlling capability
◆ Remote control with preset remote control codes capability
◆ Zone 2 custom installation facility
◆ Bi-amplification connection capability
◆ Sleep timer

Supplied accessories
Check that you received all of the following parts.
❏ Remote control
❏ Batteries (2) (AA, R6, UM-3)
❏ Optimizer microphone

2 En

❏ AM loop antenna
❏ Indoor FM antenna

Notice

Notice
• y indicates a tip for your operation.
• Some operations can be performed by using either the
buttons on the front panel or the ones on the remote
control. In case the button names differ between the front
panel and the remote control, the button name on the
remote control is given in parentheses.
• This manual is printed prior to production. Design and
specifications are subject to change in part as a result of
improvements, etc. In case of differences between the
manual and product, the product has priority.
• “ASPEAKERS” or “4DVD” (example) indicates the
name of the parts on the front panel or the remote control.
Refer to the attached sheet or the pages at the end of this
manual for the information about each position of the
parts.
• The symbol “☞ ” with page number(s) indicates the
corresponding reference page(s).

We Want You Listening For A Lifetime
Yamaha and the Electronic Industries Association’s
Consumer Electronics Group want you to get the
most out of your equipment by playing it at a safe
level. One that lets the sound come through loud and
clear without annoying blaring or distortion – and,
most importantly, without affecting your sensitive
hearing. Since hearing damage from loud sounds is often
undetectable until it is too late, Yamaha and the Electronic
Industries Association’s Consumer Electronics Group
recommend you to avoid prolonged exposure from excessive
volume levels.

Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.
“Dolby”, “Pro Logic”, and the double-D symbol are trademarks
of Dolby Laboratories.

Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent No’s:
5,451,942;5,956,674;5,974,380;5,978,762;6,226,616;6,487,535
& other U.S. and worldwide patents issued & pending. DTS is a
registered trademark and the DTS logos, Symbol, DTS-HD and
DTS-HD Master Audio are trademark of DTS, Inc. © 1996-2007
DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved.

iPod™
“iPod” is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and
other countries.

Bluetooth™
Bluetooth is a registered trademark of the Bluetooth SIG and is
used by Yamaha in accordance with a license agreement.

INTRODUCTION

About this manual

“HDMI”, the “HDMI” logo and “High-Definition Multimedia
Interface” are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI
Licensing LLC.

x.v.Color™
“x.v.Color” is a trademark of Sony Corporation.

“SILENT CINEMA” is a trademark of Yamaha Corporation.

The XM name and related logos are registered trademarks of XM
Satellite Radio Inc.

Neural Surround™ name and related logos are trademarks owned
by Neural Audio Corporation.

©2006 SIRIUS Satellite Radio Inc. “SIRIUS”, “SiriusConnect”,
the SIRIUS dog logo, channel names and logos are trademarks of
SIRIUS Satellite Radio Inc.

HD Radio™ Technology Manufactured Under License From
iBiquity Digital Corp. U.S. and Foreign Patents. HD Radio™ and
the HD Radio logo are proprietary trademarks of iBiquity Digital
Corp.

Circle Surround II, Dialog Clarity, TruBass, SRS and the
symbol are trademarks of SRS Labs, Inc.
Circle Surround II, Dialog Clarity and TruBass technologies are
incorporated under license from SRS Labs, Inc.

English

3 En

GETTING STARTED

Getting started
■ Installing batteries in the remote control

1

3

2

1

Take off the battery compartment cover.

2

Insert the two supplied batteries
(AA, R6, UM-3) according to the polarity
markings (+ and –) on the inside of the
battery compartment.

3

Snap the battery compartment cover back
into place.

Notes
• Change all of the batteries if you notice the following
conditions:
– the operation range of the remote control decreases.
– the BTRANSMIT indicator does not flash or its light
becomes dim.
• Do not use an old battery together with a new one.
• Do not use different types of batteries (such as alkaline and
manganese batteries) together. Read the packaging carefully as
these different types of batteries may have the same shape and
color.
• If the batteries have leaked, dispose of them immediately. Avoid
touching the leaked material or letting it come into contact with
clothing, etc. Clean the battery compartment thoroughly before
installing new batteries.
• Do not throw away batteries with general house waste; dispose
of them correctly in accordance with your local regulations.
• If the remote control is without batteries for more than 2
minutes, or if exhausted batteries remain in the remote control,
the contents of the memory may be cleared. When the memory
is cleared, insert new batteries, set up the remote control code
and program any acquired functions that may have been
cleared.

4 En

Quick start guide

Quick start guide

Video monitor

Front right
speaker

Front left
speaker

Preparation: Check the items
Subwoofer
Surround right
speaker

Center
speaker

Surround back
right speaker

DVD player

Prepare the following items.
❏ Speakers
❏ Front speakers ................................... x 2
❏ Center speaker .................................. x 1
❏ Surround speakers ............................ x 4
Select magnetically shielded speakers. The
minimum required speakers are two front speakers.
The priority of the requirement of other speakers is
as follows:

Surround back left
speaker

1. Two surround speakers
2. Center speaker
3. One (or two) surround back speaker(s)

Surround left
speaker

Step 1: Set up your speakers

☞ P. 6

Step 2: Connect your DVD player
and other components

☞ P. 7

INTRODUCTION

The following steps describe the easiest way to enjoy DVD movie playback in your home theater. See pages 11 to 15 for
details of the speaker placement.

❏ Active subwoofer ................................... x 1
Select an active subwoofer equipped with an RCA
input jack.
❏ Speaker cables ....................................... x 7
❏ Subwoofer cable .................................... x 1
Select a monaural RCA cable.
❏ DVD player .............................................. x 1
Select DVD player equipped with coaxial digital
audio output jack and composite video output
jack.
❏ Video monitor ......................................... x 1
Select a TV monitor, video monitor or projector
equipped with a composite video input jack.
❏ Video cable ............................................. x 2
Select an RCA composite video cable.
❏ Digital coaxial audio cable .................... x 1
y

Step 3: Press SCENE 1 button

You can also connect two subwoofers to this unit. In this
case, prepare two active subwoofers and subwoofer cables.

☞ P. 8

English

Enjoy DVD playback!

5 En

Quick start guide

Be sure to connect the left channel (L), right channel
(R), “+” (red) and “–” (black) properly.

Step 1: Set up your speakers

Front speakers and center speaker

Place your speakers in the room and connect them to this
unit.
PRE OUT SUBWOOFER 1 jack
AUDIO

MULTI CH INPUT
FRONT (8CH)
CENTER

PRE OUT
SINGLE

DOCK

CENTER

Loosen

Insert

Tighten

VIDEO

VIDEO

L

GND R
PHONO

CD

IN
MD/ OUT
(PLAY) CD-R (REC)

DVD

IN

DTV/CBL

DVR

OUT

IN

VCR

OUT

SUB
SB (8CH) SURROUND WOOFER
HDMI

ZONE 2
OUT

FRONT

SURROUND

SUR. BACK

1

2

SUBWOOFER

S VIDEO
DTV/CBL
DVD

PR

MD/CD-R MD/CD-R

1
SIRIUS

XM

2

DVD

DTV/CBL

CD

DVD

3

4

5

6

OPTICAL

DIGITAL
OUTPUT

DVD
IN1

COAXIAL

DIGITAL INPUT

IN2

DVR

FRONT A
R

SURROUND
R

SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP
L

R

OUT

OUT

MONITOR

C

DVR

SWITCHED

120V 80Hz
100W MAX. TOTAL
0.8A MAX. TOTAL

GND AM
HD Radio
ANTENNA

REMOTE

IN

AC OUTLETS

L

FM
75Ω UNBAL.

IN

OUT

DVR
VCR
OUT
COMPONENT VIDEO
DTV/CBL
B PB
Y
Y
PR

MONITOR OUT

CENTER
L

IN

DVD

A PB

OUT

IN3

SPEAKERS

FRONT B/ZONE B/
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
R EXTRA SP L

DTV/CBL

TRIGGER
OUT

+12V
15mA MAX.

SINGLE

(U.S.A. model)
Speaker terminals

1

Place your speakers and subwoofer in the
room.

To the front right
speaker

To the center speaker
To the front left
speaker

2

Connect speaker cables to each speaker.
Surround and surround back speakers

Be sure to connect the “+” (red) and “–” (black) properly.
Cables are colored or shaped differently, perhaps with a
stripe, groove or ridge. Connect the striped (grooved, etc.)
cable to the “+” (red) terminals of this unit and your speaker.
Connect the plain cable to the “–” (black) terminals.

3

To the surround
back left speaker

To the surround
right speaker

To the surround
left speaker

4

Connect each speaker cable to the
corresponding speaker terminal of this unit.

To the surround
back right speaker

Connect the subwoofer cable to the
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT 1 jack of this unit
and the input jack of the subwoofer.
Subwoofer

1

2

3

4

AV receiver
DOCK
PRE OUT
SINGLE

1

RROUND

1 Make sure that this unit and the subwoofer are
unplugged from the AC wall outlets.
2 Twist the exposed wires of the speaker cables
together to prevent short circuits.
3 Do not let the bare speaker wires touch each
other.
4 Do not let the bare speaker wires touch any
metal part of this unit.

6 En

SUR. BACK

VIDE

CENTER

2

S VID
DVD

SUBWOOFER

Input jack
Subwoofer cable

SUBWOOFER PRE
OUT 1 jack

y
You can also connect another subwoofer to the SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT 2 jack.

Quick start guide

Step 2: Connect your DVD player
and other components

3

VIDEO MONITOR OUT jack

AV receiver

Video monitor
DVD DIGITAL INPUT COAXIAL jack

DVD VIDEO jack
VIDEO

AUDIO

MULTI CH INPUT
FRONT (8CH)
CENTER

PRE OUT
SINGLE

DOCK

CENTER

VIDEO

VIDEO

L

GND R
PHONO

CD

IN
MD/ OUT
(PLAY) CD-R (REC)

IN

DTV/CBL

DVD

DVR

OUT

IN

VCR

OUT

SUB
SB (8CH) SURROUND WOOFER
HDMI

ZONE 2
OUT

SURROUND

FRONT

1

SUR. BACK

S VIDEO
DTV/CBL
DVD

2

SUBWOOFER

PR

IN

OUT

DVD

A PB

IN

OUT

MONITOR

DVR
VCR
OUT
COMPONENT VIDEO
DTV/CBL
B PB
Y
Y
PR

1
SIRIUS

XM

2

DIGITAL
OUTPUT

DVD

DTV/CBL

CD

3

4

5

OPTICAL

DVD

6
COAXIAL

DIGITAL INPUT

DTV/CBL

DVR

IN1

IN2

IN3

OUT

DVD

SPEAKERS

FRONT B/ZONE B/
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
R EXTRA SP L

DVD

FRONT A
R

SURROUND
R

SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP
L

SWITCHED

120V 80Hz
100W MAX. TOTAL
0.8A MAX. TOTAL

GND AM
HD Radio
ANTENNA

REMOTE

OUT

PB

DVR

MONITOR

OUT
OUT
VCR
DVR
VIDEO DTV/CBL
COMPONENT
Y
B PB
PR
Y

AC OUTLETS

L

R

FM
75Ω UNBAL.

IN

C

MONITOR OUT

CENTER
L

OUT

IN

IN
MD/CD-R MD/CD-R

INTRODUCTION

Connect the video cable to the VIDEO
MONITOR OUT jack of this unit and the video
input jack of your video monitor.

C

TRIGGER
OUT

+12V
15mA MAX.

DVR

SINGLE

Video input jack
Video cable

(U.S.A. model)

Make sure that this unit and the DVD
player are unplugged from the AC
wall outlets.

4

VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
jack

Connect the power plug of this unit and other
components into the AC wall outlet.
y
This unit is equipped with AC OUTLETS for the power
supply of the other components. See page 28 for details.

1

Connect the digital coaxial audio cable to the
digital coaxial audio output jack of your DVD
player and the DVD DIGITAL INPUT COAXIAL
jack of this unit.
AV receiver
DVD player

M
FRONT (8CH
AUDIO

DVD

3

DVR

DTV/CBL

DVD

IN1

COAXIAL

SPEAKERS

OPTICAL

DIGITAL INPUT
E B/
FRONT B/ZON
E
ZONE 2/PRESENC
R EXTRA SP

FRONT A
R

L

CENTER

SU

DVD DIGITAL
INPUT COAXIAL
jack

Connect the video cable to the composite
video output jack of your DVD player and
DVD VIDEO jack of this unit.
AV receiver
VIDEO

S VIDEO
DTV/CBL
DVD

PR

• Connecting a DVD player via various ways of the
connection
☞ P. 21
• Connecting a DVD recorder or a digital video
recorder
☞ P. 22

OUT

IN

☞ P. 22

• Connecting a CD player, an MD recorder or a
turntable
☞ P. 23
• Connecting an external amplifier

☞ P. 24

• Connecting a DVD player via analog multi-channel
audio connection
☞ P. 25
• Connecting a Yamaha iPod universal dock or
Bluetooth adapter
☞ P. 25
• Using the REMOTE IN/OUT jacks

☞ P. 26

• Using the VIDEO AUX jacks on the front panel
☞ P. 26

VIDEO
DOCK

• Connecting a video monitor via various ways of the
connection
☞ P. 20

• Connecting a set-top box

Digital coaxial audio
cable

DVD player

• Using the other kind of speaker combinations
☞ P. 11

R

L

Digital coaxial
audio output
jack

2

SB (8CH

DVD

6

5

4

OUT

VCR

DVD

CD

DTV/CBL

IN

OUT

IN

D/ OUT
D-R (REC)

■ For further connections

DVR
V
COMPONENT
DVD
PR
Y

• Connecting a FM/AM antenna

☞ P. 27

• Connecting the XM Mini-Tuner Dock

☞ P. 59

• Connecting the SiriusConnect tuner

☞ P. 64

A PB

OUT

DVD VIDEO jack

English

Composite
video output
jack

Video cable

7 En

Quick start guide

Step 3: Press SCENE 1 button
Check the type of the connected speakers.
If the speakers are 6 ohm speakers, set “SP IMP.” to
“6Ω MIN” before using this unit (see page 28). 4 ohm
speakers can be also used as the front speakers (see
page 109).

1

2

Turn on the video monitor and then set the
input source selector of the video monitor to
this unit.

■ About SCENE function
Just by pressing one SCENE button, you can turn on this
unit and recall your favorite input source and sound field
program according to the SCENE template that has been
assigned to the SCENE button. The SCENE templates are
built combinations of input sources and sound field
programs.
y
If you connect a Yamaha product that has capability of the
SCENE control signals, this unit can automatically activate the
component and start playback. Refer to the instruction manual of
the DVD player for further information.

■ The default assigned SCENE templates

Press SSCENE1 button.
This unit is turned on. “DVD Viewing” appears in the
front panel display, and this unit automatically
optimize own status for the DVD playback.

y
The indicator on the selected SCENE button lights up while
this unit is in the SCENE mode.

3

Start playback of the desired DVD on your
player.

4

Rotate JVOLUME to adjust the volume.

Default
SCENE
button

The name of the SCENE template
and its description

SCENE
1

DVD Viewing
– input source: DVD
– sound field program: Straight
For when you want to listen to a music disc from
the connected DVD player as the background
music for this room.

SCENE
2

Disc Listening
– input source: DVD
– sound field program: 7ch Stereo
For when you want to listen to a music disc from
the connected DVD player as the background
music for this room.

SCENE
3

TV Viewing *1
– input source: DTV/CBL
– sound field program: Straight
For when you want to watch a TV program.

SCENE
4

Radio Listening *2, *3, *4
– input source: TUNER
– sound field program: 7ch Enhancer
For when you want to listen to a music program
from the FM radio station.

Notes
*1

You must connect a cable TV or a satellite tuner to this unit in
advance. See page 22 for details.
*2 You need to connect the supplied FM and AM antennas to this
unit in advance. See page 27 for details.
*3 You must tune into the desired radio station in advance. See
pages 53 to 56 for tuning information.
*4 To achieve the best possible reception, orient the connected
AM loop antenna, or adjust the position of the end of the
indoor FM antenna.

y
You can change the assigned SCENE template for the SCENE
buttons. See page 37 for details.

Note
When you change the input source or sound field program,
the SCENE mode is deactivated.

8 En

Quick start guide

■ After using this unit...

■ Customizing the SCENE templates
☞ P. 37

• Using various SCENE templates
• Creating your original SCENE templates

☞ P. 40

INTRODUCTION

Press KMAIN ZONE ON/OFF to set this unit to
the standby mode.

What do you want to do with this
unit?

■ Using various input sources
• Basic controls of this unit

☞ P. 42

• Enjoying FM/AM radio programs

☞ P. 53

• Enjoying XM Satellite Radio programs

☞ P. 59

• Enjoying SIRIUS Satellite Radio programs
☞ P. 64
This unit is set to the standby mode and consumes a small
amount of power in order to receive infrared signals from
the remote control. To turn on this unit from the standby
mode, press the desired SSCENE buttons
(or ASCENE) or KMAIN ZONE ON/OFF
(or DPOWER). See page 29 for details.

• Using your iPod with this unit

☞ P. 70

• Using the Bluetooth components

☞ P. 72

■ Using various sound features
• Using various sound field programs

☞ P. 48

• Using the pure direct mode for high
fidelity sound

☞ P. 52

• Customizing the sound field programs

☞ P. 74

■ Adjusting the parameters of this unit
• Automatically optimizing the speaker parameters
for your listening room (AUTO SETUP) ☞ P. 32
• Manually adjusting various parameters of this unit
☞ P. 82
• Setting the remote control

☞ P. 102

• Adjusting the advanced parameters

☞ P. 109

■ Additional feature
• Automatically turning off this unit

☞ P. 47

English

9 En

CONNECTIONS

Connections
Rear panel
1

2

3

AUDIO

4

5

MULTI CH INPUT
FRONT (8CH)
CENTER

PRE OUT
SINGLE

6

DOCK

CENTER

7

VIDEO

VIDEO

L

GND R
PHONO

CD

IN
MD/ OUT
(PLAY) CD-R (REC)

DVD

IN

DTV/CBL

DVR

OUT

IN

VCR

OUT

SUB
SB (8CH) SURROUND WOOFER
HDMI

ZONE 2
OUT

FRONT

SURROUND

SUR. BACK

1

2

SUBWOOFER

S VIDEO
DTV/CBL
DVD

PR

MD/CD-R MD/CD-R

1
SIRIUS

XM

2

DIGITAL
OUTPUT

DVD

DTV/CBL

CD

4

5

3
OPTICAL

DVD

6

DTV/CBL

IN1

IN2

SPEAKERS
CENTER

FRONT A

DVR

R

L

MONITOR OUT
R

SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP
L

R

2

DVR

TRIGGER
OUT

+12V
15mA MAX.

SINGLE

9

0

A
Page

XM jack
(U.S.A. and Canada models only)

59

SIRIUS jack
(U.S.A. and Canada models only)

64

AUDIO jacks

21

DIGITAL INPUT/OUTPUT jacks

17-23

3

MULTI CH INPUT jacks

25

4

ZONE2 OUT jacks

106

5

PRE OUT jacks

24

6

DOCK terminal

25

7

Video component jacks
(VIDEO and S VIDEO)

17-22

COMPONENT VIDEO jacks

17-22

8

ANTENNA terminals

27

9

REMOTE IN/OUT jacks

26

0

Speaker terminals

A

HDMI jacks

18

B

AC OUTLETS

28

10 En

C

SWITCHED

120V 80Hz
100W MAX. TOTAL
0.8A MAX. TOTAL

Name

1

MONITOR

AC OUTLETS

L

GND AM
HD Radio
ANTENNA

8

OUT

OUT

IN3

SURROUND

FM
75Ω UNBAL.

OUT

IN

DVD
COAXIAL

R EXTRA SP L

IN

OUT

DVR
VCR
OUT
COMPONENT VIDEO
DTV/CBL
B PB
Y
Y
PR

DIGITAL INPUT
FRONT B/ZONE B/
ZONE 2/PRESENCE

REMOTE

IN

DVD

A PB

11-16

B

(U.S.A. model)

9 TRIGGER OUT jack
This is control expansion jack for custom installation.

Connections

Placing speakers
The speaker layout below shows the speaker setting we recommend. You can use it to enjoy the CINEMA DSP and
multi-channel audio sources.

■ 7.1-channel speaker layout
7.1-channel speaker layout is highly recommended for playback the sound of high definition audio formats (Dolby
TrueHD, DTS-HD Master Audio, etc.) as well as the conventional audio sources with sound field programs. See page 14
for connection information.
y

SW

FL

C

FL

FR
SR

FR

PREPARATION

We recommend that you also add the presence speakers for the effect sounds of the CINEMA DSP sound field program. See page 13 for
details.

30˚

C
SW

SL

SL
SBR
SBL

SR
60˚

SL

SR

80˚
SBL

SBR

30 cm (12 in) or more

Speaker indications
FL/FR: Front left/right
C: Center
SL/SR: Surround left/right
SBL/SBR: Surround back left/right
SW: Subwoofer
Front left and right speakers
The front speakers are used for the main source sound plus effect sounds. Place these speakers at an equal distance from the
ideal listening position. The distance of each speaker from each side of the video monitor should be the same.
Center speaker
The center speaker is for the center channel sounds (dialog, vocals, etc.). If for some reason it is not practical to use a
center speaker, you can do without it. Best results, however, are obtained with the full system.
Surround left and right speakers
The surround speakers are used for effect and surround sounds.
Surround back left and right speakers
The surround back speakers supplement the surround speakers and provide more realistic front-to-back transitions.

y
When you use two subwoofers, select the same type of the subwoofer as another and set these subwoofers as same sound characteristics.
Place each subwoofer at the same distance from the listening position. The signal output at the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT 2 jack is the
same as the one output at the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT 1 jack.

11 En

English

Subwoofer(s)
The use of a subwoofer with a built-in amplifier, such as the Yamaha Active Servo Processing Subwoofer System, is
effective not only for reinforcing bass frequencies from any or all channels, but also for reproducing the high fidelity
sound of the LFE (low-frequency effect) channel included in Dolby Digital and DTS sources. You can connect one or
two subwoofer(s) to this unit. When you use two subwoofers, you can enjoy deeper bass sound. The position of the
subwoofer is not so critical, because low bass sounds are not highly directional. But it is better to place the subwoofer
near the front speakers. Turn it slightly toward the center of the room to reduce wall reflections.

Connections

■ 6.1-channel speaker layout

■ 5.1-channel speaker layout

See page 14 for connection information.

See page 14 for connection information.

y

y

We recommend that you also add the presence speakers for the
effect sounds of the CINEMA DSP sound field program. See
page 13 for details.

We recommend that you also add the presence speakers for the
effect sounds of the CINEMA DSP sound field program. See
page 13 for details.

FR

FR
SW

FL

SR

SW

FL

C

C
SR

SL

SW

SW
SB

C

FL

FR

30˚

SL

SR

SL

Speaker indications
FL/FR: Front left/right
C: Center
SL/SR: Surround left/right
SB: Surround back
SW: Subwoofer

C

FL

30˚

SL

SR

80˚

FL/FR: Front left/right
C: Center
SL/SR: Surround left/right
SW: Subwoofer

SR

60˚
SL

Speaker indications
FR

60˚
SL

80˚

SR

SB

Front left and right speakers
Center speaker
Surround left and right speakers
Subwoofer(s)
The functions and settings of each speaker are the same as
those for the 7.1-channel speaker layout (see page 11).
Surround back speaker
Connect a single surround speakers to the SURROUND
BACK SINGLE speaker terminal and place the single
surround back speaker behind the listening position. The
surround back left and right channel signals are mixed
down and output at the single surround back speaker when
you set “SUR.B L/R SP” to “SMLx1” or “LRGx1” (see
page 88).

Front left and right speakers
Center speaker
Subwoofer(s)
The functions and settings of each speaker are the same as
those for the 7.1-channel speaker layout (see page 11).
Surround left and right speakers
Connect the surround speakers to the SURROUND
speaker terminals even if you place the surround speakers
behind the listening position. For the smooth and
unbroken sound field behind the listening position, place
the surround left and right speakers farther back compared
with the placement in the 7.1-channel speaker layout. The
surround back channel signals are directed to the surround
left and right speakers when “SUR.B L/R SP” is set to
“NONE” (see page 88).

For other speaker combinations
You can enjoy multi-channel sources with sound field programs by using a speaker combination other than the 7.1/
6.1/5.1-channel speaker combinations.
Use the automatic setup feature (see page 32) or set the “SPEAKER SET” parameters in “MANUAL SETUP” (see
page 87) to output the surround sounds at the connected speakers.

12 En

Connections

■ Using presence speakers
The presence speakers supplement the sound from the front and surround back speakers with extra ambient effects
produced by the sound field programs (see page 48). You can adjust the vertical position of dialogues with using the
presence speakers (see page 75).
To use the presence speakers, connect the speakers to the EXTRA SP terminal (see page 14) and set “EXTRA SP
ASSIGN” to “PRESENCE” (see pages 33 and 87).
0.5 to 1 m (1 to 3 ft)

0.5 to 1 m (1 to 3 ft)

Speaker indications

PL

FL

FR

1.8 m
(6 ft) or
higher

FL: Front left
FR: Front right
C: Center
PL: Front presence left
PR: Front presence right

PREPARATION

1.8 m
(6 ft) or
higher

PR

C

English

13 En

Connections

Connecting speakers
Be sure to connect the left channel (L), right channel (R), “+” (red) and “–” (black) properly. If the connections are faulty,
this unit cannot reproduce the input sources accurately.
Caution
• Before connecting the speakers, make sure that the AC power plug is disconnected from the AC wall outlet.
• Do not let the bare speaker wires touch each other or let them touch any metal part of this unit. This could damage
this unit and/or the speakers. If the speaker wires are short-circuited, “CHECK SP WIRES” appears in the front
panel display when you turn on this unit.
• Use the magnetically shielded speakers. If this type of speaker still creates interference with the monitor, place the
speakers away from the monitor.
• If you are to use 6 ohm speakers, be sure to set “SP IMP.” to “6Ω MIN” before using this unit (see page 28). 4 ohm
speakers can be also used as the front speakers. For details about the speaker impedance setting, see page 109.

Note
A speaker cord is actually a pair of insulated cables running side by side. Cables are colored or shaped differently, perhaps with a stripe,
groove or ridge. Connect the striped (grooved, etc.) cable to the “+” (red) terminals of this unit and your speaker. Connect the plain cable
to the “–” (black) terminals.

■ For the 7.1-channel speaker setting
EXTRA SP terminals
Connect the alternative front speaker system (FRONT B), front speaker systems in another room
(ZONE B), presence speakers, or Zone 2 speakers. To select the function of the speakers connected
to the EXTRA SP terminals, set the “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” parameter in “SOUND MENU” (see
page 87).

Subwoofers
(optional)

y
You can also select the function of the speakers connected to the EXTRA SP terminals in “AUTO
SETUP” (see page 33).

AUDIO

MULTI CH INPUT
FRONT (8CH)
CENTER

PRE OUT
SINGLE

DOCK

CENTER

VIDEO

VIDEO

L

GND R
PHONO

CD

IN
MD/ OUT
(PLAY) CD-R (REC)

DVD

IN

DTV/CBL

DVR

OUT

IN

VCR

OUT

SUB
SB (8CH) SURROUND WOOFER
HDMI

ZONE 2
OUT

FRONT

SURROUND

SUR. BACK

1

2

SUBWOOFER

S VIDEO
DVD
DTV/CBL

PR

MD/CD-R MD/CD-R

1
SIRIUS

XM

2

DIGITAL
OUTPUT

DVD

DTV/CBL

CD

4

5

3
OPTICAL

DVD

6

DTV/CBL

IN1

IN2

DVR

FRONT A
R

MONITOR OUT
SURROUND

CENTER
L

R

SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP
L

R

L

GND AM
HD Radio
ANTENNA

OUT

AC OUTLETS
SWITCHED

120V 80Hz
100W MAX. TOTAL
0.8A MAX. TOTAL

FM
75Ω UNBAL.

IN

TRIGGER
OUT

+12V
15mA MAX.

SINGLE

Center speaker

Left
Right
Front speakers
(FRONT A)

14 En

IN

OUT

OUT

IN3

SPEAKERS

FRONT B/ZONE B/
ZONE 2/PRESENCE

REMOTE

OUT

Left
Right
Surround speakers

Left
Right
Surround back speakers

MONITOR

DVR
VCR
OUT
COMPONENT VIDEO
DTV/CBL
B PB
Y
Y
PR

DVD
COAXIAL

DIGITAL INPUT

R EXTRA SP L

IN

DVD

A PB

C

DVR

Connections

■ For the 6.1-channel speaker setting
Center speaker
EXTRA SP terminals
(see page 14)

(optional)

AUDIO

D

IN
MD/ OUT
(PLAY) CD-R (REC)

D-R MD/CD-R

2

DVD

MULTI CH INPUT
FRONT (8CH)
CENTER

DVD

DTV/CBL

CD

4

5

3
OPTICAL

DVR

OUT

IN

VCR

SUB
SB (8CH) SURROUND WOOFER
HDMI

OUT

ZONE 2
OUT

FRONT

SURROUND

SUR. BACK

DOCK

CENTER

1

2

SUBWOOFER

Subwoofers

DVD

6
COAXIAL

DIGITAL INPUT

DVD

DTV/CBL

IN1

IN2

DVR

OUT

IN3

PREPARATION

AL
UT

IN

DTV/CBL

PRE OUT
SINGLE

SPEAKERS

FRONT B/ZONE B/
ZONE 2/PRESENCE

FRONT A

R EXTRA SP L

CENTER

SURROUND

L

R

SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP
L

R

R

L

AM

TRIGGER
OUT

12V
5mA MAX.

SINGLE

Right
Left
Surround speakers

Right
Left
Front speakers
(FRONT A)

Left (SINGLE)
Surround back speaker

■ For the 5.1-channel speaker setting
Center speaker
EXTRA SP terminals
(see page 14)

(optional)

AUDIO

D

IN
MD/ OUT
(PLAY) CD-R (REC)

D-R MD/CD-R

2
AL
UT

DVD

3

MULTI CH INPUT
FRONT (8CH)
CENTER

DVD

IN

DTV/CBL

DTV/CBL

CD

4

5

OPTICAL

DVR

OUT

IN

VCR

ZONE 2
OUT

FRONT

SURROUND

SUR. BACK

DOCK

CENTER

1

2

SUBWOOFER

Subwoofers

DVD

6
COAXIAL

DIGITAL INPUT

DVD

DTV/CBL

IN1

IN2

DVR

OUT

IN3

SPEAKERS

FRONT B/ZONE B/
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
R EXTRA SP L

SUB
SB (8CH) SURROUND WOOFER
HDMI

OUT

PRE OUT
SINGLE

FRONT A
R

CENTER
L

SURROUND
R

SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP
L

R

L

AM

TRIGGER
OUT

12V
5mA MAX.

SINGLE

English

Right
Left
Front speakers
(FRONT A)

Right
Left
Surround speakers

15 En

Connections

■ Connecting the speaker cable

1

Remove approximately 10 mm (0.4 in) of
insulation from the end of each speaker
cable and then twist the exposed wires of the
cable together to prevent short circuits.

■ Connecting the banana plug
(U.S.A. and Canada models only)
Tighten the knob and then insert the banana plug
connector into the end of the corresponding
terminal.

10 mm (0.4 in)

2

Loosen the knob.

Red: positive (+)
Black: negative (–)

■ Using bi-amplification connections

Red: positive (+)
Black: negative (–)

3

Insert one bare wire into the hole on the side
of each terminal.

Caution
Remove the shorting bars or bridges of your speakers
to separate the LPF (low pass filter) and HPF (high
pass filter) crossovers.
This unit allows you to make bi-amplification connections
to one speaker system. Check if your speakers support biamplification.
To make the bi-amplification connections, use the FRONT
and SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP terminals as shown
below. To activate the bi-amplification connections, set
“BI-AMP” to “ON” in “ADVANCED SETUP” (see
page 112).
Front speakers
Right

4

Left

Tighten the knob to secure the wire.
FRONT A
R

SURROUND BACK/
BI-AMP
L

R

SINGLE L

This unit

Note
When you make the conventional connection, make sure that the
shorting bars are put into the terminals appropriately. Refer to the
instruction manuals of the speakers for details.

16 En

Connections

Information on jacks and cable plugs
Connect one of the type of the audio jack(s) and/or video jack(s) that your input components are equipped with.
Audio jacks and cable plugs

Video jacks and cable plugs
DIGITAL

R

COAXIAL

OPTICAL

(White)

(Red)

(Orange)

L

R

C

AUDIO

Left and right
analog audio
cable plugs

Coaxial
digital audio
cable plug

VIDEO

S VIDEO

(Yellow)

O

V

S

Optical
digital
audio cable
plug

Composite
video cable
plug

S-video
cable plug

COMPONENT VIDEO
PR
PB
Y

(Red)

(Blue)

(Green)

PR

PB

Y

Component
video cable
plugs

■ Audio jacks

■ Video jacks

This unit has three types of audio jacks. Connection
depends on the availability of audio jacks on your other
components.

This unit has three types of video jacks. Connection
depends on the availability of input jacks on your video
monitor.

AUDIO jacks
For conventional analog audio signals transmitted via left
and right analog audio cables. Connect red plugs to the
right jacks and white plugs to the left jacks.

VIDEO jacks
For conventional composite video signals transmitted via
composite video cables.

DIGITAL COAXIAL jacks
For digital audio signals transmitted via coaxial digital
audio cables.
DIGITAL OPTICAL jacks
For digital audio signals transmitted via optical digital
audio cables.
Note
You can use the digital jacks to input PCM, Dolby Digital and
DTS bitstreams. When you connect components to both the
COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks, priority is given to the signals
input at the COAXIAL jack. Optical input jacks are compatible
with digital signals with up to 96 kHz of sampling frequency.

PREPARATION

DIGITAL

L

S VIDEO jacks
For S-video signals, separated into the luminance (Y) and
chrominance (C) video signals transmitted on separate
wires of S-video cables.
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks
For component video signals, separated into the
luminance (Y) and chrominance (PB, PR) video signals
transmitted on separate wires of component video cables.
y
This unit is equipped with the video conversion function. See
pages 19 and 98 for details.

English

17 En

Connections

Information on HDMI™
■ HDMI signal compatibility

Video signals
This unit is compatible with the video signals of the
following resolutions:

Audio signals
Audio signal
types

Audio signal
formats

Compatible
media

2ch Linear
PCM

2ch, 32-192 kHz,
16/20/24 bit

CD, DVD-Video,
DVD-Audio, etc.

Multi-ch
Linear PCM

8ch, 32-192 kHz,
16/20/24 bit

DVD-Audio, Bluray Disc, HD DVD,
etc.

DSD

2/5.1ch,
2.8224 MHz, 1 bit

SA-CD, etc.

Bitstream

Dolby Digital,
DTS

DVD-Video, etc.

Video signal format
– 480i/60 Hz
– 576i/50 Hz
– 480p/60 Hz
– 576p/50 Hz
– 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz
– 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz
– 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 24 Hz
Default input assignment of HDMI input jacks
HDMI input jack
IN1

Bitstream (High
definition audio)

Dolby TrueHD,
Dolby Digital Plus,
DTS-HD Master
Audio, DTS-HD High
Resolution Audio,
DTS Express

Blu-ray Disc,
HD DVD, etc.

Assigned input source
DVD

IN2

DTV/CBL

IN3

DVR

■ HDMI jack and cable plug
HDMI

y
• If the input source component can decode the bitstream audio
signals of audio commentaries, you can play back the audio
sources with the audio commentaries mixed down by using the
following connections:
– multi-channel analog audio input (see page 25)
– DIGITAL INPUT OPTICAL (or COAXIAL)
• Refer to the supplied instruction manuals of the input source
component, and set the component appropriately.

HDMI cable plug

Notes
• When CPPM copy-protected DVD-Audio is played back, video
and audio signals may not be output depending on the type of
the DVD player.
• This unit is not compatible with HDCP-incompatible HDMI or
DVI components.
• To decode audio bitstream signals on this unit, set the input
source component appropriately so that the component outputs
the bitstream audio signals directly (does not decode the
bitstream signals on the component). Refer to the supplied
instruction manuals for details.
• This unit is not compatible with the audio commentary features
(for example, the special audio contents downloaded via Internet)
of Blu-ray Disc or HD DVD. This unit does not play back the
audio commentaries of the Blu-ray Disc or HD DVD contents.

18 En

y
• We recommend that you use an HDMI cable shorter than 5
meters (16 feet) with the HDMI logo printed on it.
• Use a conversion cable (HDMI jack ↔ DVI-D jack) to connect
this unit to other DVI components.

Notes
• Do not disconnect or connect the cable or turn off the power of
the HDMI components connected to the HDMI OUT jack of
this unit while data is being transferred. Doing so may disrupt
playback or cause noise.
• If you turn off the power of the video monitor connected to the
HDMI OUT jack via a DVI connection, this unit may fail to
establish the connection to the component.
• The analog video signals input at the composite video, S-video
and component video jacks can be digitally up-converted to be
output at the HDMI OUT jack. Set “VIDEO CONV.” to “ON”
in “MANUAL SETUP” (see page 98) to activate this feature.

Connections

Audio and video signal flow
■ Audio signal flow
Input

■ Video signal flow
Output

HDMI

Input

Output

HDMI

DIGITAL AUDIO
(COAXIAL)

COMPONENT
VIDEO

PREPARATION

DIGITAL AUDIO
(OPTICAL)

AUDIO

S VIDEO

VIDEO

Digital output
Through
Analog output

Video conversion ON (see page 98)

Notes

Notes

• 2-channel as well as multi-channel PCM, Dolby Digital and
DTS signals input at one of the HDMI IN jacks can be output at
the HDMI OUT jack only when “S.AUDIO” is set to “OTHER”
(see page 101).
• Audio signals input at the HDMI IN jacks are not output at the
AUDIO output and DIGITAL OUTPUT jacks.

• When the video signals are input at the HDMI, COMPONENT
VIDEO, S VIDEO, and VIDEO jacks, the priority order of the
input signals is as follows:
1. HDMI
2. COMPONENT VIDEO
3. S VIDEO
4. VIDEO
• Digital video signals input at one of the HDMI IN jacks cannot
be output from analog video output jacks.
• The analog component video signals with
480i (NTSC)/576i (PAL) of resolution are converted to the
S-video or composite video signals and output at the S VIDEO
MONITOR OUT and VIDEO MONITOR OUT jacks.
• The analog component video signals with 1080p of resolution
are only output at the COMPONENT VIDEO MONITOR OUT
jacks.
• Use the “HDMI RES.” parameter in “VIDEO SET” to
deinterlace and convert the resolution of the analog video
signals output at the HDMI OUT jack (see page 99).

English

19 En

Connections

Connecting a TV monitor or projector
• When you use the internal tuner of the TV as the input source,
connect the digital or analog audio output jacks of the TV and
digital or analog audio input jacks of this unit. Refer to
“Connecting a set-top box” on page 22 for connecting
information.

Connect your TV (or projector) to the HDMI OUT jack,
the COMPONENT VIDEO MONITOR OUT jacks, the
S VIDEO MONITOR OUT jack or the VIDEO
MONITOR OUT jack of this unit.

Notes

Make sure that this unit and other
components are unplugged from the
AC wall outlets.

• If a video monitor is connected to this unit via a DVI
connection, you may not take full advantage of the HDMI
features.
• Some video monitors connected to this unit via a DVI
connection fail to recognize the HDMI audio/video signals
being input if they are in the standby mode. In this case, the
HDMI indicator flashes irregularly.
• If the connected video monitor is compatible with the automatic
audio and video synchronization feature (automatic lip sync
feature), this unit adjusts the audio and video timing
automatically (see page 94). Connect the video monitor to the
HDMI OUT jack of this unit to use the feature.

y
• You can choose to play back HDMI audio signals on this unit or
on another HDMI component connected to the HDMI OUT
jack of this unit. Use the “S.AUDIO” parameter in “OPTION
MENU” to select the component to play back HDMI audio
signals (see page 101).

AUDIO

D/ OUT
D-R (REC)

MULTI CH INPUT
FRONT (8CH)
CENTER

DVD

IN

DTV/CBL

DVR

OUT

IN

VCR

OUT

SUB
SB (8CH) SURROUND WOOFER
HDMI

PRE OUT
SINGLE

ZONE 2
OUT

FRONT

SURROUND

DOCK

CENTER

SUR. BACK

1

VIDEO

VIDEO

S VIDEO
DVD
DTV/CBL

2

SUBWOOFER

DVD

3

DTV/CBL

CD

4

5

OPTICAL

OUT

IN

OUT

MONITOR

DVR
VCR
OUT
COMPONENT VIDEO
DTV/CBL
B PB
Y
Y
PR

DVD
DVD

6

DTV/CBL

IN1

COAXIAL

DIGITAL INPUT

IN2

DVR

OUT

IN3

SPEAKERS

FRONT B/ZONE B/
ZONE 2/PRESENCE

FRONT A

R EXTRA SP L

IN

DVD

A PB

PR

R

MONITOR OUT

CENTER
L

SURROUND
R

SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP
L

R

C

DVR

AC OUTLETS

L

SWITCHED

120V 80Hz
100W MAX. TOTAL
0.8A MAX. TOTAL

O

(U.S.A. model)

Optical out
HDMI in
Component video in
S-video in
Video in
TV (or projector)

indicates recommended connections
indicates alternative connections
(One for the video connection, and one for the
audio connection)

20 En

PR

PB

Y

S

V

Connections

Connecting other components
Make sure that this unit and other
components are unplugged from the
AC wall outlets.

Notes
• When “VIDEO CONV.” is set to “OFF” (see page 98), be sure
to make the same type of video connections as those made for
your TV (see page 20). For example, if you connected your TV
to the VIDEO MONITOR OUT jack of this unit, connect your
other components to the VIDEO jacks.

■ Connecting a DVD player
DVD player

Optical out

PREPARATION

• When “VIDEO CONV.” is set to “ON” (see page 98), the
converted video signals are output only at the MONITOR OUT
jacks. To record a source, make the same type of video
connections between each component.
• To make a digital connection to a component other than the
default component assigned to each DIGITAL INPUT or
DIGITAL OUTPUT jack, select the corresponding setting for
“OPTICAL OUT”, “OPTICAL IN”, or “COAXIAL IN” in “I/O
ASSIGNMENT” (see page 95).
• If you connect your DVD player to both the DIGITAL INPUT
(OPTICAL) and the DIGITAL INPUT (COAXIAL) jacks,
priority is given to the signals input at the DIGITAL INPUT
(COAXIAL) jack.

S-video out
Video out

Coaxial out

Component video out
Audio out

L

C

O

HDMI out

R

PR

AUDIO

MULTI CH INPUT
FRONT (8CH)
CENTER

PRE OUT
SINGLE

PB

Y

V

DOCK

CENTER

S

VIDEO

VIDEO

L

GND R
PHONO

CD

IN
MD/ OUT
(PLAY) CD-R (REC)

DVD

IN

DTV/CBL

DVR

OUT

IN

VCR

OUT

SUB
SB (8CH) SURROUND WOOFER
HDMI

ZONE 2
OUT

FRONT

SURROUND

SUR. BACK

1

2

SUBWOOFER

S VIDEO
DVD
DTV/CBL

PR

MD/CD-R MD/CD-R

1
SIRIUS

XM

2

DIGITAL
OUTPUT

DVD

3

DTV/CBL

CD

4

5

OPTICAL

R EXTRA SP L

GND AM
HD Radio
ANTENNA

REMOTE

IN

OUT

OUT

IN

OUT

MONITOR

DVR
VCR
OUT
COMPONENT VIDEO
DTV/CBL
B PB
Y
Y
PR

DVD

6
COAXIAL

DIGITAL INPUT

DVD

DTV/CBL

DVR

IN1

IN2

IN3

OUT

SPEAKERS

FRONT B/ZONE B/
ZONE 2/PRESENCE

FM
75Ω UNBAL.

IN

DVD

A PB

FRONT A
R

MONITOR OUT

CENTER
L

SURROUND
R

SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP
L

R

L

C

DVR

AC OUTLETS
SWITCHED

120V 80Hz
100W MAX. TOTAL
0.8A MAX. TOTAL

TRIGGER
OUT

+12V
15mA MAX.

(U.S.A. model)

indicates recommended connections
indicates alternative connections
(One for the video connection, and one for the
audio connection)

English

21 En

Connections

■ Connecting a DVD recorder, PVR or VCR
VCR

S-video out

Audio out

S-video in
Audio in

L

R

L

Video in
Video out

R

(U.S.A. model)
AUDIO

IN
MD/ OUT
(PLAY) CD-R (REC)

MULTI CH INPUT
FRONT (8CH)
CENTER

DVD

IN

DTV/CBL

DVR

OUT

IN

VCR

PRE OUT
SINGLE

SUB
SB (8CH) SURROUND WOOFER
HDMI

OUT

ZONE 2
OUT

FRONT

SURROUND

DOCK

CENTER

1

S VIDEO
DVD
DTV/CBL

2

PR

MD/CD-R

2

DVD

DTV/CBL

CD

4

5

3
OPTICAL

IN

OUT

S

S

IN

OUT

DVD

A PB

MONITOR

DVR
VCR
OUT
COMPONENT VIDEO
DTV/CBL
B PB
Y
Y
PR

DVD
DVD

6

DTV/CBL

IN1

COAXIAL

DIGITAL INPUT

DVR

IN2

OUT

IN3

SPEAKERS

FRONT B/ZONE B/
ZONE 2/PRESENCE

FRONT A

R EXTRA SP L

SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP
L

R

C

V

S

S-video out

R

DVR

AC OUTLETS

L

R

Video out

L

R

SURROUND

L

R

MONITOR OUT

CENTER

HDMI out

L

V

VIDEO

VIDEO

SUBWOOFER

SUR. BACK

V

S

V

PR

PB

Y

S-video in

Audio in

Video in

Audio out

Component video out
DVD recorder
or PVR

■ Connecting a set-top box
Satellite receiver, cable
TV receiver or HDTV
decoder
S-video out
Video out

Optical out
Audio out

HDMI out

L

O

Component video out

R

AUDIO

PR

MULTI CH INPUT
FRONT (8CH)
CENTER

PRE OUT
SINGLE

PB

Y

DOCK

CENTER

V

S

VIDEO

VIDEO

L

GND R
PHONO

CD

IN
MD/ OUT
(PLAY) CD-R (REC)

DVD

IN

DTV/CBL

DVR

OUT

IN

VCR

OUT

SUB
SB (8CH) SURROUND WOOFER
HDMI

ZONE 2
OUT

FRONT

SURROUND

SUR. BACK

1

2

SUBWOOFER

S VIDEO
DVD
DTV/CBL

PR

MD/CD-R MD/CD-R

1
SIRIUS

XM

DIGITAL
OUTPUT

2

DVD

3

DTV/CBL

CD

4

5

OPTICAL

OUT

IN

OUT

MONITOR

DVR
VCR
OUT
COMPONENT VIDEO
DTV/CBL
B PB
Y
Y
PR

DVD
DVD

6

DTV/CBL

IN1

COAXIAL

DIGITAL INPUT

IN2

DVR

OUT

IN3

SPEAKERS

FRONT B/ZONE B/
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
R EXTRA SP L

IN

DVD

A PB

FRONT A
R

MONITOR OUT

CENTER
L

SURROUND
R

SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP
L

R

L

C

DVR

AC OUTLETS

(U.S.A. model)

indicates recommended connections
indicates alternative connections
(One for the video connection, and one for the
audio connection)

22 En

Connections

■ Connecting audio components
Notes
• To make a digital connection to a component other than the default component assigned to each the DIGITAL INPUT jack or the
DIGITAL OUTPUT jack, select the corresponding setting for “OPTICAL OUT”, “OPTICAL IN”, or “COAXIAL IN” in “I/O
ASSIGNMENT” (see page 95).
• Connect your turntable to the GND terminal of this unit to reduce noise in the signal. However, you may hear less noise without the
connection to the GND terminal for some turntables.
• The PHONO jacks are only compatible with a turntable with an MM or a high-output MC cartridge. To connect a turntable with a lowoutput MC cartridge to the PHONO jacks, use an in-line boosting transformer or an MC-head amplifier.
• When you connect both the DIGITAL INPUT (OPTICAL) jack and the DIGITAL INPUT (COAXIAL) jack to an audio component,
the priority is given to the DIGITAL INPUT (COAXIAL) jack.

PREPARATION

CD recorder, MD
recorder or tape deck

Turntable

R
R

LL

R
R

LL

R
R

O
O

AUDIO
AUDIO

O
O

Optical out

Audio out

Ground

LL

Audio in

Optical in

Audio out

MULTI
MULTI CH
CH INPUT
INPUT
FRONT
FRONT(8CH)
(8CH)
CENTER
CENTER

PRE
PRE OUT
OUT
SS

L
L

GND
GND R
R
PHONO
PHONO

CD
CD

XM
XM

DIGITAL
DIGITAL
OUTPUT
OUTPUT

IN
IN
MD/
MD/ OUT
OUT
(PLAY)
(PLAY) CD-R
CD-R (REC)
(REC)

MD/CD-R
MD/CD-R MD/CD-R
MD/CD-R

11
SIRIUS
SIRIUS

22

DVD
DVD

33

DVD
DVD

DTV/CBL
DTV/CBL

DTV/CBL
DTV/CBL

CD
CD

44

55

OPTICAL
OPTICAL

IN
IN

DVR
DVR

OUT
OUT

IN
IN

VCR
VCR

OUT
OUT

ZONE
ZONE 22
OUT
OUT

FRONT
FRONT SURROUND
SURROUND SU
SU

DVD
DVD

66
COAXIAL
COAXIAL

DIGITAL
DIGITAL INPUT
INPUT

DVD
DVD

DTV/CBL
DTV/CBL

IN1
IN1

IN2
IN2

DVR
DVR

OUT
OUT

IN3
IN3

SPEAKERS
SPEAKERS

FRONT
FRONT B/ZONE
B/ZONE B/
B/
ZONE
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
2/PRESENCE
L
EXTRASP
SP L
R
R EXTRA

SUB
SUB
SB
SB (8CH)
(8CH) SURROUND
SURROUND WOOFER
WOOFER
HDMI
HDMI

FRONT
FRONT AA
R
R

CENTER
CENTER
L
L

SURROUND
SURROUND
R
R

SURROUND
SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP
BACK/BI-AMP
L
L

R
R

L
L

FM
FM
75Ω
75Ω UNBAL.
UNBAL.

GND
GND AM
AM
HD
HD Radio
Radio
ANTENNA
ANTENNA

REMOTE
REMOTE

IN
IN

OUT
OUT

TRIGGER
TRIGGER
OUT
OUT

+12V
+12V
15mA
15mA MAX.
MAX.

(U.S.A. model)

LL

R
R

C
C

Coaxial
out

Audio
out
CD player

indicates recommended connections

English

indicates alternative connections
(One for the audio connection)

23 En

Connections

■ Connecting an external amplifier
This unit has more than enough power for any home use. However, if you want to add more power to the speaker output
or if you want to use another amplifier, connect an external amplifier to the PRE OUT jacks. Each PRE OUT jack outputs
the same channel signals as the corresponding SPEAKERS terminals.
Notes
•
•
•
•

When you make connections to the PRE OUT jacks, do not make connections to the SPEAKERS terminals.
The signals output at the FRONT PRE OUT jacks are affected by the TONE CONTROL settings (see page 52).
Adjust the volume level of the subwoofer with the control on the subwoofer (see page 52).
Some signals may not be output at the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT jacks depending on the settings for “SPEAKER SET” (see page 87).

PRE OUT
SINGLE

5
CENTER

L

R

FRONT

SURROUND

1

2

SUR. BACK

3

1

2

SUBWOOFER

4

1 FRONT PRE OUT jacks
Front channel output jacks.
2 SURROUND PRE OUT jacks
Surround channel output jacks.
3 SUR.BACK PRE OUT jacks
Surround back channel output jacks. When you only
connect one external amplifier for the surround back
channel, connect it to the SINGLE jack.
Notes
• When “BI-AMP” is set to “ON”, this unit outputs the front
channel audio signals at the SUR.BACK PRE OUT jacks.
• The audio signals output at the SUR.BACK PRE OUT jacks
differ depending on the “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” setting (see
pages 33 and 87).

4 SUBWOOFER PRE OUT jacks
Connect one or two subwoofers with a built-in amplifier.
Note
The signal output at the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT 2 jack is the
same as the one output at the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT 1 jack.

5 CENTER PRE OUT jack
Center channel output jack.

24 En

Connections

■ Connecting a multi-format player or an external decoder
This unit is equipped with 6 additional input jacks (left and right FRONT, CENTER, left and right SURROUND and
SUBWOOFER) for discrete multi-channel input from a multi-format player, external decoder, sound processor or preamplifier.
If you set “INPUT CH” to “8CH” in “MULTI CH” (see page 97), you can use the input jacks assigned as “FRONT” in
“MULTI CH” (see page 97) together with the MULTI CH INPUT jacks to input 8-channel signals.
Connect the output jacks on your multi-format player or external decoder to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks. Be sure to
match the left and right outputs to the left and right input jacks for the front and surround channels.
Notes

MULTI CH INPUT
FRONT (8CH)
CENTER

MULTI CH INPUT
FRONT (8CH)
CENTER

L

L

L

R

R

*1
R

L

R

L

L

R

L

R

Center out

Subwoofer
out

Front out

Center out

Subwoofer
out

Front out

Multi-format player/External
decoder (5.1-channel output)
*1

R

SUB
SB (8CH) SURROUND WOOFER

Surround out

R

Surround out

L

Surround back out

SUB
SB (8CH) SURROUND WOOFER

PREPARATION

• When you select the component connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks as the input source (see page 43), this unit automatically
turns off the digital sound field processor, and you cannot select sound field programs.
• This unit does not redirect signals input at the MULTI CH INPUT jacks to accommodate for missing speakers. We recommend that
you connect at least a 5.1-channel speaker system before using this feature.

Multi-format player/External
decoder (7.1-channel output)

The analog audio input jacks assigned as “FRONT” in “MULTI CH” (see page 97).

■ Connecting a Yamaha iPod universal
dock or Bluetooth adapter
This unit is equipped with the DOCK terminal on the rear
panel that allows you to connect a Yamaha iPod universal
dock (such as YDS-10, sold separately) or Bluetooth
adapter (such as YBA-10 sold separately). Connect a
Yamaha iPod universal dock or Bluetooth adapter to the
DOCK terminal on the rear panel of this unit using its
dedicated cable.
DOCK

Refer to “Using iPod™” on page 70 for playback of your iPod
and “Using Bluetooth™ components” on page 72 for playback of
your Bluetooth components.

VIDEO

VIDEO

S VIDEO
DVD
DTV/CBL

PR

y

IN

DVD

A PB

OUT

IN

OUT

MONITOR

DVR
VCR
OUT
COMPONENT VIDEO
DTV/CBL
B PB
Y
Y
PR

MONITOR OUT

C

DVR

English

Yamaha iPod universal dock
or Bluetooth adapter

25 En

Connections

■ Using REMOTE IN/OUT jacks
When the components are the Yamaha products and have
the capability of the transmission of the remote control
signals, connect the REMOTE IN jack and REMOTE
OUT jack to the remote control input and output jack with
the monaural analog mini cable as follows.
(U.S.A. model)
GND AM
HD Radio
ANTENNA

IN

OUT

Use the VIDEO AUX jacks on the front panel to connect a
game console or a video camera to this unit.
Caution
Be sure to turn down the volume of this unit and other
components before making connections.

FM
75Ω UNBAL.

REMOTE

Using the VIDEO AUX jacks on the
front panel

TRIGGER
OUT

+12V
15mA MAX.

Notes
• The audio signals input at the DOCK terminal on the rear panel
take priority over the ones input at the VIDEO AUX jacks.
• To reproduce the source signals input at these jacks, select
“V-AUX” as the input source.

Remote
control out

Remote
control in
VOLUME

SPEAKERS

EDIT
SEARCH MODE

BAND

CATEGORY
A/B/C/D/E

PRESET/TUNING/CH

MEMORY

INFO

ZONE 2
ON/OFF

ZONE
CONTROL

SCENE

Infrared signal
receiver or Yamaha
component

Yamaha component
(CD or DVD player,
etc.)

1

2

3

4

PROGRAM
SYSTEM OFF

PHONES

TONE CONTROL

INPUT
STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

AUDIO SELECT

VIDEO AUX

OPTIMIZER MIC

STANDBY
/ON

SILENT CINEMA

EFFECT

S VIDEO

VIDEO

L

AUDIO

R

OPTICAL

y
VIDEO

L

S

V

L

AUDIO

R

OPTICAL

R

O

Audio output

Video output

Optical output

S VIDEO

S-Video output

• If the components have the capability of the SCENE control
signals, this unit can automatically activate the corresponding
components and start the playback when you use one of the
SCENE buttons. Refer to the owner’s manuals for details about
the capability of the SCENE control signals of the components.
• If the component connected to the REMOTE OUT jack is not
the Yamaha product, set “SCENE IR” in the advanced setup
menu to “OFF” (see page 112).

Game console or
video camera

indicates recommended connections

indicates alternative connections
(One for the video connection, and
one for the audio connection)

26 En

Connections

Connecting the FM and AM
antennas

Connecting the wire of the AM loop antenna
(U.S.A. model)
Press and hold

Insert

Release

Both FM and AM indoor antennas are supplied with this
unit. Connect each antenna correctly to the designated
terminals. In general, these antennas should provide
sufficient signal strength.
Notes
(Canada model)

AM loop antenna
(supplied)

Indoor FM
antenna
(supplied)

(U.S.A. model)
MD/CD-R MD/CD-R

1
SIRIUS

XM

2

DIGITAL
OUTPUT

DVD

3

DTV/CBL

CD

4

5

OPTICAL

Open the lever

Insert

Close the lever

PREPARATION

• The AM loop antenna should be placed away from this unit.
• A properly installed outdoor antenna provides clearer reception
than an indoor one. If you experience poor reception quality,
install an outdoor antenna. Consult the nearest authorized
Yamaha dealer or service center about outdoor antennas.
• The AM loop antenna should always be connected, even if an
outdoor AM antenna is connected to this unit.

y
The wire of the AM loop antenna does not have any polarity
and you can connect either end of the wire to AM or GND
terminal.

Assembling the supplied AM loop antenna
COAX

DIGITAL INPUT
FRONT B/ZONE B/
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
R EXTRA SP L

R

(U.S.A. model)

FM
75Ω UNBAL.

GND AM
HD Radio
ANTENNA

REMOTE

TRIGGER
OUT

Outdoor AM antenna
Use a 5 to 10 m (16 to 33
ft) vinyl-covered wire
extended outdoors from a
window.

Ground (GND terminal)
For maximum safety and minimum interference, connect the
antenna GND terminal to a good earth ground. A good earth
ground is a metal stake driven into moist earth.

(Canada model)

English

27 En

Connections

Connecting the power cable
(U.S.A. model)

MONITOR OUT

C

DVR

AC OUTLETS

Setting the speaker impedance
Caution
If you are to use 6 ohm speakers, set “SP IMP.” to
“6Ω MIN” as follows BEFORE using this unit. 4 ohm
speakers can be also used as the front speakers.

SWITCHED

120V 80Hz
100W MAX. TOTAL
0.8A MAX. TOTAL

1

Press LSYSTEM OFF on the front panel to
turn off this unit.
See page 29 for details.

2

Press and hold MTONE CONTROL and
then press KMAIN ZONE ON/OFF to turn
on this unit.
This unit turns on, and the advanced setup menu
appears in the front panel display.

To the AC wall outlet

TONE CONTROL

While holding
down

MAIN ZONE

ON/OFF

■ AC OUTLETS (SWITCHED)
Use these 2 outlets to supply power to any connected
components. Connect the power cable of your other
components to these 2 outlets. Power to these 2 outlets is
supplied when this unit is turned on. However, power to
these 2 outlets is cut off when this unit is turned off. For
information on the maximum power or the total power
consumption of the components that can be connected to
these 2 outlets, see “Specifications” on page 127.

3

Rotate the NPROGRAM selector to select
“SP IMP.”.
“SP IMP.” and the current speaker impedance setting
(“8Ω MIN”) appear in the front panel display.

4

Press MTONE CONTROL repeatedly to
select “6Ω MIN”.

5

Press LSYSTEM OFF to save the new
setting and turn off this unit.

Note
The power to AC OUTLETS of this unit is not cut off while this
unit is charging connected iPod even when this unit is in the
standby mode. When this unit completes charging or the iPod is
disconnected, the power is cut off automatically when this unit is
in the standby mode.

Memory back-up
The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data
from being lost even if this unit is in the standby mode.
However, the stored data will be lost in case the power
cable is disconnected from the AC wall outlet or if the
power supply is cut off for more than one week.

28 En

Note
The setting you made is reflected next time you turn on this
unit.

Connections

Turning this unit on and off
■ Turning on this unit
Press KMAIN ZONE ON/OFF (or DPOWER) to
turn on this unit.
The main zone is turned on.
y

PREPARATION

• When you turn on this unit, there will be delay for a few
seconds before this unit can reproduce sound.
• You can also turn on the main zone by pressing SSCENE (or
ASCENE) buttons.

■ Set the main zone to the standby mode
Press KMAIN ZONE ON/OFF (or CSTANDBY)
to set the main zone to the standby mode.
In the standby mode, this unit consumes a small amount of
power in order to receive infrared signals from the remote
control.
y
Press L SYSTEM OFF to set the main zone and Zone 2 (see
page 108) to the standby mode simultaneously.

English

29 En

Connections

Front panel display
1

2
MULTI CH

VCR

3
DVR

q EX ADAPTIVE DRC

MASTER AUDIO q DIGITAL PLUS
HD 96 q TRUE HD
ES 24 q PL x
MATRIX DISCRETE

4
V-AUX
DOCK
SP
AB

5
DTV/CBL

6

DVD

MD/CD-R

ENHANCER

7
CD

8
TUNER

PHONO

XM

ZONE 2
SILENT CINEMA

ft
ms
dB

A

B C

DE

F

1 HDMI indicator
Lights up when the signal of the selected input source is
input at the HDMI IN jacks (see page 18).
2 ADAPTIVE DRC indicator
Lights up when the adaptive dynamic range control
feature is turned on (see page 91).
3 DOCK indicator
• Lights up when you station your iPod in a Yamaha
iPod universal dock (such as YDS-10, sold separately)
connected to the DOCK terminal of this unit (see
page 25) and V-AUX is selected as the input source.
The DOCK indicator also lights up when this unit is
charging the battery of the stationed iPod in the
standby mode.
• Flashes while the connected Yamaha Bluetooth adapter
(such as YBA-10, sold separately) and the Bluetooth
component is in the paring or the Bluetooth adapter is
searching the Bluetooth component (see page 72).
• Light up while the Yamaha Bluetooth adapter is
connected to the Bluetooth component (see page 72).

SIRIUS

VOL.
YPAO MEMORY HD
VIRTUAL AUTO TUNED STEREO MUTE
dB
HOLD
SLEEP
96/24 LFE

CS
neural
PCM DSD

0

9

G

H

L C R
SL SB SR
SBL
SBR

I

7 Tuner indicators
Lights up when this unit is in the FM, AM, XM Satellite
Radio, or SIRIUS Satellite Radio tuning mode (see
pages 53 to 69).
Note
HD indicator is only applicable to the U.S.A. model only and
lights up when this unit is turned into the HD Radio reception
band.

8 96/24 indicator
Lights up when a DTS 96/24 signal is input to this unit.
9 MUTE indicator and VOLUME level indicator
• The MUTE indicator flashes while the MUTE function
is on (see page 45).
• Indicates the current volume level.
0 Input signal indicators
Lights up when this unit is reproducing PCM (Pulse Code
Modulation) or DSD (Direct Stream Digital) digital audio
signals.

4 ENHANCER indicator
Lights up when the Compressed Music Enhancer mode is
selected (see page 50).

A Decoder indicators
The respective indicator lights up when any of the
decoders of this unit function.

5 Input source indicators
The corresponding cursor lights up to show the currently
selected input source.

Note

Note
The XM and SIRIUS indicator is only applicable to the U.S.A.
and Canada models and the cursor on the left of the XM indicator
or SIRIUS indicator lights up only when “XM” or “SIRIUS” is
selected as the input source.

6 YPAO indicator
Lights up when you run “AUTO SETUP” and when the
speaker settings set in “AUTO SETUP” are used without
any modifications (see page 32).

The neural indicator is only applicable to the U.S.A. and
Canada models and CSII indicator is only applicable to
the U.S.A. model.
B Sound field indicators
Light up to indicate the active sound fields (see page 48).
Presence sound field
Listening position
Surround left
sound field

Surround right
sound field

Surround back sound field

C Headphone indicator
Lights up when headphones are connected (see page 45).

30 En

Connections

D SP A B indicators
Light up according to the set of front speakers activated
(see page 43).
SP A: The FRONT A speakers are activated.
SP B: The FRONT B speakers are activated.
SP A B: The FRONT A and FRONT B speakers are
activated.

Using the remote control
The remote control transmits a directional infrared ray.
Be sure to aim the remote control directly at the remote
control sensor on this unit during operation.
Remote control sensor

E ZONE2 indicator
Lights up when Zone 2 is turned on (see page 107).

CINEMA DSP indicator
Lights up when you select a CINEMA DSP sound
field program (see page 48).

Approximately 6 m (20 ft)

30

PREPARATION

F DSP indicators
The respective indicator lights up when any of the sound
field programs are selected (see page 48).
30

VIRTUAL indicator
Lights up when the Virtual CINEMA DSP mode is
active (see page 51).
SILENT CINEMA indicator
Lights up when headphones are connected and a
sound field program is selected (see page 51).

Infrared window (1)
Outputs infrared control signals. Aim this window at the
component you want to operate.

G Multi-information display
Shows the name of the current sound field program and
other information when adjusting or changing settings.

BTRANSMIT indicator
Flashes while the remote control is sending infrared
signals.

H SLEEP indicator
Lights up while the sleep timer is on (see page 47).

Operation mode selector (F)
The function of some buttons depends on the operation
mode selector position.

I Input channel and speaker indicators
LFE indicator

LFE
L C R
SL SB SR
SBL
SBR

Presence speaker indicators
Input channel indicators

Input channel indicators
• Indicate the channel components of the current
digital input signal.
• Light up or flash according to the settings of the
speakers when this unit is in the automatic setup
procedure (see page 32) or in the “BASIC MENU”
in “MANUAL SETUP” (see page 89).
Presence speaker indicators
Light up or flash according to the setting of “EXTRA
SP ASSIGN” when this unit is in the automatic setup
procedure (see page 32) or in the “BASIC MENU” in
“MANUAL SETUP” (see page 87).

SOURCE
Operates the component selected with an input
selector button (see page 103).
TV
Operates the TV assigned to either 4DTV/CBL or
4PHONO (see page 102).
Notes
• Do not spill water or other liquids on the remote control.
• Do not drop the remote control.
• Do not leave or store the remote control in the following types
of conditions:
– places of high humidity, such as near a bath
– places of high temperatures, such as near a heater or stove
– places of extremely low temperatures
– dusty places
• To set the remote control codes for other components, see
page 104.

You can make settings for the presence and surround back
speakers automatically by running “AUTO SETUP” (see
page 32) or manually by adjusting settings for “SUR.B L/R
SP” (see page 88) in “SPEAKER SET”.

31 En

English

y

AMP
Operates the amplifier function of this unit.

OPTIMIZING THE SPEAKER SETTING FOR YOUR LISTENING ROOM (YPAO)

Optimizing the speaker setting for your listening room (YPAO)
This unit employs the YPAO (Yamaha Parametric Room Acoustic Optimizer) technology which lets you avoid
troublesome listening-based speaker setup and achieves highly accurate sound adjustments automatically. The supplied
optimizer microphone collects and this unit analyzes the sound your speakers produce in your actual listening
environment.

Using AUTO SETUP

2

Notes
• Be advised that it is normal for loud test tones to be output
during the “AUTO SETUP” procedure.
• To achieve the best results, make sure the room is as quiet as
possible while the “AUTO SETUP” procedure is in progress. If
there is too much ambient noise, the results may not be
satisfactory.

Connect the supplied optimizer microphone
to the OPTIMIZER MIC jack on the front
panel.
“MIC ON View OSD menu” appears in the front
panel display.
VIDEO AUX

OPTIMIZER MIC

S VIDEO

VIDEO

L

AUDIO

R

OPTICAL

y
• Initial settings are indicated in bold.
• You can run “AUTO SETUP” using the system menu that
appears in the OSD or in the front panel display. This manual
uses the OSD illustrations to explain the “AUTO SETUP”
procedure.
• Before performing operations, set the operation mode selector
on the remote control to FAMP.
• This unit uses the speakers connected to the FRONT A speaker
terminals as the front speakers for the adjustment.

1

Omni-directional
microphone

The following menu screen appears on the video
monitor.
AUTOSETUP
. EXTRASPASSIGN
>ZONE2
FRONTB
ZONEBPRESENCE
NONE
SETUP;;;;;;;AUTO
EQ;;;;;;;NATURAL
START

Make sure of the following check points.
Note

❏
❏

Speakers are connected appropriately.
Headphones are disconnected from this unit.
This unit and the video monitor are turned on.
This unit is selected as the video input source of
the video monitor.
The connected subwoofer is turned on and the
volume level is set to about half way (or slightly
less).
The crossover frequency controls of the
connected subwoofer is set to the maximum.
VOLUME

MIN

MAX

[]/[]:Up/Down
[]/[]:Select
[ [

3

[

❏
❏
❏
❏

[

Before starting the automatic setup, check the following
check points.

Place the optimizer microphone at your
normal listening position on a flat level
surface with the omni-directional
microphone heading upward.
Optimizer microphone

CROSSOVER
HIGH CUT

MIN

MAX

Controls of a subwoofer (example)

❏

The room is sufficiently quiet.

y
If you connect two subwoofers to this unit, the volume level
of each subwoofer is set to slightly less.

32 En

y
It is recommended that you use a tripod (etc.) to affix the
optimizer microphone at the same height as your ears would
be when you are seated in your listening position. You can
use the attached screw of a tripod (etc.) to fix the optimizer
microphone to the tripod (etc.).

Optimizing the speaker setting for your listening room (YPAO)

4

Notes

Press 8l / h to select the desired setting
for “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” and then press 8n.
Extra speaker assignment
EXTRA SP ASSIGN
Selects the function of the speakers connected to the
EXTRA SP terminals.
Choices: FRONT B, ZONE2, ZONE B,
PRESENCE, NONE

• When you use the Zone 2 speakers (see
page 107)
Select “ZONE2” to set the function of the speakers
to the Zone 2 speakers. This unit drives the Zone 2
speakers by using the internal amplifier.
• When you want to use another front
speaker system in Zone B
Select “ZONE B”.
• When you use the presence speakers (see
page 13)
Select “PRESENCE” to set the function of the
speakers to the presence speakers.
• When you do not use the EXTRA SP
terminals
Select “NONE” to deactivate the EXTRA SP
terminals.
Note

6

Press 8l / h to select the desired setting of
“EQ”.
Parametric equalizer type EQ
Parametric equalizer adjusts the level of the specified
frequency bands. This unit automatically selects the
crucial frequency bands for the listening room and
adjusts the level of the selected frequency bands to
create a cohesive sound field in the room. You can
select the type of the parametric equalizer adjustment
from the following choices.
Choices: NATURAL, FLAT, FRONT
• Select “NATURAL” to average out the frequency
response of all speakers with higher frequencies
being all speakers to achieve more natural sound.
Recommended if the FLAT setting sounds a little
harsh.
• Select “FLAT” to average the frequency response
of all speakers. Recommended if all of your
speakers are of similar quality.
• Select “FRONT” to adjust the frequency response
of each speaker in accordance with the sound of
your front speakers. Recommended if your front
speakers are of much higher quality than your other
speakers.

PREPARATION

• When you use the alternative front speaker
system (see page 43)
Select “FRONT B”.

• “RELOAD” or “UNDO” is available only when you have
previously run “AUTO SETUP” and confirmed the results.
• “RELOAD” or “UNDO” is not available when you change
the setting of “BI-AMP” in the advanced setup (see
page 112) or “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” in “BASIC MENU”
(see page 87).

If you select “ON” in “BI-AMP” (see page 112), you cannot
select “PRESENCE” or “ZONE2” in “EXTRA SP ASSIGN”.

5

Press 8l / h to select “SETUP” and then
press 8n.
Choices: AUTO, RELOAD, UNDO, DEFAULT
• Select “AUTO” to automatically run the entire
“AUTO SETUP” procedure.
• Select “RELOAD” to reload the last “AUTO
SETUP” settings and override the previous
settings.
• Select “UNDO” to undo the last “AUTO SETUP”
settings and restore the previous settings.
• Select “DEFAULT” to reset the “AUTO SETUP”
parameters to the initial factory settings.

English

33 En

Optimizing the speaker setting for your listening room (YPAO)

7

Press 8n to select “START” and then press
8ENTER to start the setup procedure.
The following message appears in the OSD.
When this unit starts the automatic setup procedure,
loud test tones are output at the speakers.
For more accurate measurements, keep quiet and
move to the wall where speakers are not around. We
recommend that you leave the listening room during
the automatic setup procedure.

9

Make sure that the following screen appears
and then press 8ENTER to display the
result screen.
AUTOSETUP

Measurement Complete

Press [ENTER]

NOTICE
Loudtesttonesare
output.


Pleasekeepquiet
orleavetheroom.

AUTOSETUP


RESULT
SP :
3/4/0.1
DIST: 14.0/17.0ft
LVL : -9.0/+6.5dB
. > SET CANCEL

Press[ENTER]




Once you perform the next operation, this unit starts
the automatic setup procedure.

8

Press 8ENTER to start the automatic setup
procedure.
The following screen appears in the OSD and setup
procedure starts in 10 seconds.
AUTOSETUP

MeasurementStart
in 9seconds

[RETURN]:Cancel

Loud test tones are output from each speaker during
the auto setup procedure. Once all items are set, the
“RESULT” display appears in the OSD.

[ ]/[ ]:Up/Down
[ENTER]:Enter

The results displayed under “RESULT” are as
follows:
Number of speakers SP
Displays the number of speakers connected to this
unit in the following order:
Front/Back/Subwoofer
Speaker distance DIST
Displays the speaker distance from the listening
position in the following order:
Closest speaker distance/Farthest speaker distance
Speaker level LVL
Displays the speaker output level in the following
order:
Lowest speaker output level/Highest speaker output
level

Notes
• During the automatic setup procedure, do not perform any
operation on this unit.
• We recommend that you get out of the room while this unit
is in the auto setup procedure. It takes approximately 3
minutes for this unit to complete the auto setup procedure.

y
Press 8k to cancel the automatic setup procedure.

34 En

Notes
• The signal output at the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT 2 jack
is the same as the one output at the SUBWOOFER PRE
OUT 1 jack. Therefore, even if you connect two
subwoofers, the number of the connected subwoofer is
indicated as “0.1”.
• If “E-10:INTERNAL ERROR” appears during the testing
procedure, restart from step 4.
• If you selected other than “AUTO” in step 5, no test tones
are output.
• If an error occurs during the “AUTO SETUP” procedure,
the setup procedure is canceled and an error screen
appears. For details, see “If an error screen appears” on
page 36.
• When this unit detects potential problems during the
“AUTO SETUP” procedure, “WARNING” and the
number of warning messages appears in the above of
“RESULT” (see page 36).
• Depending on the listening environment, “SWFR
PHASE:REV” appears during the automatic procedure
and “SUBWOOFER PHASE” in “SOUND MENU” (see
page 89) is automatically set to “REVERSE”.

Optimizing the speaker setting for your listening room (YPAO)

10

Notes

Press 8k and then 8ENTER to display the
setup results in detail.

• The distances displayed in the “DISTANCE” results may
be longer than the actual distance depending on the
characteristics of your subwoofer.
• In the “EQ” results, different values may be set for the
same frequency to provide finer adjustments.

AUTOSETUP
. RESULT
SP :
3/4/0.1
DIST: 14.0/17.0ft
LVL : -9.0/+6.5dB
> SET CANCEL
[ ]/[ ]:Up/Down
[ENTER]:Detail

12

Press 8ENTER to return to the top
result display.
PREPARATION

AUTOSETUP
RESULT



WIRING

RESULT
SP :
3/4/0.1
DIST: 14.0/17.0ft
LVL : -9.0/+6.5dB
. > SET CANCEL

FRONT L;;;;;;;OK

[ ]/[ ]:Up/Down
[ENTER]:Enter
[[]/[[]:Select
[ENTER]:Return

11

13
Press 8l / h repeatedly to toggle between
the setup result displays.
Press 8k / n to toggle between the parameters in a
results.

Make sure the pointer is pointing at “SET”
and “CANCEL” and then press 8l / h to
select “SET” or “CANCEL”.
AUTOSETUP


Results of the speaker
connection and wiring
(WIRING)

RESULT
SP :
3/4/0.1
DIST: 14.0/17.0ft
LVL : -9.0/+6.5dB
. > SET CANCEL
[ ]/[ ]:Up/Down
[ENTER]:Enter

Choices: SET, CANCEL
• Select “SET” to confirm the “AUTO SETUP”
results.
• Select “CANCEL” to cancel the “AUTO SETUP”
results.

Results of the speaker distance
from the listening position
(DISTANCE)

Results of the setting of each
speaker size
(SIZE)

14

Press 8ENTER to confirm your selection.
The following screen appears. Disconnect the
optimizer microphone from this unit. The optimizer
microphone is sensitive to heat. Keep it away from
direct sunlight and do not place it on top of this unit.
AUTOSETUP

Results of the parametric
equalizer of each speaker
(EQ)

AUTOSETUPComplete
Disconnect Microphone
PRESS [ENTER]
[MENU]:Exit

Results of the speaker output level
(LEVEL)

English

y
If you are not satisfied with the results or want to manually
adjust each parameter, use “MANUAL SETUP” (see
page 82).

35 En

Optimizing the speaker setting for your listening room (YPAO)

15

Press 8ENTER to confirm your selection.
The top “SET MENU” screen appears in the OSD.
SET MENU
. ;AUTO SETUP
;MANUAL SETUP
.A;SIGNAL INFO

16

p

p

[ ]/[ ]:Up/Down
[ENTER]:Enter

Press ISET MENU to exit from “SET
MENU”.

■ If “WARNING” appears
When this unit detects potential problems during the
“AUTO SETUP” procedure, “WARNING” appears in the
top result display. Check the warning messages to correct
your speaker settings.
Note
Warnings differ from errors in that warnings do not cancel the
“AUTO SETUP” procedure.

1

y
If you change speakers, speaker positions, or the layout of your
listening environment, run “AUTO SETUP” again to recalibrate
your system.

Make sure the pointer is pointing at
“WARNING” and then press 8ENTER to
display the detailed information about the
warning.
The number on the right of “WARNING” indicates
the number of warning messages.
AUTOSETUP

■ If an error screen appears

. WARNING(3)
RESULT
SP :
3/4/0.1
DIST: 14.0/17.0ft
LVL : -9.0/+6.5dB
>SET CANCEL

Press 8k / n / l / h to select “RETRY” or
“EXIT” and then press 8ENTER.
The following display is an example when “E-9:USER
CANCEL” appears in the OSD.

[ ]/[ ]:Up/Down
[ENTER]:Detail

2

ERROR
. E-9:USER CANCEL
Don't operate
any function

Press 8l / h repeatedly to toggle between
the warning displays.
WARNING

>RETRY

EXIT
W-1:OUTOFPHASE
Reverse Channel
FL
-CENTER
PL
PR
SL
SR
SBL
SBR
[[]/[[]:Select
[ENTER]:Return

[[]/[[]:Select
[ENTER]:Enter

Choices: RETRY, EXIT
• Select “RETRY” to retry the “AUTO SETUP”
procedure.
• Select “EXIT” to exit from the “AUTO SETUP”
procedure.

y
• For details about each warning message, see the “AUTO
SETUP” section in “Troubleshooting” on page 120.
• When the corresponding warning message is not
applicable to a speaker, “––” is displayed instead.
• If “SWFR: TOO LOUD” or “SWFR: TOO LOW” appears
in the “W-3: LEVEL ERROR” display, adjust the volume
level of the subwoofer(s).

y
If “E-5:NOISY” appears, “PROCEED” also appears in the
choices. When you select “PROCEED”, this unit continues the
measurements and settings, but the settings may not be optimal.

3

36 En

Press 8ENTER to return to the top result
display.

SELECTING THE SCENE TEMPLATES

Selecting the SCENE templates
This unit is equipped with 19 preset SCENE templates for
various situations of using this unit. As the initial factory
setting, the following SCENE templates are assigned to
each SCENE button (see page 8):

2

SCENE 1: DVD Viewing
SCENE 2: Disc Listening
SCENE 3: TV Viewing
SCENE 4: Radio Listening

Rotate the RINPUT selector (or set the
operation mode selector to FAMP and then
press 8l / h) to select the desired
template.

DVD MovieView

If you want to use other SCENE templates, you can select
the desired SCENE templates from the SCENE template
library and assign the templates to the selected SCENE
buttons on the front panel and the remote control.
Select the desired SCENE
template

3

Press the SSCENE (or ASCENE) button
again to confirm the selection.
The selected SCENE template is assigned to the
SCENE button.

1

Assign the
SCENE
template to the
SCENE button

SCENE template library
(Image)

Selecting the desired SCENE
template to the SCENE buttons
1

Front panel

or

BASIC
OPERATION

1

1

Remote control

Note
Once the desired SCENE templates are assigned to the
corresponding SCENE buttons, you need to set the input
source of the SCENE template on the remote control. See
page 41 for details.

Press and hold the SSCENE (or ASCENE)
button for 3 seconds.
The indicator on the selected SCENE button on the
front panel starts to flash, and the name of the
currently assigned SCENE template appears in the
front panel display.
3 seconds

3 seconds
or

1

1

Remote control

Front panel

1

Flashes

English

DVD Viewing

37 En

Selecting the SCENE templates

■ Which SCENE template would you like to select?
Which source do you like to
play back?

Video sources
(DVD video,
Recorded video)

Which component do you
like for playback?
DVD

SCENE templates

Default
SCENE buttons

DVD Viewing

1

DVD Movie Viewing
DVD Live Viewing

Music discs (CD, SACD or DVD-Audio)

DVR

DVR Viewing

DVD

Disc Hi-fi Listening
Music Disc Listening
Disc Listening

CD

2

CD Hi-fi Listening
CD Listening
CD Music Listening

Radio programs

TUNER (FM/AM)

Radio Listening

XM

XM Listening

SIRIUS

SIRIUS Listening

iPod or Bluetooth
component

DOCK*

Dock Listening

TV programs

DTV/CBL

TV Viewing

4

3

TV Sports Viewing

Video games

V-AUX*

Action Game Playing
RPG Playing

Vinyl records

PHONO

LP Record Listening

Note
*

When iPod is connected to the Yamaha iPod universal dock or a Bluetooth component is connected to the Bluetooth adapter, this unit
plays back the audio sources input at the DOCK terminal.

y
You can create your original SCENE templates by editing the preset SCENE templates. See page 40 for details.

38 En

Selecting the SCENE templates

■ Preset SCENE templates descriptions
The illustrations of the SCENE button in the following table indicate the assigned SCENE buttons in the default setting.
SCENE template

Input source

Playback mode

Features

DVD Viewing

DVD*

Straight

DVD Movie Viewing

DVD*

MOVIE
Sci-Fi

Select this SCENE template when you play back movies on
your DVD player.

DVD Live Viewing

DVD*

ENTERTAINMENT
Music Video

Select this SCENE template when you enjoy the music live
video on your DVD player.

DVR Viewing

DVR

MOVIE
Drama

Select this SCENE template when you play back movies on
your digital video recorder.

Disc Hi-fi Listening

DVD*

Pure Direct

Select this SCENE template when you enjoy the high fidelity
sound of the music discs on your DVD player.

Music Disc
Listening

DVD*

STEREO
2ch Stereo

Select this SCENE template when you play back music discs
on your DVD player.

Disc Listening

DVD*

STEREO
7ch Stereo

Select this SCENE template when you play back music
sources on your DVD player as the background music.

CD Hi-fi Listening

CD*

Pure Direct

Select this SCENE template when you enjoy the high fidelity
sound of the music discs on your CD player.

CD Listening

CD*

STEREO
7ch Stereo

Select this SCENE template when you play back music discs
on your CD player.

CD Music Listening

CD*

STEREO
2ch Stereo

Select this SCENE template when you play back music source
on your CD player as the background music.

Radio Listening

TUNER

Select this SCENE template when you play back general
contents on the DVD player.

1

BASIC
OPERATION

2

MUSIC ENHANCER Select this SCENE template when you enjoy FM or AM radio
programs.
7ch Enhancer

4

XM Listening

XM

SIRIUS Listening

SIRIUS

MUSIC ENHANCER Select this SCENE template when you enjoy SIRIUS Satellite
Radio programs.
7ch Enhancer

Dock Listening

V-AUX

MUSIC ENHANCER Select this SCENE template when you play back music on
your iPod stationed in a Yamaha iPod universal dock or
7ch Enhancer

MUSIC ENHANCER Select this SCENE template when you enjoy XM Satellite
Radio programs.
7ch Enhancer

Bluetooth component that is connected to the Bluetooth
adapter.

TV Viewing

DTV/CBL

Straight

TV Sports Viewing

DTV/CBL

ENTERTAINMENT
Sports

Select this SCENE template when you enjoy sports programs
on your TV.

Action Game
Playing

V-AUX

ENTERTAINMENT
Action Game

Select this SCENE template when you play action games such
as car racing and FPS games.

RPG Playing

V-AUX

ENTERTAINMENT
Roleplaying Game

Select this SCENE template when you play role-playing
games.

LP Record Listening

PHONO

Pure Direct

Select this SCENE template when you enjoy general
programs on your TV.

3

*

Select this SCENE template when you play back vinyl records
on your turntable.

39 En

English

When the connected DVD player or CD player has the capability of the SCENE control signals and is connected to the REMOTE
OUT jack of this unit, this unit operates the DVD player or CD player worked with the SCENE features.

Selecting the SCENE templates

Creating your original SCENE
templates

3

You can create your original SCENE templates for each
SCENE button. You can refer to the preset 19 SCENE
templates to create the original SCENE templates.
Select the desired SCENE
template

Create an original SCENE
template

Press 8k / n to select the desired parameter
of the SCENE template and then 8l / h to
select the desired value of the selected
parameter.
You can adjust the following parameters for a
SCENE template:
• INPUT: The input source component.
• MODE: The active sound field programs,
“Straight” or “Pure Direct” mode.

4

Press the ASCENE button again to confirm
the edit.

SCENE : DVD Viewing
SCENE : DVD Viewing
INPUT : DVD

y

SCENE template library
(Image)

An asterisk mark (*) appears by the name of the original SCENE
template.

Notes
1

Assign the SCENE
template to the
SCENE button

1

Turn on the video monitor connected to this
unit.

2

Press and hold the desired ASCENE button
for 3 seconds.
The SCENE template customizing screen appears on
the video monitor.

[

SCENE1


.pDVDViewing[
INPUT: DVD
MODE:Straight

[ENTER]:Rename
[SCENE1]:SET
[RETURN]:EXIT

• Once the desired SCENE templates are assigned to the
corresponding ASCENE buttons, you need to set the input
source of the SCENE template on the remote control. See
page 41 for details.
• You can create a customized SCENE template for each SCENE
button, and if you create another customized SCENE template,
this unit overwrites the old customized SCENE template with
the new one.
• The newly created template is only available for the assigned
SCENE button.

■ Rename the SCENE templates
Select the name of the SCENE template at step 3
of “Creating your original SCENE templates” and
then press 8ENTER.

Note
When the SCENE template you want to customize is not
assigned to any of the ASCENE buttons, press 8l / h
repeatedly to recall the desired SCENE template on the
menu screen.

40 En

[

p

SCENE1

RENAME
DVDViewing




[]/[]:Character
[p]/[[]:Position
[ENTER]:SET
[RETURN]:CANCEL

• Press 8k / n to select the desired character.
• Press 8l / h to place an “_” (underscore) under the
space or the desired character.
• Press 9RETURN to cancel the new name.
• Press 8ENTER to confirm the new name.

Selecting the SCENE templates

Using the remote control for the SCENE feature
■ Controlling the input source
components in the SCENE mode
You can operate both this unit and the input source
component by using the remote control. You must set the
appropriate remote control code for each input source in
advance (see page 104).
Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FSOURCE.

1
2

■ Setting the input source of the
customized SCENE template on the
remote control
If you customize the input source of the selected SCENE
template, you must set the input source of the SCENE
template on the remote control to operate the input source
component correctly.
Press the desired ASCENE button on the
remote control.

Press the desired ASCENE button on the
remote control.

2

Press the desired buttons in the * area below
to control the input source component of the
selected SCENE template.

Press and hold the ASCENE button and the
desired input selector button (4).
The BTRANSMIT indicator flashes twice.

3

Keep holding down the buttons pressed in
step 2 until the BTRANSMIT indicator
flashes twice again.

CODE SET

TRANSMIT

POWER

POWER

TV

AV

POWER

STANDBY

Note

SIRIUS

A

DOCK

CBL

V-AUX

DTV

CD

CD-R

DVD

DVR

VCR

PHONO

TUNER

XM

MD

AMP

SOURCE

TV VOL

*

TV CH

VOLUME
TV

TV MUTE

BASIC
OPERATION

1

MUTE

TV INPUT

PROG

ENHANCER

1

2

STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

5

6

MULTI CH IN

AUDIO SEL

9

0

Set to
SOURCE

If the setting of the input source is not successful, the
B TRANSMIT indicator flashes repeatedly. In this case, repeat
the setup procedure.

3

SUR. DECODE

4
PARAMETER

7

8
SLEEP

10

PRESET/CH

ENT

SET MENU

LEVEL
TITLE

MENU

BAND

SRCH MODE
ENTER
A-E/CAT.

RETURN

DISPLAY

MEMORY
INFO

PRG SELECT

REC

SCENE

1

2

3

4

SCENE
buttons

Note
*

These buttons control the input source component. See
page 103 for details of the function of each button.

English

41 En

PLAYBACK

Playback
Caution
Extreme caution should be exercised when you play
back CDs encoded in DTS. If you play back a CD
encoded in DTS on a DTS-incompatible CD player,
you will only hear some unwanted noise that may
damage your speakers. Check whether your CD player
supports CDs encoded in DTS. Also, check the sound
output level of your CD player before you play back a
CD encoded in DTS.

3

Start playback on the selected source
component or select a broadcast station.
• Refer to the operating instructions for the source
component.
• See page 53 for details about FM or AM tuning
instructions.
• See page 60 for details about XM Satellite Radio
tuning instructions.
• See page 65 for details about SIRIUS Satellite
Radio tuning instructions.
• See page 70 for details about iPod operations.
• See page 72 for details about Bluetooth operations.

4

Rotate JVOLUME (or press EVOLUME +/–)
to adjust the volume to the desired output
level.

y
To play DTS-encoded CDs when using a digital audio
connection, set “DECODER MODE” in “INPUT MENU” to
“DTS” before the playback (see page 96).
Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FAMP.

y

Basic procedure
1

Turn on the video monitor connected to this
unit.

5

y
See page 46 to display the input source information on the
video monitor.

2

• See page 52 to adjust the level of each speaker.
• This does not affect the AUDIO OUT (REC) level.
• You can set the initial volume level and maximum volume
level (see page 91).

Rotate the RINPUT selector (or press one
of the input selector buttons (4)) to select
the desired input source.

Rotate the NPROGRAM selector (or press
KPROG l / h repeatedly) to select the
desired sound field program.
The name of the selected sound field program
appears in the front panel display. See page 48 for
details about sound field programs.

The name of the currently selected input source
appears in the front panel display for a few seconds.

Sci-Fi

Available input sources

Currently selected sound field program
MULTI CH

VCR

DVR



V-AUX

DTV/CBL

DVD

MD/CD-R

CD

TUNER

PHONO

XM

SIRIUS

DVD

Currently selected input source

y
The corresponding input selector button on the remote
control for the currently selected input source lights up for
approximately 5 seconds after you press any buttons on the
remote control, showing which source component is
currently being operated.

42 En

Note
Sound field programs cannot be selected when the
component connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks is
selected as the input source (see page 43).

y
• Choose a sound field program based on your listening
preference, not merely on the name of the program.
• When you select an input source, this unit automatically
selects the last sound field program used with the
corresponding input source.
• To display information about the currently selected sound
field program in the OSD, see page 74 for details.

Playback

Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FAMP.

Selecting the MULTI CH INPUT
component
Use this feature to select the component connected to the
MULTI CH INPUT jacks (see page 25) as the input
source.

Selecting the front speaker set
Use this feature to turn the front speaker system (FRONT
A and/or FRONT B) on or off.
Press ASPEAKERS on the front panel
repeatedly to turn on or off the set of front
speakers connected to the FRONT A and/or
EXTRA SP speaker terminals.
The active front speaker set changes as follows.

Rotate the RINPUT selector to select “MULTI
CH” (or press OMULTI CH IN).
“MULTI CH” appears in the front panel display.

FRONT A

OFF

y
Use “MULTI CH” menu in “INPUT MENU” to set the
parameters for MULTI CH INPUT (see page 97).

FRONT B
FRONT A
and
FRONT B

Notes
Sound field programs cannot be selected when the component
connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks is selected as the input
source.

• FRONT A and B or FRONT B setting is not available when
“EXTRA SP ASSIGN” is set to “PRESENCE”, “ZONE 2” or
“NONE” (see page 87).
• Turn off the volume level of this unit when you switch the front
speaker setting.

BASIC
OPERATION

Note

■ Using the Zone B feature
When you set “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” to “ZONE B” (see
page 87), you can use the speakers connected to the
EXTRA SP speaker terminals in another room (Zone B).
Press ASPEAKERS on the front panel
repeatedly to turn on or off the Zone B speakers.
When you activate the Zone B speakers, all the speakers in
the main room are muted.
Note
If you select the sound field program and activate the Zone B
speakers, Virtual CINEMA DSP activates automatically (see
page 51).

English

43 En

Playback

Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FAMP.

Selecting audio input jacks
(AUDIO SELECT)

Displaying the current status of
this unit on a video monitor
You can display the operating information of this unit on a
video monitor.

This unit comes with a variety of input jacks. Use this
feature (audio input jack select) to switch between input
jacks when more than one input jack is assigned to the
same input source.
y

1

Turn on the video monitor connected to this
unit.

2

Press JDISPLAY on the remote control.
The current status screen appears in the OSD.

• We recommend that you set the audio input jack select to
“AUTO” in most cases.
• You can adjust the default audio input jack select of this unit by
using “AUDIO SELECT” in “OPTION MENU” (see
page 100).

Press QAUDIO SELECT (or PAUDIO SEL)
repeatedly to select the desired audio input jack
select setting.
Available input sources

MULTI CH

VCR

DVR

V-AUX

DTV/CBL

DVD

MD/CD-R

CD

TUNER

PHONO

XM

Currently selected audio input jack select setting

Function

AUTO

Automatically selects input signals in the
following order:
(1) HDMI
(2) Digital signals
(3) Analog signals

HDMI

Selects only HDMI signals. When HDMI
signals are not input, no sound is output.

COAX/OPT

Automatically selects input signals in the
following order:
(1) Digital signals input at the COAXIAL
jack
(2) Digital signals input at the OPTICAL
jack
When no signals are input, no sound is
output.

ANALOG

Selects only analog signals. If no analog
signals are input, no sound is output.

Note
This feature is not available when no digital input jacks
(OPTICAL, COAXIAL and HDMI) are assigned. In addition,
HDMI is not available as an audio input jack select setting when
the HDMI IN jacks are not used. Use “I/O ASSIGNMENT” in
“INPUT MENU” to reassign the respective input jack (see
page 95).

44 En

y
• You can select the amount of time that the current status is
displayed in the OSD by using the “OSD-AMP”
parameter in “OPTION MENU” (see page 98).
• To turn off the status screen, press JDISPLAY again.

SIRIUS

A.SEL:AUTO

AUDIO SELECT

STATUSVOL:-40.0dB

MOVIE
Sci-Fi

INPUT:DVD
A.SEL:HDMI



[DISPLAY]:STATUSOFF

Note
The OSD signal is not output at the DVR and VCR VIDEO
OUT jacks and will not be recorded.

Playback

Using your headphones

Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FAMP.

Connect a pair of headphones with a stereo
analog audio cable plug to the PHONES jack on
the front panel.

You can combine a video image from a video source with
sound from an audio source. For example, you can enjoy
listening to classical music while viewing beautiful
scenery from the video source on the video monitor.

VOLUME

SPEAKERS

EDIT
SEARCH MODE

BAND

CATEGORY
A/B/C/D/E

PRESET/TUNING/CH

MEMORY

INFO

ZONE 2
ON/OFF

Playing video sources in the
background of an audio source

ZONE
CONTROL

SCENE

1

2

3

4

PROGRAM
SYSTEM OFF

PHONES

TONE CONTROL

INPUT
STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

AUDIO SELECT

VIDEO AUX

OPTIMIZER MIC

STANDBY
/ON

SILENT CINEMA

EFFECT

S VIDEO

VIDEO

L

AUDIO

R

OPTICAL

Press the input selector buttons (4) on the
remote control to select a video source and then
an audio source.
Audio sources

TUNER

XM

DOCK

CBL

V-AUX

DTV

CD

CD-R

DVD

DVR

VCR

PHONO

SIRIUS

MD

When you select a sound field program, SILENT CINEMA mode
activates automatically (see page 51).

Notes

y

DVD

DVR

VCR

MULTI CH IN

Audio sources

Press GMUTE on the remote control to mute the
audio output.
Press GMUTE again to resume the audio output.

CBL

DTV

Video sources

• When you connect headphones, no signals are output at the
speaker terminals.
• All Dolby Digital and DTS audio signals are mixed down to the
left and right headphone channels.

Muting the audio output

DOCK
V-AUX

BASIC
OPERATION

Video sources

y

9

y
• You can also select “MULTI CH” as the audio source (see
page 43). Set the operation mode selector to FAMP and then
press OMULTI CH IN.
• Set the “BGV” parameter in the “MULTI CH” menu to the
desired setting to select the default background video input
source of the MULTI CH INPUT sources (see page 97).

• You can also rotate JVOLUME (or press EVOLUME +/–) to
resume the audio output.
• You can adjust the muting level by using the “MUTE TYPE”
parameter in “VOLUME MENU” (see page 91).
• The MUTE indicator flashes in the front panel display when the
audio output is muted and disappears from the front panel
display when the audio output is resumed.

English

45 En

Playback

Displaying the input source
information
You can display the audio and video information of the
current input signal.

1

Set the operation mode selector to FAMP
and then press ISET MENU on the remote
control.
The top “SET MENU” display appears in the OSD.

Notes
• “–––” appears when this unit cannot display the corresponding
information.
• (U.S.A. model only)
When the HD Radio signals include the flag data, the flag
information appears. We recommend that you select “SUR.
DECODE” to activate the corresponding surround decoder (see
page 79).

■ Video information
Information

SET MENU

HDMI SIGNAL

Type of the source video signals and
the video signals output at the HDMI
OUT jack of this unit.

HDMI RES.

Resolution of the input signal (analog
or HDMI) and the output signal
(HDMI). When input video signals are
composite video or S-video signals,
the input video signals are indicated as
“Composite” or “S-Video”.

ANALOG RES.

Resolution of the analog video signals
output at the COMPONENT VIDEO
MONITOR OUT jacks of this unit.

HDMI ERROR
(HDMI MESSAGE)

Error message for HDMI sources or
connected HDMI devices.

. ;AUTO SETUP
;MANUAL SETUP
.A;SIGNAL INFO

3

p

p

[ ]/[ ]:Up/Down
[ENTER]:Enter

2

Press 8n repeatedly to select “SIGNAL
INFO” and then press 8ENTER.
The audio information about the input source appears
in the OSD.
Press 8l / h to toggle between the audio
and video information displays.

Descriptions

Note

4

Press ISET MENU on the remote control
again to exit from “SET MENU”.

“–––” appears when this unit cannot display the corresponding
information.

HDMI error and message

■ Audio information

Message
Information
FORMAT

Descriptions
Signal format. When this unit cannot detect a
digital signal, it automatically switches to
analog input.

SAMPLING

The number of samples per second taken from
a continuous signal to make a discrete signal.

CHANNEL

The number of source channels in the input
signal (front/surround/LFE). For example, a
multi-channel soundtrack with 3 front
channels, 2 surround channels and LFE, is
displayed as “3/2/0.1”.

BITRATE

The number of bits passing a given point per
second.

FLAG

Flag data encoded in DTS, Dolby Digital, or
PCM signals that cue this unit to automatically
switch decoders (“Surround EX”, etc.).

46 En

Cause

DEVICE OVER

The number of the connected HDMI
components is over the limit.

HDCP ERROR

HDCP authentication failed.

Out of Res.

Out of resolution. The connected monitor is
not compatible with the resolution of the
input video signal.

Playback

■ Canceling the sleep timer

Using the sleep timer
Use this feature to automatically set the main zone to the
standby mode after a certain amount of time. The sleep
timer is useful when you are going to sleep while this unit
is playing or recording a source. The sleep timer also
automatically turns off any external components
connected to the AC OUTLETS (see page 28).

Press HSLEEP on the remote control repeatedly
until “SLEEP OFF” appears in the front panel
display.
Disappears

Note

SLEEP

Even if this unit is in the standby mode, this unit does not cut off
the power to AC OUTLETS while charging connected iPod (see
page 28).

SLEEP 120min
SLEEP OFF

The SLEEP indicator turns off, and “SLEEP OFF”
disappears from the front panel display after a few
seconds.
y
The sleep timer setting can also be canceled by pressing
CSTANDBY (or KMAIN ZONE ON/OFF) to set the main
zone to the standby mode.

BASIC
OPERATION

Set the operation mode selector to FAMP and
then press HSLEEP repeatedly to set the
amount of time.
Each time you press HSLEEP, the front panel display
changes as shown below.

OFF

SLEEP 90min

SLEEP 30min

SLEEP 60min

The SLEEP indicator flashes while you are switching the
amount of time for the sleep timer. Once the sleep timer is
set, the SLEEP indicator lights up in the front panel
display, and the display returns to the selected sound field
program.
Flashes

SLEEP

SLEEP 120min.
Lights up

SLEEP

Straight

English

47 En

SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS

Sound field programs
This unit is equipped with a variety of precise digital decoders that allow you to enjoy multi-channel playback from
almost any stereo or multi-channel sound source. This unit is also equipped with a Yamaha digital sound field processing
(DSP) chip containing several sound field programs which you can use to enhance your playback experience.

Selecting sound field programs
Rotate the NPROGRAM selector (or set the
operation mode selector to FAMP and then
press KPROG l / h repeatedly).
The name of the selected sound field program appears in
the front panel display and in the OSD.

Notes
• When you select an input source, this unit automatically selects
the last sound field program used with the corresponding input
source.
• Sound field programs cannot be selected when the component
connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks is selected as the
input source (see page 43).
• When you play back the Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus,
DTS-HD Master Audio, or DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
sources, this unit does not activate any sound field program.
• When the sampling frequency of the input sources are higher
than 96 kHz, this unit does not apply any sound field programs.

Sound field program descriptions
y
Select a sound field program based on your listening preference, not merely on the name of the program, etc.

■ For audio music sources
y
For audio music sources, we also recommend that you use the Pure Direct mode (see page 52).

Notes
• The available sound field parameters differ depending on the settings of the speakers.
• “DIALG.LIFT” is available only when “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” in “SPEAKER SET” is set to “PRESENCE” (see page 87).

CLASSICAL
Program

Descriptions

Hall in Munich

This sound field simulates a concert hall with approximately 2500 seats in Munich, using stylish
wood for the interior finishing as normal standards for European concert halls. Fine, beautiful
reverberations spread richly, creating a calming atmosphere. The listener’s virtual seat is at the
center left of the arena.

Hall in Vienna

This is an approximately 1700-seated, middle-sized concert hall with a shoebox shape that is
traditional in Vienna. Pillars and ornate carvings create extremely complex reflections from all
around the audience, producing a very full, rich sound.

Chamber

This program creates a relatively wide space with a high ceiling like an audience hall in a palace. It
offers pleasant reverberations that are suitable for courtly music and chamber music.

48 En

Sound field programs

LIVE/CLUB
Program

Descriptions

Cellar Club

This program simulates a live house with a low ceiling and homey atmosphere. A realistic, live sound
field features powerful sound as if the listener is in a row in front of a small stage.

The Roxy Theatre

This is the sound field of a rock music live house in Los Angeles, with approximately 460 seats. The
listener’s virtual seat is at the center left of the hall.

The Bottom Line

This is the sound field at stage front in The Bottom Line, that was a famous New York jazz club once.
The floor can seat 300 people to the left and right in a sound field offering real and vibrant sound.

■ For various sources
Notes
• The available sound field parameters and the created sound fields differ depending on the input sources and the settings of this unit.
• “DIALG.LIFT” is available only when “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” in “SPEAKER SET” is set to “PRESENCE” (see page 87).

ENTERTAINMENT
Program

Descriptions

Action Game

This sound field has been suitable for action games such as car racing and FPS games. It uses the
reflection data that limits the effects range per channel in order to offer a powerful playing environment
with a being-there feeling by enhancing various effects tones while maintaining a clear sense of
directions.

Roleplaying Game

This sound field has been suitable for role-playing and adventure games. It combines the sound field
effects for movies and the sound field designs for “Action Game” to represent the depth and 3D feeling of
the field during play, while offering movie-like surround effects in the movie scenes in the game.

Music Video

This sound field offers an image of a concert hall for live performance of pop, rock and jazz music. The
listener can indulge oneself in a hot live space thanks to the presence sound field that emphasizes the
vividness of vocals and solo play and the beat of rhythm instruments, and to the surround sound field that
reproduces the space of a big live hall.

BASIC
OPERATION

Sports

This program allows the listeners to enjoy stereo sport broadcasts and studio variety programs with
enriched live feeling. In sports broadcasts, the voices of the commentator and sportscaster are positioned
clearly at the center while the atmosphere of the stadium expands in an optimum space to offer the
listeners with a feeling of presence in the stadium.

■ For movie sources
y
You can select the desired decoder used with following sound field program (except “Mono Movie”). See page 79 for details.

Notes
• The available sound field parameters and the created sound fields differ depending on the input sources and the settings of this unit.
• “DIALG.LIFT” is available only when “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” in “SPEAKER SET” is set to “PRESENCE” (see page 87).

MOVIE
Program

Descriptions

Spectacle

This program represents the spectacular feeling of large-scale movie productions.
It reproduces a broad theater sound field matching the cinemascope and wider-screen movies with an
excellent dynamic range from very small to extremely large sound.

Sci-Fi

This program clearly reproduces the finely elaborated sound design of the latest science fiction and
special effects-featuring movies.
You can enjoy a variety of cinematographically created virtual spaces reproduced with clear separation
between dialog, sound effects and background music.

49 En

English

Standard

This program creates a sound field emphasizing the surrounding feeling without disturbing the original
acoustic positioning of multi-channel audio such as Dolby Digital and DTS. It has been designed with the
concept of “an ideal movie theater”, in which the audience is surrounded by beautiful reverberations from
the left, right and rear.

Sound field programs

Program

Descriptions

Adventure

This program is ideal for precisely reproducing the sound design of action and adventure movies.
The sound field restrains reverberations but puts emphasis on reproducing a powerful space expanded
widely to the left and right. The reproduced depth is also restrained relatively to ensure the separation
between audio channels and the clarity of the sound.

Drama

This sound field features stable reverberations that match a wide range of movie genres from serious
dramas to musicals and comedies. The reverberations are modest but offer an optimum 3D feeling,
reproducing effects tones and background music softly but cubically around clear words and center
positioning in a way that does not fatigue the listener even after long hours of viewing.

Mono Movie

This program is provided for reproducing monaural video sources such as a classic movie in an
atmosphere of a good old movie theater.
The program produces the optimum expansion and reverberation to the original audio to create a
comfortable space with a certain sound depth.

Note
The available parameters differ depending on the input sources and the settings of this unit.

STEREO
Program

Descriptions

2ch Stereo

Use this program to mix down multi-channel sources to 2 channels.

7ch Stereo

Use this program to output sound from all speakers. When you play back multi-channel sources, this unit
downmixes the source to 2 channels, and then outputs the sound from all speakers. This program creates
a larger sound field and is ideal for background music at parties, etc.

■ The Compressed Music Enhancer
MUSIC ENHANCER
Program

Descriptions

Straight Enhancer

Use this program to enhance the sound nearest to the original depth and width of the 2-channel or multichannel compression artifacts.

7ch Enhancer

Use this program to play back compression artifacts in 7-channel stereo.

■ Surround decode mode
SUR. DECODE
Program

Sur. Decoder

50 En

Descriptions
Select this program to playback sources with selected decoders. You can playback 2-channel sources on
multi-channels. See page 79 for details.

Sound field programs

■ Using sound field programs without
surround speakers
(Virtual CINEMA DSP)
Virtual CINEMA DSP allows you to enjoy the CINEMA
DSP programs without surround speakers. It creates
virtual speakers to reproduce the natural sound field.
When you set “SUR. L/R SP” to “NONE” (see page 88),
Virtual CINEMA DSP activates automatically whenever
you select a sound field program (see page 48).
Note
Virtual CINEMA DSP will not activate even when “SUR. L/R
SP” is set to “NONE” (see page 88) in the following cases:
– when the component connected to the MULTI CH INPUT
jacks is selected as the input source (see page 43).
– when headphones are connected to the PHONES jack.
– when this unit is in the “7ch Stereo” mode.

SILENT CINEMA allows you to enjoy multi-channel
music or movie sound, including Dolby Digital and DTS
sources, through ordinary headphones. SILENT CINEMA
activates automatically whenever you connect headphones
to the PHONES jack while listening to sound field
programs (see page 48). When activated, the SILENT
CINEMA indicator lights up in the front panel display.

Enjoying unprocessed input
sources (Straight decoding mode)
When this unit is in the “Straight” mode, 2-channel stereo
sources are output from only the front left and right
speakers. Multi-channel sources are decoded straight into
the appropriate channels without any additional effect
processing.
Press OSTRAIGHT (or NSTRAIGHT) to select
“Straight”.

■ Deactivating the “Straight” mode
Press OSTRAIGHT (or NSTRAIGHT) so that
“Straight” disappears from the front panel
display.
The sound effect is turned back on.

BASIC
OPERATION

■ Enjoying multi-channel sources and
sound field programs with headphones
(SILENT CINEMA)

Before performing the following operation, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FAMP.

Notes
• SILENT CINEMA does not activate when the component
connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks is selected as the
input source (see page 43).
• SILENT CINEMA is not effective when the “Pure Direct” (see
page 52) or “2ch Stereo” mode (see page 50) is selected, or
when this unit is in the “Straight” mode (see page 51).

English

51 En

USING AUDIO FEATURES

Using audio features
Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FAMP.

Adjusting the speaker level
You can adjust the output level of each speaker while
listening to a music source. This is also possible when
playing sources input at the MULTI CH INPUT jacks.
Note
This operation will override the level adjustments made in
“AUTO SETUP” (see page 32) and “SP LEVEL” (see page 89).

1

Press 7LEVEL on the remote control and
then 8k / n repeatedly to select the speaker
you want to adjust.

Enjoying pure hi-fi sound
Use the Pure Direct mode to enjoy the pure high fidelity
sound of the selected source. When the Pure Direct mode
is activated, this unit plays back the selected source with
the least circuitry.
Press PPURE DIRECT (or QPURE DIRECT)
to turn the Pure Direct mode on or off.
The PPURE DIRECT button on the front panel lights up
while this unit is in the Pure Direct mode. The front panel
display automatically dims.
Notes

FRONT L

Front left speaker

FRONT R

Front right speaker

• The following operations are not possible when this unit is in
the Pure Direct mode:
– switching the sound field program
– displaying the OSD
– adjusting the “SET MENU” parameters (except for level
settings)
– operating video functions (video conversion, etc.)
• The Pure Direct mode is automatically canceled whenever this
unit is turned off.

CENTER

Center speaker

y

SUR. L

Surround left speaker

The front panel display turns on momentarily when an operation
is performed.

SUR. R

Surround right speaker

SBL

Surround back left speaker

SBR

Surround back right speaker

SWFR

Subwoofer

PRNS L

Presence left speaker

Speaker and headphone adjustments are stored independently.

PRNS R

Presence right speaker

1

Press MTONE CONTROL on the front panel
repeatedly to select the high-frequency
response (TREBLE) or the low-frequency
response (BASS).

2

Rotate the NPROGRAM selector to adjust
the high-frequency response (TREBLE) or
the low-frequency response (BASS).
Control range: –6 dB to +6 dB

Display

Adjusted speaker

Adjusting the tonal quality
Use this feature to adjust the balance of bass and treble for
the front left and right speaker channels.
y

y
• The available speaker channels differ depending on the
setting of the speakers.
• When the video monitor is turned on, the “LEVEL”
adjustment menu appears in the video monitor.

2

3

Press 8l / h to adjust the speaker output
level.
• Press 8h to increase the value.
• Press 8l to decrease the value.
Control range: –10.0 dB to +10.0 dB
Press 7LEVEL to turn off the speaker level
adjustment display.

52 En

Notes
• If you increase or decrease the high-frequency or the lowfrequency sound to an extreme level, the tonal quality of the
surround speakers may not match.
• TONE CONTROL is not effective when PURE DIRECT is
selected, or when MULTI CH INPUT is selected as the input
source.

FM/AM TUNING

FM/AM tuning
Overview
You can use two tuning modes to tune into the desired FM/AM station:
Frequency tuning mode (AUTO TUNING/MANUAL TUNING)
You can search or specify the frequency of the desired FM/AM station automatically or manually (see “Basic tuning
operations” on this page).
Preset tuning mode (PRESET TUNING)
You can preset the desired FM/AM station in advance, and then recall the station by specifying the preset group and
number (see “Using station preset feature” on page 54).
Note
Orient the connected FM and AM antennas for the best reception.

Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FSOURCE and then
press 4TUNER.

1

Rotate the RINPUT selector (or press
4TUNER) to select “TUNER” as the input
source.

BASIC
OPERATION

Manual tuning mode (MANUAL TUNING)
Use this feature if the signal from the station you
want to select is weak and you cannot tune by using
the automatic tuning. When this unit is in the manual
tuning mode, “MANUAL TUNING” appears in the
front panel display for a moment.

Basic tuning operations

AFM 88.9MHz
No colon (:)

y

2

Press CBAND (or 7BAND) to select the
reception band.
“FM” or “AM” appears in the front panel display.

3

Press BSEARCH MODE (or ISRCH
MODE) to select the desired tuning mode.

• Manually tuning into an FM station automatically
switches the tuner to monaural reception to increase the
signal quality.
• (U.S.A. model only)
If you tune into a hybrid HD Radio station by using the
manual tuning mode, this nit automatically selects the
analog radio service. You cannot select the HD Radio
audio programs (see page 57) and display the HD Radio
information (see page 58).

Automatic tuning mode (AUTO TUNING)
Use this feature when the signal from the station you
want to select is strong.
When this unit is in the automatic tuning mode,
“AUTO TUNING” appears in the front panel display
for a moment. The AUTO indicator appears in the
front panel display.
Lights up

AUTO

AFM 88.9MHz
No colon (:)

Preset tuning mode (PRESET TUNING)
Use this feature to recall the preset stations. When
this unit is in the preset tuning mode, “PRESET
TUNING” appears in the front panel display for a
moment. Frequency tuning is not possible. See
page 54 for details.

4

Press EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h (or
8PRESET/CH k / n) repeatedly to tune into
the desired station.
• Press Eh (or 8k) to tune into a higher
frequency.
• Press El (or 8n) to tune into a lower frequency.
English

53 En

FM/AM tuning

y
• When this unit is tuned into a station, the TUNED indicator
lights up.
• Hold down the button to continue searching when this unit is in
the manual tuning mode.
• Press GINFO (or 0INFO) repeatedly to toggle the frequency
information and sound field program information in the front
panel.
• (U.S.A. model only)
If the station that this unit is tuned into is an HD Radio station,
you can toggle the HD Radio information in the front panel
display by pressing GINFO (or 0INFO) repeatedly. See
page 58 for details.
• (U.S.A. model only)
If the station that you tune this unit into is the HD Radio station,
the HD indicator also appears in the front panel display. See
page 57 for details about the HD Radio features.

Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FSOURCE and then
press 4TUNER.

Using station preset feature
Use this feature to store up to 40 stations FM/AM stations
(A1 to E8: 8 preset station numbers in each of the 5 preset
station groups). Preset the desired stations to this unit by
using the automatic or manual preset tuning features in
advance (see “Automatic station preset” and “Manual
station preset” on page 55).
Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FSOURCE and then
press 4TUNER.

1

Press BSEARCH MODE (or ISRCH
MODE) repeatedly to select “PRESET
TUNING”.

2

Press EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h (or
8PRESET/CH k / n) to select the desired
preset station number (A1 to E8).
The preset station group and number appear in the
front panel display along with the station band and
frequency.

■ Direct frequency tuning
Use this feature tune into the desired station directly by
entering the frequency.

1

2

Press 7BAND on the remote control
repeatedly to select the desired reception
band.
“FM” or “AM” appears in the front panel display.
Press BSEARCH MODE (or ISRCH
MODE) repeatedly to select “AUTO TUNING”
or “MANUAL TUNING”.

A1:FM 88.9MHz
Preset group and preset station number

y
You can select the preset station group (A to E) by pressing DA/
B/C/D/E (or 8A-E/CAT. l / h) repeatedly.

Note

AFM 88.9MHz
No colon (:)

y
If a colon (:) appears in the front panel display, manual
tuning is not possible. Press BSEARCH MODE (or
ISRCH MODE) to turn the colon (:) off.

3

Enter the frequency of the desired station by
pressing the numeric buttons (6).
Example: To tune into 103.7 MHz

1

0

3

7

y
If the entered frequency is out of the range of the FM/AM tuning,
“WRONG STATION!” appears in the front panel display and
then this unit automatically tunes into the last selected station.

54 En

• (U.S.A. model only)
When you recall one of the sub-audio program (HD2 to HD8)
of an FM HD Radio station, it takes a few seconds for this unit
to recall the desired program. While this unit recalls the subaudio program, this unit outputs the sound of the analog service
of the station.
• (U.S.A. model only)
If the selected sub-audio program is currently not available, this
unit is tuned into the main audio program, and if the main audio
program is also not available, this unit is tuned into the analog
service.

FM/AM tuning

■ Automatic station preset
You can use the automatic preset tuning feature to store up
to 40 FM stations with strong signals (A1 to E8: 8 preset
station numbers in each of the 5 preset station groups) in
order.
(U.S.A. model only)
You can use the automatic preset tuning feature to store up
to 40 AM HD Radio, FM HD Radio, and analog FM radio
stations with strong signals.

1

Rotate the RINPUT selector (or press
4TUNER) to select “TUNER” as the input
source.

(U.S.A. model)

2

(Canada model)

2

3

Press CBAND (or 7BAND) to select “FM”
as the reception band.
“FM” appears in the front panel display.

• (U.S.A. model only)
When this unit stores the FM HD Radio stations with this
feature, this unit stores only the main audio program of the
stations (HD1). When you want to store the sub-audio programs
of the FM HD Radio stations, preset the stations manually.
• Any stored station data existing under a preset station number is
cleared when you store a new station under the same preset
station number.
• If the number of received stations does not reach 40 (E8),
automatic preset tuning automatically stops after searching for
all the available stations and copy the stored stations to the rest
preset station numbers.
• (Canada model only)
Only FM stations with sufficient signal strength are stored
automatically by automatic preset tuning. If the station you
want to store is weak in signal strength or an AM radio station,
tune into it manually and store it as described in “Manual
station preset” below.

■ Manual station preset
Use this feature to store the AM or FM stations with weak
signals manually.
(U.S.A. model only)
You can store the analog AM/FM radio stations and AM/
FM HD Radio stations manually, and you can also store
the sub-audio programs of FM HD Radio station.

1

BASIC
OPERATION

Press CBAND (or 7BAND) to select the
desired reception band.
“FM” or “AM” appears in the front panel display.
This unit searches the stations in the selected band
and then another band.

Notes

Tune into a station.
See page 53 for tuning instructions.
y

Press and hold FMEMORY (or
9MEMORY) for more than 3 seconds.
The preset station number as well as the MEMORY
and AUTO indicators flashes. After approximately 5
seconds, automatic presetting starts from the current
frequency and proceeds toward higher frequencies.
Flash

(U.S.A. model only)
To store a sub-audio program of the HD Radio station (HD2
to HD8), press 0PRG SELECT b / a repeatedly to
select the desired audio program (see page 57).

2

Press FMEMORY (or 9MEMORY).
The MEMORY indicator flashes in the front panel
display for approximately 30 seconds.

MEMORY
AUTO

MEMORY

A1:FM 88.9MHz

Flashes

Flashes

When automatic preset tuning is completed, the
MEMORY indicator disappears.

y
To cancel the preset memory mode, press FMEMORY (or
9MEMORY) again.

y

English

• You can specify the preset number from which this unit stores
FM stations. Press DA/B/C/D/E (or 8A-E/CAT. l / h) and
then EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h
(or 8PRESET/CH k / n) repeatedly after you perform step 3
to select the preset station number under which the first station
will be stored.
• To cancel the automatic station preset, press FMEMORY (or
9MEMORY) again.

55 En

FM/AM tuning

3

■ Exchanging preset stations
Press EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h (or
8PRESET/CH k / n) repeatedly to select a
preset station group and number (A1 to E8)
while the MEMORY indicator is flashing.
• Press Eh (or 8k) to select a higher preset
station group and number.
• Press El (or 8n) to select a lower preset station
group and number.
Flashes

You can exchange the assignments of two preset stations
with each other. The example below describes the
procedure to exchange preset station “E1” with “A5”.
Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FSOURCE and then
press 4TUNER.

1

Select preset station “E1” using DA/B/C/D/E
and EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h.
See “Using station preset feature” on page 54.

2

Press and hold BEDIT for more than 3
seconds.
“E1” and the MEMORY indicator flash in the front
panel display.

MEMORY

A1:FM 88.9MHz
The displayed station has been stored as A1.

y
You can select the preset station group (A to E) by pressing
DA/B/C/D/E (or 8A-E/CAT. l / h) repeatedly.

4

Press FMEMORY (or 9MEMORY) while
the MEMORY indicator is flashing.
The station band and frequency appear in the front
panel display with the preset station group and
number you have selected. The MEMORY indicator
disappears from the front panel display.

Flashes

MEMORY

E1:FM 88.9MHz
Flashes

3

Notes
• Any stored station data existing under a preset station number is
cleared when you store a new station under the same preset
station number.
• The reception mode (stereo or monaural) is stored along with
the station frequency.

Select preset station “A5” using DA/B/C/D/E
and EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h.
“A5” and the MEMORY indicator flash in the front
panel display.
See “Using station preset feature” on page 54.
Flashes

MEMORY

A5:FM 88.9MHz
Flashes

4

56 En

Press BEDIT again.
“EXCHANGE E1-A5” appears in the front panel
display and the assignments of the two preset stations
are exchanged.

USING HD RADIO™ FEATURES (U.S.A. MODEL ONLY)

Using HD Radio™ features (U.S.A. model only)
HD Radio technology is a new technology that enables FM and AM radio stations to broadcast programs digitally.
Digital broadcasting provides listeners with radically improved audio quality and reception as well as new data services.
Furthermore, supplemental program services allow listeners to select from up to 8 HD Radio programs multicast on a
single FM HD Radio channel. For further information on HD Radio technology, visit “http://www.ibiguity.com/”.
This unit is equipped with an HD Radio reception feature, facilitating CD quality FM broadcasts as well as analog FM
stereo quality AM broadcasts. In addition, this unit can receive both audio and data (such as song titles, artist names,
program types, and comments) from supplemental program services (HD1 to HD8).
y
When the HD Radio signals include the audio signal flag data (“Neural”, etc.), the flag information appears in the “SIGNAL INFO”
screen (see page 46). We recommend that you select “SUR. DECODE” as the sound field program and activate the surround decoder
corresponding to the flag information (see page 80).

Notes

Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FSOURCE and then
press 4 TUNER.

Selecting HD Radio™ audio
programs
Use this feature to select one of the 8 HD Radio audio
programs (HD1 to HD8) when the unit is in the tuner
mode. Each audio program contains data programs.
When the selected FM HD Radio station provides some
audio programs, currently selected audio program number
appears in the front panel display as follows.
HD

AFM88.9MHz2
Currently selected audio program

Press 0PRG SELECT b / a on the remote
control repeatedly to toggle between HD Radio
audio programs.
The HD indicator may disappear from the front panel
display while toggling between data programs.

BASIC
OPERATION

• The tuning method for HD Radio stations are same as analog FM/AM radio stations; however, if you tune into a hybrid HD Radio
station by using the manual tuning mode, this unit automatically selects the analog radio service. Use the automatic tuning mode,
preset tuning mode, or direct frequency tuning to tune into the desired HD Radio station (see pages 53 and 54).
• This unit is capable of receiving both hybrid and all-digital HD Radio station signals. However, this unit may not automatically receive
all-digital FM station signals and the automatic tuning operation may stop. In this case, enter the frequency of the desired all-digital
FM HD Radio station directly by using the numeric buttons (6) (see page 54).

y
You can also select the desired HD Radio audio program by
pressing the numeric key. While this unit is in the automatic or
manual tuning mode, press a numeric button (1-8) (6) and then
HENT.

Notes
• Only 1 HD Radio audio program (HD1) is available for AM
broadcasts, while up to 8 audio programs (HD1 to HD8) are
available for FM broadcasts. The audio programs from HD2 to
HD8 can be selected only when they contain data programs.
• When reception for an audio program ceases, the HD indicator
disappears from the front panel display and HD1 is
automatically selected after approximately 20 seconds.
• Some audio programs may not contain data programs
depending on the broadcasting station and the time period.

English

57 En

Using HD Radio™ features (U.S.A. model only)

Displaying HD Radio™ information
Use this feature to display the HD Radio information in
the front panel display or video monitor.

■ Front panel display

■ Video monitor
Press JDISPLAY on the remote control.
The following information is displayed in the video
monitor.

TUNERInformationANT:
Press GINFO (or 0INFO) repeatedly to toggle
between the following HD Radio information
displays.
STATION INFO 1

e.g.) A

FM 88.9MHz2

Preset station group and number/Frequency/Audio
program (only when multiple audio programs are
available)

STATION INFO 2

e.g.) WXYZ-FM <2/3>

Station name/Audio program (only when multiple audio
programs are available)

[1]
[2]

A1:FM88.9MHz2PRESET
WXYZ-FMHD<2/3>
:ClassicRock
:FrankieZipper

[3]

:RoadtoIndia

[4]

:Made-to-order

[5]
[6]
[7]
[8]

[1] Preset station Category and number/
frequency/Audio program (only when multiple
audio programs are available)
[2] Program category
[3] Song title
[4] Album title

CATEGORY INFO

e.g.) Classic Rock

Program category

SONG INFO

[5] Antenna reception level
[6] Tuning mode (see page 53)

e.g.) Frankie Zipper

[7] Station name/Audio program (only when
multiple audio programs are available)
[8] Artist name

Artist name/Song title

y
ALBUM INFO

e.g.) Made-to-order

Album title

ANTENNA INFO

e.g.) ANTENNA

-

Antenna reception level

DSP PROG. INFO

e.g.) The Bottom Line

Sound field program

Back to “STATION INFO 1”

y
• You can set the front panel display mode by using “FL
SCROLL” in “DISPLAY SET” (see page 98).
• Press 8ENTER repeatedly to hold and release the current HD
Radio information. While this unit is holding the information,
the HOLD indicator flashes in the front panel display.

58 En

• To turn off the displayed information screen, press
JDISPLAY again.
• Press 8 ENTER repeatedly to hold and release the current HD
Radio information. While this unit is holding the information,
the “HOLD” appears in the OSD.
• You can set the time for which the HD Radio information is
displayed in the video monitor by using the “OSD-SOURCE”
parameter in “Manual Setup” (see page 98).
• The current HD Radio reception level appears on the top of the
HD Radio information screen. For the best reception, adjust the
orientation of the antenna so that “
” or “
” is displayed
here.
• When this unit is tuned into an analog FM/AM radio station,
“TUNER Information” appears as follows.
TUNERInformationANT:
A1:FM98.7MHzPRESET
AAAA____ANALOG
:
:
:
:

XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING

XM Satellite Radio tuning
XM Radio offers an extraordinary variety of commercial-free music, plus the best in premier sports, news, talk radio,
stand-up comedy, children’s and entertainment programming. XM is broadcast in superior digital audio quality from
coast to coast. From rock to reggae, from classical to hip hop, XM has something for every music fan.
XM Satellite Radio online information
For U.S. customers: http://www.xmradio.com/
For Canadian customers: http://www.xmradio.ca/

Note
The XM Satellite Radio service is only available in the 48 contiguous United States (not available in Alaska and Hawaii) and Canada.

XM READY legal disclaimer

BASIC
OPERATION

XM monthly service subscription sold separately. XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock required (each sold separately) to receive XM
service. It is prohibited to copy, decompile, disassemble, reverse engineer, hack, manipulate or otherwise make available any
technology or software incorporated in receivers compatible with the XM Satellite Radio System. Installation costs and other fees
and taxes, including a one-time activation fee may apply. All fees and programming subject to change. Channels with frequent
explicit language are indicated with an XL. Channel blocking is available for XM radio receivers by calling 1-800-XM-RADIO (US
residents) and 1-877-GET-XMSR (Canadian residents). For a full listing of the XM commercial- free channels and advertisingsupported channels, visit lineup.xmradio.com (US residents) or xmradio.ca (Canadian residents). Subscriptions subject to Customer
Agreement available at www.xmradio.com (US residents) and www.xmradio.ca (Canadian residents). Only available in the 48
contiguous United States and Canada. ©2008 XM Satellite Radio Inc. All rights reserved. All other trademarks are the property of
their respective owners.

■ Enjoying XM HD Surround content
This unit is equipped with the Neural Surround decoder that plays back the XM HD surround sound content of the XM
Satellite Radio broadcasts in multi-channels, resulting in a full surround sound experience (see page 80).

Connecting the XM Mini-Tuner Dock
Connect the XM Mini-Tuner and the XM Dock (sold
separately) to the XM jack on the rear panel of this unit.
For details, see the operating instructions provided with
the XM Mini-Tuner Dock.
XM Mini-Tuner and XM Dock
(sold separately)

y
To ensure optimal reception of the XM Satellite Radio signals,
the XM Mini-Tuner Dock must be placed at or near a southerly
facing window with no obstacles in the path to the sky. You can
mount it indoors or outdoors. Use the “ANTENNA INFO”
information in the front panel or “XM Information” screen in the
video monitor (see page 63) to check the antenna reception level
and adjust the orientation of the antenna.

Note
If “CHECK ANTENNA” or “CHECK XM TUNER” appears in
the front panel display, the connection and setting of the antenna,
Home Dock, or XM Mini-Tuner may not correct (see page 117).

L

GND R
CD

XM

DIGITAL
OUTPUT

English

PHONO

MD/CD-R

1
SIRIUS

59 En

XM Satellite Radio tuning

Activating XM Satellite Radio
Once you have installed the XM Mini-Tuner Dock,
inserted the XM Mini-Tuner, connected the XM Dock to
your XM Ready® home audio system, and installed the
antenna, you are ready to subscribe and begin receiving
XM programming. There are three places to find your
eight character XM Radio ID: On the XM Mini-Tuner, on
the XM Mini-Tuner package, and on XM Channel 0.
Record the XM Radio ID in the following eight squares
for reference.

Basic XM Satellite Radio
operations
Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FSOURCE.

1

Note

Rotate the RINPUT selector (or press
4XM) to select “XM” as the input source.
The cursor on the left of the XM indicator lights up in
the front panel display and the XM Satellite Radio
information (such as channel number, channel name,
category, artist name, or song title) for the currently
selected channel appears in the front panel display.
Lights up

The XM Radio ID does not use the letters “I”, “O”, “S” or “F”.
Activate your XM Satellite Radio service in the U.S. online at
http://activate.xmradio.com/ or call 1-800-XM-RADIO (1-800967-2346). Activate your XM Satellite Radio service in Canada
online at https://activate.xmradio.ca/ or call 1-877-GET-XMSR
(1-877-438-9677). You will need a major credit card. XM will
send a signal from the satellites to activate the full channel lineup.
Activation normally takes 10 to 15 minutes, but during peak busy
periods you may need to keep your XM Ready home audio
system on for up to an hour. When you can access the full lineup
on your XM Ready home audio system you are done.

MULTI CH

VCR

DVR

V-AUX

DTV/CBL

DVD

MD/CD-R

CD

TUNER

PHONO

XM

SIRIUS

001Preview
y
When you select “XM” as the input source, this unit
automatically recalls the previously selected channel.

Notes
• The XM Satellite Radio signals cannot be output at the
AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks.
• If a status message or an error message appears in the front
panel display or in the OSD, see the “XM Satellite Radio”
section in “Troubleshooting” on page 113 for appropriate
remedies.

2

Search for a channel by using one of the XM
Satellite Radio search modes.
• To select a channel from the all channel list, see
“All Channel Search mode” on page 61.
• To select a channel by category, see “Category
Search mode” on page 61.
• To select a channel from the preset channels, see
“Preset Search mode” on page 61.
• To select the desired channel directly by entering
the channel number, see “Direct number access
mode” on page 61.

y
• You can use the Neural Surround decoder to enjoy the XM HD
surround sound content of the XM Satellite Radio broadcasts in
multi-channels (see page 80).
• You can set the XM Satellite Radio preset channels (see
page 62).
• You can display the XM Satellite Radio information in the front
panel display or in the OSD (see page 63).

60 En

XM Satellite Radio tuning

Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FSOURCE and then
press 4XM.

■ All Channel Search mode

1

2

Press BSEARCH MODE (or ISRCH
MODE) repeatedly to select “ALL CH
SEARCH”.
Press EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h (or
8PRESET/CH k / n) repeatedly to search
for a channel within all channels.

y

3

y
You can also select the preset channel number directly by
pressing the numeric buttons (1 to 8) (6).

■ Direct number access mode

1

Press ISRCH MODE on the remote control
repeatedly to select “ALL CH SEARCH” or
“CAT SEARCH”.

2

Press the numeric buttons (6) to enter the
desired three-digit channel number.
For example, to enter the number 123, press the
numeric buttons (6) as shown below.

• You can search for a channel quickly by pressing and holding
EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h (or 8PRESET/CH k / n).
• To display the XM Radio ID number displayed in the front
panel display, select channel “0”.

Press BSEARCH MODE (or ISRCH
MODE) repeatedly to select “CAT SEARCH”.

2

Press DCATEGORY (or 8A-E/CAT. l / h)
repeatedly to change the channel category.

3

Press EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h (or
8PRESET/CH k / n) repeatedly to search
for a channel within the selected channel
category.

1

2

BASIC
OPERATION

■ Category Search mode

1

Press EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h (or
8PRESET/CH k / n) repeatedly to change
the preset channel number (1 to 8).

3

y
• To enter a one-digit or two-digit channel number, press the
numeric buttons (6) on the remote control and then press
HENT to confirm the input number.
• Instead of pressing HENT to tune into the channel
immediately, you can wait a few seconds until this unit
confirms the entered channel number.
• Pressing a button other than the numeric buttons (6) or HENT
cancels the Direct Number Access mode procedure.

y
You can search for a channel quickly by pressing and holding
EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h (or 8PRESET/CH k / n).

■ Preset Search mode
Prior to selecting a preset channel in the Preset Search
mode, you must preset XM Satellite Radio channels. For
details, see “Setting the XM Satellite Radio preset
channels” on page 62.
y
The initial factory setting of all preset channels (A1 to E8) is “001
Preview”.

Press BSEARCH MODE (or ISRCH
MODE) repeatedly to select “PRESET
SEARCH”.

2

Press DCATEGORY (or 8A-E/CAT. l / h)
repeatedly to change the preset channel
group (A to E).

English

1

61 En

XM Satellite Radio tuning

Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FSOURCE and then
press 4XM.

3

Setting the XM Satellite Radio
preset channels

Press EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h
(or 8PRESET/CH k / n) repeatedly to select
a preset channel group and number (A1 to
E8) while the MEMORY indicator is flashing.
The preset channel number appears in the front panel
display.
Flashes

You can use this feature to store up to 40 XM Satellite
Radio channels (A1 to E8: 8 preset channel numbers in
each of the 5 preset channel groups). You can then recall
any preset channel easily by selecting the preset channel
group and number as described in “Preset Search mode”
on page 61.

1

C5 043XMU
Selected preset channel group and number

y
Search for a channel you want to set as a
preset channel by using one of the XM
Satellite Radio search modes.
See “Basic XM Satellite Radio operations” on
page 60 for details.

043XMU
Currently selected channel number

2

MEMORY

You can select the preset station group (A to E) by pressing
DA/B/C/D/E (or 8A-E/CAT. l / h) repeatedly.

4

Press FMEMORY (or 9MEMORY) to set
the selected XM Satellite Radio channel as a
preset channel while the MEMORY indicator
is flashing.
A colon (:) appears next to the preset channel number
for confirmation, and the MEMORY indicator turns
off in the front panel display.

Press FMEMORY (or 9MEMORY).
The MEMORY indicator flashes in the front panel
display for approximately 30 seconds.

Colon (:)

MEMORY

Note

Flashes

Once you set a new preset channel, the one previously stored in
the same preset channel group and number is cleared.

Note
You must proceed to and carry out steps 3 through 4 while
the MEMORY indicator is flashing in the front panel
display.

62 En

C5:043XMU

XM Satellite Radio tuning

Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FSOURCE and then
press 4XM.

Displaying the XM Satellite Radio
information
You can display the XM Satellite Radio information (such
as channel number, channel name, category, artist name,
or song title) for the currently selected channel in the front
panel display or in the OSD.
Note
If a status message or an error message appears in the front panel
display or in the OSD, see the “XM Satellite Radio” section in
“Troubleshooting” on page 113 for appropriate remedies.

Press GINFO (or 0INFO) repeatedly to toggle
between the following XM Satellite Radio
information display modes.
CHANNEL INFO

e.g.) 043 XMU

■ Displaying the XM Satellite Radio
information in the OSD
Press JDISPLAY.
The following screen is displayed in the OSD.

XMInformationANT:
[1]
[2]

Channel number/name

CATEGORY INFO

• The front panel display can indicate up to 14 alphanumeric
characters at once. You can set whether to display the XM
Satellite Radio information in the front panel display in a
continuous manner or by 14 alphanumeric characters at once by
using the “FL SCROLL” parameter in “OPTION MENU” (see
page 98).
• If the XM Satellite Radio information contains a character that
cannot be recognized by this unit, the character will be
displayed with a space.
• To hold the current XM Raido information, press 8ENTER on
the remote control while it is being displayed. The HOLD
indicator flashes in the front panel display while you are
holding the XM information. Press 8ENTER again to release
the held information.
• When the antenna of the XM Mini-Tuner Dock cannot receive
the signals, “NO SIGNAL” appears in the front panel display.

[3]

ALLCHSEARCH
043:XMU
:Rock
:Coldplay
:Speedofsound

[4]

BASIC
OPERATION

■ Displaying the XM Satellite Radio
information in the front panel display

y

[5]
[6]

e.g.) ROCK

Channel category

[1] Search mode (see page 60)
[2] Channel category

SONG INFO

e.g.) Coldplay / Sp

Artist name / Song title

[3] Song title
[4] Antenna reception level
[5] Channel number/name

ANTENNA INFO

e.g.) 043

ANT:

Channel number/Antenna reception level

DSP PROG. INFO

e.g.) 7ch Enhancer

Sound field program

Back to “CHANNEL INFO”

-

[6] Artist name
y

63 En

English

• To turn off the OSD, press JDISPLAY again.
• XM status messages also appear in the OSD.
• You can select the amount of time the XM Satellite Radio
information is displayed in the OSD by using the “OSDSOURCE” parameter in “OPTION MENU” (see page 98).
• To hold the XM Satellite Radio information, press 8ENTER
on the remote control while it is being displayed in the OSD.
“HOLD” appears in the screen while you are holding the XM
information. Press 8ENTER again or change the XM Satellite
Radio channel to release the held information.
• The current XM Satellite Radio reception level appears on the
top of the XM Satellite Radio information screen. For the best
reception, adjust the orientation of the antenna of Home Dock
so that “
” or “
” is displayed here. “
” is displayed if
the antenna cannot receive the signals correctly. In this case,
adjust the orientation of the antenna (see page 59).

SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIO™ TUNING

SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ tuning
SIRIUS Satellite Radio provides over 130 channels of exclusive entertainment and 100% commercial-free music. Only
SIRIUS has more than 65 original music channels, from today’s hits to R&B, oldies, and classical masterpieces. From
authentic country and real bluegrass to cool jazz, hot latin, reggae, rock and many more. Best of all, it’s all 100%
commercial-free.
SIRIUS also has more than 55 channels of world-class sports, news and entertainment. Included as part of your
subscription, you get up to 16 NFL games a week, up to 40 NBA games a week and up to 40 NHL games a week. (Games
are broadcast during their respective seasons.)
Coupled with great sports news from ESPN, the SIRIUS sports offering is unrivaled. And don't forget a host of other
great news and entertainment, like NPR, CNBC, Fox News, Radio Disney and E! Entertainment Radio. For more
information, visit http://www.sirius.com/.
SIRIUS Satellite Radio legal disclaimer
SIRIUS is available in the U.S.A. for subscribers with addresses in the continental U.S.A. and is available in Canada for subscribers
with a Canadian address. To Get SIRIUS Satellite Radio a subscription and compatible tuner and antenna are required and sold
separately. Visit sirius.com for the most complete and up-to-date channel lineup and information.
“SIRIUS” and the SIRIUS dog logo and related marks are trademarks of SIRIUS Satellite Radio Inc.

Connecting the SiriusConnect™
tuner
Connect the SiriusConnect tuner (sold separately) to the
SIRIUS jack on the rear panel of this unit. For details, see
the operating instructions provided with the SiriusConnect
tuner.
SiriusConnect™ tuner and the antenna
(sold separately)

y
• To ensure optimal reception of the SIRIUS Satellite Radio
signals, the antenna of the SiriusConnect tuner must be placed
at or near a window with no obstacles in the path to the sky. The
orientation of the antenna for the best reception differs
depending on the area. Refer to the instruction manuals
supplied with the SiriusConnect tuner for the installation of the
antenna.You can mount it indoors or outdoors.
• Use the “ANTENNA INFO” information in the front panel or
“SIRIUS Information” screen in the video monitor (see
page 69) to check the antenna reception level and adjust the
orientation of the antenna.
• You need to connect the SiriusConnect tuner to the AC wall
outlet.

Notes

L
T
AN

GND R

DC

PHONO

CD

XM

DIGITAL
OUTPUT

5V

MD/CD-R

1
SIRIUS

To the AC wall outlet
FM

64 En

• If “CHECK SR TUNER” or “ANTENNA ERROR” appears in
the front panel display, the connection of the SiriusConnect
tuner or antenna is incorrect. In such cases, check the
connection of the SiriusConnect tuner and the antenna (see
page 118).
• If “NOT SUPPORTED” appears in the front panel display, this
unit does not support the connected SiriusConnect tuner.

SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ tuning

Activating SIRIUS Satellite
Radio™ subscription
Before using the SIRIUS Satellite Radio feature, you need
to activate your SIRIUS Satellite Radio subscription. To
activate the subscription you need the Sirius ID which is
uniquely assigned to the SiriusConnect tuner. Sirius ID is
12-digit number and it appears on the package of the
SiriusConnect tuner, on the label of the SiriusConnect
tuner, and when you tune into the SIRIUS Satellite Radio
channel “0” (see below).

Basic SIRIUS Satellite Radio™
operations
Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FSOURCE.

1

■ Displaying the Sirius ID of your
SiriusConnect tuner

1

Set the operation mode selector on the
remote control to FSOURCE and then press
4SIRIUS.

Rotate the RINPUT selector (or press
4SIRIUS) to select “SIRIUS” as the input
source.
The cursor on the left of the SIRIUS indicator lights
up in the front panel display and the SIRIUS Satellite
Radio information (such as channel number, channel
name, category, artist name, or song title) for the
currently selected channel appears in the front panel
display.
Lights up

2

Press 60 and then HENT to display the
Sirius ID of your SiriusConnect tuner.
“000 Sirius IDxxxxxxxxxxxx” (“xxxxxxxxxxxx”
indicates the 12-digit Sirius ID of your SiriusConnect
tuner) appears in the front panel display.

V-AUX

DTV/CBL

DVD

MD/CD-R

CD

TUNER

PHONO

XM

SIRIUS

y
When you select “SIRIUS” as the input source, this unit
automatically recalls the previously selected channel.

Notes

To scroll the message again, press GINFO (or 0INFO).

• The SIRIUS Satellite Radio signals cannot be output at the
AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks.
• When you have not activated your subscription yet, you
can only select “184” or “000”.
• If a status message or an error message appears in the front
panel display or in the OSD, see the “SIRIUS Satellite
Radio” section in “Troubleshooting” on page 118 for
appropriate remedies.

Write the Sirius ID below.

ID:
Contact SIRIUS Satellite Radio to activate
your subscription.

SIRIUS Satellite Radio online information
Contact for activation
URL: https//activate.siriusradio.com/
Phone: 1-888-539-SIRIUS (1-888-539-7474)

DVR

184 SIRIUS Wea

y

3

VCR

BASIC
OPERATION

MULTI CH

2

y
Status messages appear in the front panel display or video
monitor during the activation. For details, see “SIRIUS Satellite
Radio” section on page 118. Once the activation is finished,
“SUB UPDATED” appears.

Search for a channel by using one of the
SIRIUS Satellite Radio search modes.
• To select a channel from the all channel list, see
“All Channel Search mode” on page 66.
• To select a channel by category, see “Category
Search mode” on page 66.
• To select a channel from the preset channels, see
“Preset Search mode” on page 66.
• To select the desired channel directly by entering
the channel number, see “Direct number access
mode” on page 66.

y

65 En

English

• If you tune into a channel that you do not subscribe, “CALL
888-539-SIRIUS TO SUBSCRIBE” appears in the front panel
display. To scroll the message again, press GINFO (or
0INFO).
• You can set the SIRIUS Satellite Radio preset channels (see
page 67).
• You can display the SIRIUS Satellite Radio information in the
front panel display or in the video monitor (see page 69).

SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ tuning

Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FSOURCE and then
press 4SIRIUS.

■ All Channel Search mode

1

Press BSEARCH MODE (or ISRCH
MODE) repeatedly to select “ALL CH
SEARCH”.

2

Press EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h (or
8PRESET/CH k / n) repeatedly to search
for a channel within all channels.

y
• You can search for a channel quickly by pressing and holding
EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h (or 8PRESET/CH k / n).
• You can skip channels to the previous or next category by
pressing DCATEGORY (or 8A-E/CAT. l / h).

■ Preset Search mode
Prior to selecting a preset channel in the Preset Search
mode, you must preset SIRIUS channels. For details, see
“Setting the SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ preset channels” on
page 67.

1

Press BSEARCH MODE (or ISRCH
MODE) repeatedly to select “PRESET
SEARCH”.

2

Press DCATEGORY (or 8A-E/CAT. l / h)
repeatedly to change the preset channel
group (A to E).

3

Press EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h (or
8PRESET/CH k / n) repeatedly to change
the preset channel number (1 to 8).
y
You can also select the preset channel number directly by
pressing the numeric buttons (1 to 8) (6).

■ Category Search mode

1

Press BSEARCH MODE (or ISRCH
MODE) repeatedly to select “CAT SEARCH”.

2

Press DCATEGORY (or 8A-E/CAT. l / h)
repeatedly to change the channel category.

3

Press EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h (or
8PRESET/CH k / n) repeatedly to search
for a channel within the selected channel
category.

■ Direct number access mode

1

Press ISRCH MODE on the remote control
repeatedly to select “ALL CH SEARCH” or
“CAT SEARCH”.

2

Press the numeric buttons (6) to enter the
desired three-digit channel number.
For example, to enter the number 123, press the
numeric buttons (6) as shown below.

y
You can search for a channel quickly by pressing and holding
EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h (or 8PRESET/CH k / n).

1

2

3

Note
This unit skips the channels when this unit is All Channel Search
mode or Category Search mode in the following cases (it is not
malfunction of this unit):
– the channel is locked (see page 67).
– the channel is out of service.
– you do not subscribe to the channel.

66 En

y
• To display the Sirius ID number displayed in the front panel
display, select channel “0”.
• To enter a one-digit or two-digit channel number, press the
numeric buttons (6) on the remote control and then press
HENT to confirm the input number.
• Instead of pressing HENT to tune into the channel
immediately, you can wait a few seconds until this unit
confirms the entered channel number.
• If no button is pressed within a few seconds after you enter a
one-digit or two-digit number, this unit automatically confirms
the entered channel number.
• If the selected channel is locked, “PIN:___” appears in the front
panel display. Enter the four-digit Parental Lock code number
by using the numeric buttons (6) or press HENT to cancel
(see page 67).

SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ tuning

y

Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FSOURCE and then
press 4SIRIUS.

You can select the preset station group (A to E) by pressing
DA/B/C/D/E (or 8A-E/CAT. l / h) repeatedly.

4

Setting the SIRIUS Satellite
Radio™ preset channels
You can use this feature to store up to 40 SIRIUS Satellite
Radio channels (A1 to E8: 8 preset channel numbers in
each of the 5 preset channel groups). You can then recall
any preset channel easily by selecting the preset channel
group and number as described in “Preset Search mode”
on page 66.

1

001 SIRIUS Hit
Currently selected channel number

2

Press FMEMORY (or 9MEMORY).
The MEMORY indicator flashes in the front panel
display for approximately 30 seconds.

A1:023 Hair Na
Colon (:)

Note
Once you set a new preset channel, the one previously stored in
the same preset channel group and number is cleared.

Setting the Parental Lock
You can use the Parental Lock feature to limit the access
to the desired SIRIUS Satellite channels. This unit
automatically skips the locked channels when this unit is
in the All Channel Search mode or Category Search mode
and you search a channel by pressing EPRESET/
TUNING/CH l / h (or 8PRESET/CH k / n).

■ Setting the code number and the locked
channels

MEMORY

Use this feature to set the Parental Lock code number
(PIN) and select the channels to be locked.

Flashes

Note

1

Set the operation mode selector to FAMP
on the remote control and then press ISET
MENU to display.

2

Press 8n to select “MANUAL SETUP” and
then press 8ENTER.

3

Press 8n repeatedly to select “INPUT
MENU” and then press 8ENTER.

You must proceed to and carry out steps 3 through 4 while
the MEMORY indicator is flashing in the front panel
display.

3

BASIC
OPERATION

Search for a channel you want to set as a
preset channel by using one of the SIRIUS
Satellite Radio search modes.
See “Basic SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ operations” on
page 65 for details.

Press FMEMORY (or 9MEMORY) to set
the selected SIRIUS Satellite Radio channel
as a preset channel while the MEMORY
indicator is flashing.
A colon (:) appears next to the preset channel number
for confirmation, and the MEMORY indicator turns
off in the front panel display.

Press EPRESET/TUNING/CH l / h
(or 8PRESET/CH k / n) repeatedly to select
a preset channel group and number (A1 to
E8) while the MEMORY indicator is flashing.
The preset channel number appears in the front panel
display.
Flashes
MEMORY

English

A1023 Hair Na
Currently selected preset channel group and
number

67 En

SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ tuning

4

Note

Press 8k / n repeatedly to select “SIRIUS”
and then press 8ENTER.
The following menu screen appears.
A)

In the SIRIUS Satellite Radio channel list screen, this unit
outputs the sound of the selected channel even if the channel
is locked. Only the first eight characters of each channel
name are displayed in the list.

SIRIUS
. INPUTRENAME
VOL. TRIM;;;;;0.0dB
PARENTAL LOCK

10

5

p

[

[ ]/[ ]:Up/Down
[ENTER]:Enter

Press 8n repeatedly to select “PARENTAL
LOCK” and then press 8ENTER.
“NEW PIN:0000” appears.

Press 8ENTER to lock the selected
channel.
Check mark appears before the locked channel.
y
When you select the locked channel and press 8ENTER,
this unit unlocks the selected channel.

11

Repeat steps 9 and 10 to lock the channels
you want.

NEWPIN:0000

12

Press 9RETURN to exit from the
“PARENTAL LOCK” screen.

[0] [9]:NUMBER
[ENT]:Enter

13

Press ISET MENU to exit from the setup
menu.
This unit is tuned into the last channel you select in
the “PARENTAL LOCK” screen. If the channel is
locked, this unit is tuned into “184 SIRIUS Weather
& Emergency” or “000 Sirius IDxxxxxxxxxxxx”
(“xxxxxxxxxxxx” indicates the Sirius ID of your
SiriusConnect tuner).

PARENTAL LOCK

Note
If a SiriusConnect tuner is not connected to this unit, “Not
Available” appears.

y
If the Parental Lock code number is already set, “PIN:___”
appears instead of “NEW PIN:0000”. Refer to step 8 and
then proceed the operations.

6

Enter the desired 4-digit code number by
using the numeric buttons (6).
y
Press 9RETURN to return the previous menu level
without setting the code number.

7

Press 8ENTER to confirm the code number.
“OK” and then the SIRIUS Satellite Radio channel
list appears. Refer to the step 9 and then proceed the
operations.

8

Enter the 4-digit code number you set at step
6 above to unlock the protection.
When the code number is correct, “OK” and then the
SIRIUS Satellite Radio channel list appears.

y
• If you forget or want to change the Parental lock code number,
use “SR PIN” in “ADVANCED SETUP” to reset the Parental
Lock code number.
• When you select “ALL” in “INIT” (see page 112), all locked
channels are unlocked.

■ Tuning into the locked channels
You can tune into the locked channels by the Direct
number access mode or preset tuning mode. When you
tune into the locked channel, following message appears
in the front panel display. Enter the code number you set
for the Parental Lock feature by using the numeric buttons
(6) or press HENT to cancel the tuning.

PIN:____
Notes

9

Press 8l / h repeatedly to select the
desired channel category and then press
8k / n repeatedly to select the channel you
want to lock.

68 En

• If the entered code number is incorrect, “Wrong” appears in the
front panel display and this unit is tuned into the previously
selected channel.
• If a channel is unlocked, you can also select the channel in
Zone2.

SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ tuning

Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FSOURCE and then
press 4SIRIUS.

y

If a status message or an error message appears in the front panel
display or in the OSD, see the “SIRIUS Satellite Radio” section
in “Troubleshooting” on page 118 for appropriate remedies.

■ Displaying the SIRIUS Satellite Radio
information in the OSD

■ Displaying the SIRIUS Satellite Radio
information in the front panel display

Press JDISPLAY on the remote control.
The following screen is displayed in the OSD.

Displaying the SIRIUS Satellite
Radio™ information
You can display the SIRIUS Satellite Radio information
(such as channel number, channel name, category, artist
name, composer name, or song title) for the currently
selected channel in the front panel display or in the OSD.

Press GINFO (or 0INFO) repeatedly to toggle
between the following SIRIUS Satellite Radio
information display modes.
CHANNEL INFO

[2]

e.g.) 008 Big '80s

Channel number/name

CATEGORY INFO

[1]

SIRIUSInformationANT:

[5]

ALLCHSEARCH
008:Big'80s
:Pop
:Sanumemo

[6]

[3]

:RoadtoIndia

[4]

C:FrankieZipper

BASIC
OPERATION

Note

• The front panel display can indicate up to 14 alphanumeric
characters at once. You can set whether to display the SIRIUS
Satellite Radio information in the front panel display in a
continuous manner or by 14 alphanumeric characters at once by
using the “FL SCROLL” parameter in “OPTION MENU” (see
page 98).
• If the SIRIUS Satellite Radio information contains a character
that cannot be recognized by this unit, the character will be
displayed with a space.
• To hold the current SIRIUS Satellite Radio information, press
8ENTER on the remote control while it is being displayed.
Press 8ENTER again to release the held information.
• When the antenna of the SiriusConnect tuner cannot receive the
signals, “ACQUIRING” appears in the front panel display.
• When an information is unavailable, “––––” appears.

[7]

e.g.) Pop

[1] Search mode (see page 65)

Channel category

[2] Channel category
[3] Song title
SONG INFO

e.g.) Sanumemo / Roa

[4] Composer name

Artist name / Song title
[5] Antenna reception level
[6] Channel number/name
COMPOSER INFO

e.g.) Frankie Zipper

Composer name

ANTENNA INFO

y

e.g.) 043

ANT:

Channel number/Antenna reception level

DSP PROG. INFO

[7] Artist name

e.g.) 7ch Enhancer

Sound field program

-

Back to “CHANNEL INFO”

69 En

English

• To turn off the OSD, press JDISPLAY again.
• SIRIUS status messages also appear in the OSD.
• You can select the amount of time the SIRIUS Satellite Radio
information is displayed in the OSD by using the “OSDSOURCE” parameter in “OPTION MENU” (see page 98).
• To hold the SIRIUS Satellite Radio information, press
8ENTER on the remote control while it is being displayed in
the OSD. While this unit is holding the information screen,
“HOLD” appears in the OSD.
• The HOLD indicator flashes in the front panel display while
you are holding the SIRIUS information. Press 8ENTER
again or change the SIRIUS Satellite Radio channel to release
the held information.

USING IPOD™

Using iPod™
Once you have stationed your iPod in a Yamaha iPod universal dock (such as YDS-10, sold separately) connected to the
DOCK terminal of this unit (see page 25), you can enjoy playback of your iPod using the supplied remote control. You
can also use the Compressed Music Enhancer mode of this unit to improve the sound quality of the compression artifacts
(such as the MP3 format) stored on your iPod (see page 50).
Notes
• Only iPod (Click and Wheel), iPod nano, and iPod mini are supported.
• Some features may not be compatible depending on the model or the software version of your iPod.

y
• For a complete list of status messages that appear in the front panel display and in the OSD, see the “iPod” section in
“Troubleshooting” on page 119.
• Once the connection between your iPod and this unit is complete, “iPod connected” appears in the front panel display and the DOCK
indicator lights up in the front panel display.
• Only the analog audio and video signals of your iPod are input at the DOCK terminal, and the analog audio signals can be output at the
analog AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks for recording.
• Your iPod battery is automatically charged when your iPod is stationed in a Yamaha iPod universal dock connected to the DOCK
terminal of this unit as long as this unit is turned on. You can also select whether this unit charges the battery of the stationed iPod or
not when this unit is in the standby mode by selecting the “STANDBY CHARGE” parameter in “INPUT MENU” (see page 96). The
DOCK indicator turns on while this unit charges the battery of the connected iPod when this unit is in the standby mode.

Controlling iPod™
You can control your iPod when “V-AUX” is selected as the input source. The operations of your iPod can be done with
the aid of the OSD of this unit (menu browse mode) or without it (simple remote mode).

■ Remote control operation
Before performing the following operations, set the operation
mode selector on the remote control to FSOURCE and then
press 4V-AUX.
Button
8 ENTER

Function
Subsequent menu

k

Menu up

n

Menu down

l

Previous menu

h

Subsequent menu

0 ll

Search backward (Press and hold)

hh

Search forward (Press and hold)

a

Skip forward

b

Skip backward

s

Stop

e

Pause (Menu browse mode)
Play/Pause (Simple remote mode)

p

Play (Menu browse mode)
Play/Pause (Simple remote mode)

I MENU

Previous menu

J DISPLAY

Display

70 En

■ Controlling iPod in the simple remote
mode
You can perform the basic operations of your iPod (play,
stop, skip, etc.) using the supplied remote control without
the aid of the OSD of this unit.
y
• You can view the photos or video clips stored on your iPod
(some models only).
• Operations can be also done with the controls on your iPod.

Using iPod™

■ Controlling iPod in the menu browse
mode
You can perform the advanced operations of your iPod
using the supplied remote control with the aid of the OSD
of this unit. You can browse the songs stored on your iPod
in the OSD. Further, you can change or adjust settings for
your iPod to suit your personal preferences.
y
• The name of the song being played also appears in the front
panel display according to the “FL SCROLL” parameter in
“OPTION MENU” (see page 98).
• You can select the amount of time the iPod menu and play
information is displayed in the OSD by using the “OSDSOURCE” in “OPTION MENU” (see page 98).

Notes

1

Set the operation mode selector to
FSOURCE and then press JDISPLAY on
the remote control.
The following display appears in the OSD.

y
When “Shuffle” is set to a setting other than “Off”, “
” appears
in the top right corner while songs or albums are being shuffled.

Repeat Repeat
Use this feature to set this unit to repeat one song or a
sequence of songs.
Choices: Off, One, All
• Select “Off” to deactivate this feature.
• Select “One” to set this unit to repeat one song.
• Select “All” to set this unit to repeat a sequence of
songs.
y
When “Repeat” is set to a setting other than “Off”, “ ” or “ ”
appears in the top right corner while one song or a sequence of
songs are being repeated.
1

■ The function of the play information
display
[1]

Playlists
Artists
Albums
Songs
Genres
Composers
Settings

Top
>
>
>
>
>
>
>

[3]
[4]
[5]
[6]

2

Press 8k / n / l / h to navigate the iPod
menu and then press 8ENTER to begin
playback of the selected song.
Choices: Playlists (playlists), Artists (artists), Albums
(albums), Songs (songs), Genres (genres),
Composers (composers), Settings (settings)
• Playlists > Songs
• Artists > Albums > Songs
• Albums > Songs
• Songs
• Genres > Artists > Albums > Songs
• Composers > Albums > Songs
• Settings > Shuffle, Repeat

iPod[Play]
1/9

FrankieZipper
Made-to-order
RoadtoIndia



||;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;
0:51-7:44
All

[2]
iPod

All

BASIC
OPERATION

• Operations cannot be done with the controls on your iPod.
• There are some characters that cannot be displayed in the front
panel display or in the OSD of this unit. Those characters are
replaced with underscores “_”.
• The “Settings” parameters can be changed or adjusted only in
the OSD. Press 8ENTER or 8k/n repeatedly on the remote
control to toggle between the “Settings” parameter settings.
• You cannot browse the photos or video clips stored on your
iPod in the OSD. Use the simple remote mode to enjoy
watching the photos or video clips stored on your iPod.

Shuffle Shuffle
Use this feature to set this unit to play songs or albums in
random order.
Choices: Off, Songs, Albums
• Select “Off” to deactivate this feature.
• Select “Songs” to set this unit to play songs in random
order.
• Select “Albums” to set this unit to play albums in
random order.

[1]

Playback status

[2]

Track number/total tracks

[3]

Artist name

[4]

Song title

[5]

Progress bar

[6]

Elapsed time

[7]

Shuffle and repeat icons

[8]

(playback),
forward) and

[9]

Name of the album

[7]
[8]

[9]

[10]

(pausing),
(search
(search backward)
English

[10] Remaining time

71 En

USING BLUETOOTH™ COMPONENTS

Using Bluetooth™ components
You can connect a Yamaha Bluetooth adapter (such as YBA-10, sold separately) to the DOCK terminal of this unit and
enjoy the music contents stored in your Bluetooth component (such as a portable music player) without wiring between
this unit and the Bluetooth component. You need to perform “pairing” the connected Bluetooth adapter and your
Bluetooth component in advance.

Pairing the Bluetooth™ adapter
and your Bluetooth component
Pairing must be performed when using a Bluetooth
component with the Bluetooth adapter connected to this
unit for the first time or if the pairing data has been
deleted. “Pairing” refers to the operation of registering a
Bluetooth component for Bluetooth communications.

Note
If the Bluetooth adapter is not connected to the DOCK
terminal of this unit, “No BT adapter” appears in the front
panel display.

4

Check that the Bluetooth component detects
the Bluetooth adapter.
If the Bluetooth component detects the Bluetooth
adapter, “YBA-10 YAMAHA” (example) appears in
the Bluetooth device list.

5

Select the Bluetooth adapter in the Bluetooth
device list and then enter the pass key
“0000” on the Bluetooth component.
When the pairing procedure is successful,
“Completed” appears in the front panel display.

y
• You only need the pairing operation for the first time that you
use the Bluetooth component with the Bluetooth adapter.
• Pairing requires operations on this unit and on the other
component with which Bluetooth communications are to be
established. If necessary, refer to the other component’s
operating instructions.

There are two pairing methods: pairing by using “START
PAIRING” in “SET MENU” and quick pairing.

■ Pairing by using “SET MENU”
Use this feature to perform pairing with the video monitor.
Select “START PAIRING” in “INPUT MENU”. See
page 97 for details.

■ Quick pairing
To ensure security, a time limit of 8 minutes is set for the
pairing operation. You are recommended to read and fully
understand all the instructions before starting.

1

Rotate the RINPUT selector (or set the
operation mode selector to FSOURCE and
then press 4V-AUX) to select “V-AUX” as
the input source.

2

Turn on the Bluetooth component you want
to pair with.

3

Press and hold CBAND (or 7BAND) for 3
seconds to start pairing.
Once the Bluetooth adapter starts pairing,
“Searching...” appears for a moment. While the
Bluetooth adapter is in the pairing mode, DOCK
indicator flashes in the front panel display.
y
To cancel the pairing, press CBAND (or 7BAND) again.

72 En

Note
The Yamaha Bluetooth adapter can be paired with up to eight
Bluetooth components. When pairing is conducted successfully
with a ninth component and the pairing data is registered, the
pairing data for the least recently used other component is
cleared.

Playback of the Bluetooth™
component
1

Rotate the RINPUT selector (or set the
operation mode selector to FSOURCE and
then press 4V-AUX) to select “V-AUX” as
the input source.

2

Start playback of your Bluetooth component.
When the connected Bluetooth adapter detects the
Bluetooth component, “BT connected” and the
DOCK indicator appears in the front panel display.

y
• When you press 8ENTER on the remote control, the
connected Bluetooth adapter searches and connect to the last
connected Bluetooth component. If the Bluetooth adapter
cannot find the Bluetooth component, “Not found” appears in
the front panel display.
• To disconnect the Bluetooth adapter from the Bluetooth
component, press 9RETURN.

RECORDING

Recording
Recording adjustments and other operations are performed from the recording components. Refer to the operating
instructions for those components.
Caution
The DTS signal is a digital bitstream. Attempting to digitally record the DTS bitstream will result in noise being
recorded. Therefore, if you want to use this unit to record sources encoded in DTS, the following considerations and
adjustments need to be made. To play DTS-encoded DVDs and CDs (when using a digital audio connection) on your
DTS-compatible player, follow its operating instructions to make a setting so that the analog signal will be output
from the player.
Notes

BASIC
OPERATION

• When this unit is set to the standby mode, you cannot record between other components connected to this unit.
• TONE CONTROL (see page 52) and VOLUME settings, the speaker level (see page 52) and the sound field programs (see page 48)
do not affect recorded material.
• The source connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks of this unit cannot be recorded.
• The XM Satellite Radio and SIRIUS Satellite Radio signals cannot be output at the AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks.
• HD Radio signals can be output at the analog AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks and DIGITAL OUTPUT jack for recording.
• Digital signals input at the DIGITAL INPUT jacks are not output at the analog AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks for recording. Likewise,
analog signals input at the AUDIO IN jacks are not output at the DIGITAL OUTPUT jack. Therefore, if your source component is
connected to provide only digital or analog signals, you can only record digital or analog signals.
• A given input source is not output on the same AUDIO OUT (REC) channel.
• S-video and composite video signals pass independently through the video circuits of this unit. Therefore, when recording or dubbing
video signals input from a video source component that provides only an S-video or a composite video signal, you can only record an
S-video or a composite video signal on your VCR.
• The analog audio signals input at the DOCK terminal can be output at the analog AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks for recording.
• Check the copyright laws in your country to record from CDs, radio, etc. Recording of copyrighted material may infringe copyright
laws.

y
Do a test recording before you start an actual recording.

If you play back a video source that uses scrambled or encoded signals to prevent it from being dubbed, the picture
itself may be disturbed due to those signals.

1

Turn on all the connected components.

2

Rotate the RINPUT selector (or press one
of the input selector buttons (4)) to select
the source component you want to record
from.

3

Start playback on the selected source
component or select a broadcast station.

4

Start recording on the recording component.

English

73 En

ADVANCED SOUND CONFIGURATIONS

Advanced sound configurations
Changing sound field parameter
settings
You can enjoy good quality sound with the initial factory
settings. Although you do not have to change the initial
factory settings, you can change some of the parameters to
better suit the input source or your listening room.

3

Press KPROG l / h repeatedly to select
the desired sound field program you want to
adjust.

4

Press 8k / n to select the desired sound
field parameter and then 8l / h to change
the selected sound field parameter value.
• Press 8h to increase the value.
• Press 8l to decrease the value.

Note
You cannot change the sound field parameter values when
“MEMORY GUARD” in “OPTION MENU” is set to “ON” (see
page 100). If you want to change the sound field parameter
values, set “MEMORY GUARD” to “OFF”.

1

Turn on the video monitor connected to this
unit.

2

Set the operation mode selector to FAMP
and then press RPARAMETER on the
remote control.
The following screen is shown in the OSD.
Sound field program category
MOVIE

Cursor

.

y
• For details about the function and control range of each sound
field parameter, see page 76.
• When you set a sound field parameter to a value other than the
initial factory settings, an asterisk mark (*) appears by the
sound field parameter name in the OSD.
• Repeat steps 3 and 4 as necessary to change other sound field
program parameter settings.
• The available sound field parameters for some of the sound field
programs may be displayed on more than one page in the OSD.
In this case, press 8k / n to scroll through pages.
• To initialize the parameters of the selected sound field program,
press 8n repeatedly to select “INITIALIZE” and then press
8h. Once the confirmation screen appears in the OSD, press
8h to confirm or 8l to cancel the initialization.

1/2
MOVIE

Sci-Fi
SUR.;;PLIIx Movie
DSP LEVEL;;;;;0dB
P.INIT.DLY;;;16ms
P.ROOM SIZE;;;1.0
S.INIT.DLY;;;16ms
S.ROOM SIZE;;;1.0

2/2

Sci-Fi
SB INIT.DLY;;15ms
SB ROOM SIZE ;;1.0
DIALOG LIFT;;;;;0
. INITIALIZE

[p]/[[]: Select
[[]: Initialize

Sound field parameters Sound field parameter
values

5

74 En

Press RPARAMETER to turn off the sound
field parameter screen.

Advanced sound configurations

■ Basic configuration of sound field
programs
Each sound field program has some parameters defining
the characteristics of the program. To customize the
selected sound field program, adjust “DSP LEVEL” and/
or “DIALG.LIFT” first, and then try other parameters.

Adjusting the vertical dialogue position
(DIALG.LIFT)
Use this feature to adjust the vertical position of the
dialogues in movies. The ideal position of the dialogues is
at the center of the video monitor screen.

y
To change sound field parameter settings, see page 74 for details.

Adjusting the effect sound level of the sound
field programs (DSP LEVEL)
Sound field programs add effect sounds (DSP effect
sounds) to the original source sound to create sound field
in the listening room. Use the “DSP LEVEL” parameter to
adjust the level of the effect sounds.

The DSP effect
sound level is low.

The DSP effect sound
level is high.

Increase the value of “DSP LEVEL”
• The effect sound of the selected sound field
program is too weak.
• You cannot recognize any difference between the
sound field programs.

If the dialogues are heard at the lower position of the video
monitor screen, increase the value of “DIALG.LIFT”.

Move up to the ideal dialogue position.

Choices: 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5
“0” (initial setting) is the lowest position, and “5” is the
highest position.
Notes

ADVANCED
OPERATION

Adjust “DSP LEVEL” in the following cases:

The ideal
dialogue
position.

• “DIALG.LIFT” is only available only “EXTRA SP ASSIGN”
is set to “PRESENCE” (see page 72).
• You cannot move the dialogue position down from the initial
dialogue position.

Decrease the value of “DSP LEVEL”
• The sound is vague.
• You feel that the additional sound effect is
excessive.
Control range: –6 dB to +3 dB

English

75 En

Advanced sound configurations

■ Sound field parameters for the advanced configurations
Use the following sound field parameters to customize sound field programs in detail.
y
To change sound field parameter settings, see page 74 for details.
Sound field parameter

INIT.DLY
P.INIT.DLY
S.INIT.DLY
SB INI.DLY

Features
Initial delay. Presence, surround, and surround back sound field initial delay. Changes the
apparent distance from the source sound by adjusting the delay between the direct sound and the
first reflection heard by the listener. The smaller the value, the closer the sound source seems to
the reflection face.
y
When you adjust the initial delay parameters, we also recommend that you adjust the
corresponding room size parameters likewise. This adjustment is especially effective for the
CINEMA DSP programs.
Control range: 1 to 99 ms (INIT.DLY and P.INIT.DLY)
1 to 49 ms (S.INIT.DLY and SB INI.DLY)
Source sound

Level

Level

Level

Early
reflections

Time

Time

Time
Delay

Delay

Delay

Sound source

Reflection face

Small value = 1 ms

76 En

Large value = 99 ms

Advanced sound configurations

Sound field parameter

ROOM SIZE
P.ROOM SIZE
S.ROOM SIZE
SB ROOM SIZE

Features
Room size. Presence, surround, and surround back room size. Adjusts the apparent size of the
surround sound field. The larger the value, the larger the surround sound field becomes. As the
sound is repeatedly reflected around a room, the larger the hall is, the longer the time between
the original reflected sound and the subsequent reflections. By controlling the time between the
reflected sounds, you can change the apparent size of the virtual venue. Changing this parameter
from one to two doubles the apparent length of the room.
y
When you adjust the room size parameters, we also recommend that you adjust the
corresponding initial delay parameters likewise. This adjustment is especially effective for the
CINEMA DSP programs.
Control range: 0.1 to 2.0

Time

Early
reflections

Level

Level

Level

Source sound

Time

Time

Sound source

Small value = 0.1

Liveness. Surround and surround back sound field liveness. Adjusts the reflectivity of the virtual
walls in the hall by changing the rate at which the early reflections decay. The early reflections of
a sound source decay much faster in a room with acoustically absorbent wall surfaces than in one
which has highly reflective surfaces. A room with acoustically absorbent surfaces is referred to
as “dead”, while a room with highly reflective surfaces is referred to as “live”. This parameter
lets you adjust the early reflection decay rate and thus the “liveness” of the room.

ADVANCED
OPERATION

Control range: 0 to 10
Source sound

Time

Small reflected
sound

Small value = 0

Level

Dead

Level

Live
Level

LIVENESS
S.LIVENESS
SB LIVENESS

Large value = 2.0

Time

Time

Large reflected
sound

Large value = 10

English

77 En

Advanced sound configurations

Sound field parameter

REV.TIME

Features
Reverberation time. Adjusts the amount of time taken for the dense, subsequent reverberation
sound to decay by 60 dB at 1 kHz. This changes the apparent size of the acoustic environment
over an extremely wide range. Set a longer reverberation time for “dead” sources and listening
room environments, and a shorter time for “live” sources and listening room environments.
Control range: 1.0 to 5.0 s

Source sound

Reverberation

Reverberation

Early reflections
60 dB

REV.TIME
Sound source

60 dB

60 dB

REV.TIME

REV.TIME

Short
reverberation

Long
reverberation

Small value = 1.0 s

REV.DELAY

Large value = 5.0 s

Reverberation delay. Adjusts the time difference between the beginning of the direct sound and
the beginning of the reverberation sound. The larger the value, the later the reverberation sound
begins. A later reverberation sound makes you feel as if you are in a larger acoustic environment.

Level

Control range: 0 to 250 ms

Source sound

(dB)

60 dB
Reverberation
Time
REV.DELAY

REV.LEVEL

REV.TIME

Reverberation level. Adjusts the volume of the reverberation sound. The larger the value, the
stronger the reverberation becomes.
Control range: 0 to 100%

Level

Source sound

(dB)

REV. LEVEL

Time

78 En

Advanced sound configurations

Sound field parameter

DIRECT

Features
2-channel stereo direct. Bypasses the decoders and the DSP processors of this unit for pure hi-fi
stereo sound when playing 2-channel analog sources.

(“2ch Stereo” only)

Choices: AUTO, OFF
y
• Select “AUTO” to bypass the decoders, the DSP processors and the tone control circuitry only
when “BASS” and “TREBLE” are set to 0 dB (see page 52).
• Select “OFF” not to bypass the decoders, the DSP processors and the tone control circuitry
when “BASS” and “TREBLE” are set to 0 dB.
• When multi-channel signals (Dolby Digital and DTS) are input, they are downmixed to 2
channels and output from the front left and right speakers.
• The low-frequency signals of the front left and right channels are redirected to the subwoofer
in the following cases:
– “LFE/BASS OUT” is set to “BOTH” (see page 87).
– “FRONT SP” is set to “SMALL” (see page 88) and “LFE/BASS OUT” is set to “SWFR”
(see page 87).

CT
SL
SR
SB
PL
PR

LEVEL
LEVEL
LEVEL
LEVEL
LEVEL
LEVEL

7-channel stereo center, surround left, surround right, surround back, presence left and presence
right levels. Adjusts the volume level of each channel in the 7-channel stereo mode. The
available parameters differ depending on the setting of the speakers.
Control range: 0 to 100%

(“7ch Stereo” only)

EFFECT LEVEL
(“Straight Enhancer” and
“7ch Enhancer” only)

Straight and 7-channel Compressed Music Enhancer effect level. The high-frequency signals of
some sources may be emphasized too much. In this case, set the effect level to “LOW”.

ADVANCED
OPERATION

Choices: HIGH, LOW
• Select “HIGH” for a high effect level.
• Select “LOW” for a low effect level.

■ Selecting decoders used with sound
field programs (SUR.)
Use this feature to select the desired decoder used with
MOVIE sound field programs (except “Mono Movie”).
See page 49 for details about MOVIE sound field
program.
Available decoders
Decoder

Functions

PLIIx Movie
PLII Movie

Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro
Logic II) processing for movie
sources. The Pro Logic IIx decoder
is not available when “SUR.B L/R
SP” is set to “NONE” (see page 88).

Neo:6 Cinema

DTS processing for movie sources.

Selecting decoders
■ Selecting decoders for 2-channel
sources (surround decode mode)
Use this feature to play back sources with selected
decoders. You can play back 2-channel sources on multichannels.
Set the operation mode selector to FAMP and
then press MSUR. DECODE repeatedly on the
remote control to select the desired surround
decoder.
You can select from the following modes depending on the
type of source you are playing and your personal
preference.
y

79 En

English

You can change the decoder parameter settings (see page 81). Set
the operation mode to FAMP and then press RPARAMETER
to display the decoder parameters in the OSD. Press 8k / n
repeatedly to select the desired decoder parameter and then press
8l / h repeatedly to change the value of the selected
parameter.

Advanced sound configurations

■ Decoder descriptions (SUR.)
Decoder

Descriptions

Pro Logic

Dolby Pro Logic processing for any sources.

PLIIx Movie
PLII Movie

Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) processing for movie sources. The Pro Logic IIx
decoder is not available when “SUR.B L/R SP” is set to “NONE” (see page 88).

PLIIx Music
PLII Music

Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) processing for music sources. The Pro Logic IIx
decoder is not available when “SUR.B L/R SP” is set to “NONE” (see page 88).

PLIIx Game
PLII Game

is not available when “SUR.B L/R SP” is set to “NONE” (see page 88).

Neo:6 Cinema

DTS processing for movie sources.

Neo:6 Music

DTS processing for music sources.

CSII Cinema

SRS Circle Surround II processing for movie sources.

Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) processing for game sources. The Pro Logic IIx decoder

(U.S.A. model only)

CSII Music

SRS Circle Surround II processing for music sources.

(U.S.A. model only)

Neural Surround processing for any sources.

Neural Sur.
(U.S.A. and Canada models
only)

The Neural Surround decoder is compatible with PCM signals and analog 2-channel input sources.
When Neural Surround-incompatible signals are being input while the Neural Surround decoder is
selected, multi-channel sources are decoded straight into the appropriate channels without any
additional effect processing and the Neural Surround-incompatible PCM signals are played back in
stereo. The Neural Surround decoder is especially suitable for the XM HD Surround program of XM
Satellite Radio.

y
When you select the surround decode mode for Dolby Digital, DTS or DTS 96/24 sources, this unit automatically selects “SURROUND
DECODE Dolby Digital”, “SURROUND DECODE DTS” or “SURROUND DECODE DTS 96/24” program.

80 En

Advanced sound configurations

Decoder parameter descriptions
Decoder parameter

PANORAMA
(“PLIIx Music” and “PLII
Music” only)

Features
Pro Logic IIx Music and Pro Logic II Music panorama. Sends stereo signals to the surround speakers as
well as the front speakers for a wraparound effect.
Choices: OFF, ON

DIMENSION
(“PLIIx Music” and “PLII
Music” only)

Pro Logic IIx Music and Pro Logic II Music dimension. Adjusts the sound field either towards the front
or towards the rear.
Control range: –3 (towards the rear) to +3 (towards the front)
Initial setting: STD (standard)

CENTER WIDTH
(“PLIIx Music” and “PLII
Music” only)

Pro Logic IIx Music and Pro Logic II Music center width. Moves the center channel output completely
towards the center speaker or towards the front left and right speakers. A larger value moves the center
channel output towards the front left and right speakers.
Control range: 0 (center channel sound is output only from the center speaker) to
7 (center channel sound is output only from the front left and right speakers)
Initial setting: 3

C. IMAGE
(“Neo:6 Music” only)

DTS Neo:6 Music center image. Adjusts the front left and right channel output relative to the center
channel to make the center channel more or less dominant as necessary.
Control range: 0.0 (center channel sound is output only from the front left and right speakers) to
1.0 (center channel sound output only from the center speaker)
Initial setting: 0.3

(“CSII Movie” and “CSII
Music” only)

SRS CSII Movie and SRS CSII Music focus. Adjusts the clearness of a sound image by elevating the
perception of the sound image to compensate for non-optimally placed speakers from a lower location.
A larger value makes speakers sound as if they are positioned at ear level.
Control range: 0 (lower location) to 8 (higher location)

TruBass
(“CSII Movie” and “CSII
Music” only)

SRS CSII Movie and CSII Music TruBass. Adjusts the lower register by producing the perception of
improved low frequency performance. A larger value improves bass even without a subwoofer and
provides deeper, richer bass in the presence of a subwoofer.

ADVANCED
OPERATION

FOCUS

Control range: 0 (standard low-frequency performance) to 8 (enhanced low-frequency performance)

English

81 En

CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)
You can use the following parameters in “SET MENU” to adjust a variety of system settings and customize the way this
unit operates. Change the initial settings (indicated in bold under each parameter) to reflect the needs of your listening
environment.

■ Auto setup

AUTO SETUP

Use this feature to automatically adjust speaker and system parameters (see page 32).

■ Manual setup

MANUAL SETUP

Use this feature to manually adjust speaker and system parameters.
Basic menu 1 BASIC MENU
Menu

A)SPEAKER SET

Parameter

Functions

Page

EXTRA SP ASSIGN

Selects the function of the speakers connected to the EXTRA SP
speaker terminal.

87

LFE/BASS OUT

Selects the speakers that output the LFE (low-frequency effect) and the
low-frequency signals.

87

FRONT SP

Selects the size of the front speakers.

88

CENTER SP

Selects the size of the center speaker.

88

SUR. L/R SP

Selects the size and number of the surround speakers.

88

SUR.B L/R SP

Selects the size and number of the surround back speakers.

88

CROSS OVER

Selects the crossover frequency of all the speakers set to “SML” (or
“SMALL”) in “SPEAKER SET” (see page 88).

89

SUBWOOFER PHASE

Switches the phase of your subwoofer if bass sounds are lacking or
unclear.

89

B)SP LEVEL

FR.L/FR.R/CNTR/
SUR.L/SUR.R/
SBL/SBR/SWFR/
PR.L/PR.R

Adjust the balance the speaker levels between the front left or
surround left speakers and each speaker selected in “SPEAKER SET”
(see page 87).

89

C)SP DISTANCE

UNIT

Selects the unit to adjust the speaker distance.

90

FRONT L/FRONT R/
CENTER/SUR. L/
SUR. R/SBL/SBR/
SWFR/PRNS L/
PRNS R

Adjust the distance of each speaker and the delay applied to the
respective channel.

90

Turns the test tone output on or off for the “SPEAKER SET”, “SP
LEVEL”, and “SP DISTANCE” settings.

90

D)TEST TONE

82 En

—

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

Volume menu 2 VOLUME MENU
Parameter

Functions

Page

ADAPTIVE DRC

Selects whether this unit automatically adjusts the dynamic range in conjunction with the
volume level or not.

91

ADAPTIVE DSP LEVEL

Selects whether this unit adjusts the DSP effect level automatically in conjunction with the
volume level or not.

91

MUTE TYPE

Adjusts how much the mute function reduces the output volume (see page 45).

91

MAX VOL.

Sets the maximum volume level of the main zone.

91

INIT. VOL.

Sets the volume level of the main zone when the power of this unit is turned on.

91

Sound menu 3 SOUND MENU
Menu

A)EQUALIZER

Parameter

Functions

Page

Selects the type of equalizer.

92

GEQ

Adjusts the tonal quality of the speakers when you set “EQ TYPE
SELECT” to “GEQ”.

92

TEST

Selects whether this unit outputs the test tone while making
adjustments of “GEQ” or not.

92

SPEAKER

Adjusts the speaker LFE level.

93

HEADPHONE

Adjusts the headphone LFE level.

93

C)DYNAMIC
RANGE

SPEAKER

Adjusts the amount of the dynamic range compression of the speakers.

93

HEADPHONE

Adjusts the amount of the dynamic range compression of the
headphones.

93

D)LIPSYNC

HDMI AUTO

Selects whether this unit activates the automatic audio and video
synchronization function (automatic lip sync) or not.

94

AUTO

Makes fine adjustments of the audio delay when the automatic audio
and video synchronization function is active.

94

MANUAL

Adjustment the audio delay manually when the connected video
monitor is not compatible with the automatic audio and video
synchronization function or “HDMI AUTO” is set to “OFF”.

94

Use this feature to enjoy 6.1/7.1-channel playback for multi-channel
sources using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx, Dolby Digital EX, or DTS-ES
decoders by using the connected surround back speakers.

94

B)LFE LEVEL

E)EXTD SUR.

—

ADVANCED
OPERATION

EQ TYPE SELECT

English

83 En

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

Input menu 4 INPUT MENU
Note
Some parameters described below may not be available for all input sources and some parameters are only available for specific input
sources.
Parameter

Functions

Page

I/O ASSIGNMENT

Assigns the input/output jacks according to the component to be used if the initial settings of
this unit do not correspond to your needs.

95

INPUT RENAME

Changes the name of the input source that appears in the OSD and in the front panel display.

96

VOL. TRIM

Adjusts the level of the signal input at each jack.

96

DECODER MODE

Switches the decoder activation mode. You can designate the reassigned digital input jacks for
DTS signals.

96

STANDBY CHARGE

Selects whether this unit charges the battery of the stationed iPod or not when this unit is in the
standby mode (see page 29).

96

PARENTAL LOCK
(U.S.A. and Canada
models only)

Sets the SIRIUS Parental Lock code number and the channel lock configuration (see page 67)

96

START PAIRING

Pair the connected Yamaha Bluetooth adapter (such as YBA-10, sold separately) with a
Bluetooth component (see page 72).

97

BGV

Selects the video source played back in the background of the sources input at the MULTI CH
INPUT jacks.

97

INPUT CH

Selects the number of channels input from an external decoder.

97

FRONT

Selects the analog jacks at which the front channel signals from an external decoder are input
when you set “INPUT CH” to “8CH”.

97

Option menu 5 OPTION MENU
Menu

A)DISPLAY SET

B)VIDEO SET

84 En

Parameter

Functions

Page

DIMMER

Adjusts the brightness of the front panel display.

98

OSD SHIFT

Adjusts the vertical position of the OSD.

98

OSD-SOURCE

Sets the amount of time to display the HD Radio information (U.S.A.
model only), SIRIUS Satellite Radio information, XM Satellite Radio
information, or iPod menu in the video monitor after you perform a
certain operation.

98

OSD-AMP

Sets the amount of time to display the status information screen after
you perform a certain operation.

98

FL SCROLL

Selects the mode to display the information of the HD Radio
information (U.S.A. model only), SIRIUS Satellite Radio information,
XM Satellite Radio information, or iPod menu in the front panel
display.

98

VIDEO CONV.

Selects whether to convert the video signals input at the VIDEO,
S VIDEO, and COMPONENT VIDEO jacks.

98

HDMI RES.

Selects whether this unit activates the HDMI up-conversion of the
analog video signals input at the VIDEO, S VIDEO, and
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks so that the up-scaled video signals are
output at the HDMI OUT jack.

99

HDMI ASPECT

Adjusts the aspect ratio for analog video signals output at the HDMI
OUT jack.

99

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

Menu

Parameter

Functions

Page

C)MEMORY GUARD

—

Prevents accidental changes to sound field program parameter values
and other system settings.

100

AUDIO SELECT

Designates the default audio input jack select setting for the input
sources connected to the DIGITAL INPUT jacks when you turn on the
power of this unit.

100

DECODER MODE

Designates the default decoder mode for the input sources connected
to the DIGITAL INPUT jacks when you turn on the power of this unit.

100

EXTD SUR.

Designates the extended decoder mode for the input sources connected
to the DIGITAL INPUT jacks when you turn on the power of this unit.

100

E)HDMI SET

S.AUDIO

Selects whether to play back HDMI audio signals on this unit or on
another HDMI component connected to the HDMI OUT jack.

101

F)ZONE2 SET

MAX VOL.

Adjusts the maximum volume level in Zone 2.

101

INIT. VOL.

Sets the volume level of Zone 2 when you turn on the power of this
unit.

101

D)INIT. CONFIG

■ Signal information SIGNAL INFO
Use this feature to check audio and video signal information (see page 46).

ADVANCED
OPERATION
English

85 En

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

4

Use the remote control to access and adjust each
parameter.
y
• You can change the “SET MENU” parameters while this unit is
reproducing sound.
• If you press RPARAMETER during the “SET MENU”
operation, the “SET MENU” operation is canceled.
• Press 9RETURN to return to the previous menu level.

2

Set the operation mode selector to FAMP
and then press ISET MENU to enter “SET
MENU”.
The top “SET MENU” display appears in the OSD.

3 SOUND MENU

. A)EQUALIZER

B)LFE LEVEL
C)DYNAMIC RANGE
D)LIPSYNC
E)EXTD SUR.

[]/[]: Up/Down
[ENTER]: Enter

[

1

Press 8k / n repeatedly and then press
8ENTER to select and enter the desired
menu.
The following displays are examples where “SOUND
MENU” is selected.

5

Press 8k / n to select “MANUAL SETUP”.
SET MENU

p

Using SET MENU

Press 8k / n repeatedly and then press
8ENTER to select and enter the desired
submenu.
The following display is an example where “LFE
LEVEL” is selected.

;AUTO SETUP

. ;MANUAL SETUP
;SIGNAL INFO

B)LFE LEVEL

. SPEAKER;;;;;;0dB
HEADPHONE;;-20dB

p

3

Press 8ENTER to enter “MANUAL SETUP”.
The “MANUAL SETUP” display appears in the
OSD.

6

Press 8k / n to select the desired parameter
and then 8l / h to change the parameter
settings.
• Press 8h to increase the value.
• Press 8l to decrease the value.

7

Press ISET MENU to exit from “SET
MENU”.

MANUAL SETUP

. 1 BASIC MENU
2
3
4
5

VOLUME MENU
SOUND MENU
INPUT MENU
OPTION MENU

86 En

p

[

[]/[]: Up/Down
[ENTER]: Enter

p

[]/[]: Up/Down
[p]/[[]: Adjust

[

[

[]/[]: Up/Down
[ENTER]: Enter

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

1 BASIC MENU
Use this feature to manually adjust the basic speaker
settings. Most of the “BASIC MENU” parameters are set
automatically when you run the automatic setup.

LFE/bass out LFE/BASS OUT
Use this feature to select the speakers that output the LFE
(low-frequency effect) and the low-frequency signals.
A)SPEAKER SET
LFE/BASS OUT

1 BASIC MENU

. A)SPEAKER SET
B)SP LEVEL
C)SP DISTANCE
D)TEST TONE

SWFR

p

[

[]/[]: Up/Down
[ENTER]: Enter

FRONT >BOTH

LFE signals output
Subwoofer(s) and speakers

y
Set “TEST TONE” to “ON” to output the test tone for the
“SPEAKER SET”, “SP LEVEL” and “SP DISTANCE”.

Choice
Subwoofer(s)

Front
speakers

Other
speakers

■ Speaker settings A)SPEAKER SET

BOTH

Output

No output

No output

y

SWFR

Output

No output

No output

To select the desired parameter, press 8k / n repeatedly.

FRONT

No output

Output

No output

Extra speaker assignment EXTRA SP ASSIGN
Selects the function of the speakers connected to the
EXTRA SP terminals.

Subwoofer(s)

Front
speakers

Other
speakers

BOTH

*1

*2

*3

SWFR

*4

*3

*3

FRONT

No output

*1

*3

p

[

Subwoofer(s) and speakers
Choice

*1

Choice

Descriptions

ZONE2

Select this setting when you use the Zone 2
speakers (see page 107).

FRONT B

Select this setting when you use another front
speaker system in the main zone (see page 43).

ZONE B

Select this setting when you use another front
speaker system in another room (see page 43).

PRESENCE

Select this setting when you use the presence
speakers (see page 13).

NONE

Select this setting when you do not use the
EXTRA SP terminals.

*2
*3
*4

ADVANCED
OPERATION

XA)SPEAKER SET
X
EXTRA SP ASSIGN
X
ZONE2 >FRONT B
X
ZONE B PRESENCE
X
NONE
X
X
X
X
ZONE2 SET
XXXX[]/[]:Up/DownXXXXX
Not Available
XXXX[p]/[[]:EnterXXXXXXX
X

Low-frequency signals output

Output(s) the low-frequency signals of the front
channels and other speakers set to “SMALL”.
Always output the low-frequency signals of the front
channels.
Output the low-frequency signals if the speakers are set
to “LARGE”.
Outputs the low-frequency signals of the speakers set to
“SMALL” or “NONE”.

Notes
• This parameter shares the value with the “EXTRA SP
ASSIGN” parameter in “AUTO SETUP” (see page 33).
• If you select “ON” in “BI-AMP” (see page 112), you cannot
select “PRESENCE” or “ZONE2” in “EXTRA SP ASSIGN”.
• After changing the “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” setting, carry out
“AUTO SETUP” again (see page 32).

English

87 En

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

Measure for the speaker size
The woofer section of a speaker is
– 16 cm (6.5 in) or larger: large
– smaller than 16 cm (6.5 in): small

Surround left/right speakers SUR. L/R SP
A)SPEAKER SET
SUR. L/R SP

Front speakers FRONT SP
NONE >SMALL

LARGE

A)SPEAKER SET
FRONT SP

Choice

SMALL

>LARGE

Choice

Descriptions

LARGE

Select this setting when the front speakers are
large.

SMALL

Select this setting when the front speakers are
small.

Descriptions

LARGE

Select this setting when the surround speakers
are large.

SMALL

Select this setting when the surround speakers
are small.

NONE

Select this setting when you do not use the
surround speakers. This unit is set to the Virtual
CINEMA DSP mode (see page 51), and “SUR.B
L/R SP” is automatically set to “NONE”.

Surround back left/right speakers
SUR.B L/R SP

Note
A)SPEAKER SET

When “LFE/BASS OUT” is set to “FRONT”, you can select only
“LARGE” in “FRONT SP”. If the value of “FRONT SP” is set to
other than “LARGE” in advance, this unit change the value to
“LARGE” automatically.

SUR.B L/R SP

SMLx1 >SMLx2

Center speaker CENTER SP
Choice

A)SPEAKER SET

LRGx1

Descriptions

LRGx1

Select this setting when the single surround back
speaker is large.

LRGx2

Select this setting when the surround back left
and right speakers are Large.

SMLx1

Select this setting when the single surround back
speaker is small.

When the center speaker is large:
Select “LARGE” (large).

SMLx2

Select this setting when the surround back left
and right speakers are small.

When the center speaker is small:
Select “SMALL” (small).

NONE

Select this setting when you do not use the
surround back speakers. The surround back
channel signals are directed to the surround left
and right speakers.

CENTER SP

NONE >SMALL

LARGE

When you do not use the center speaker:
Select “NONE” (none). The center channel signals are
directed to the front left and right speakers.
Note
Choice

Descriptions

LARGE

Select this setting when the center speaker is
large.

SMALL

Select this setting when the center speaker is
small.

NONE

Select this setting when you do not use the center
speaker. The center channel signals are directed
to the front left and right speakers.

88 En

If the Dolby TrueHD audio signals are input and “SUR.B L/R
SP” is set to “NONE”, the left and right surround back channels
are not directed to the surround left and right speakers.

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

Bass cross over CROSS OVER
Use this feature to select the crossover frequency of all the
speakers set to “SML” (or “SMALL”) in “SPEAKER
SET” (see page 87). All frequencies below the selected
frequency will be sent to the subwoofer(s) or front
speakers depending on the setting of “LFE/BASS OUT”
in “SPEAKER SET” (see page 87).
Choices: 40Hz, 60Hz, 80Hz, 90Hz, 100Hz, 110Hz,
120Hz, 160Hz, 200Hz
A)SPEAKER SET

■ Speaker level B)SP LEVEL
Use this feature to manually balance the speaker levels
between the front left or surround left speakers and each
speaker selected in “SPEAKER SET” (see page 87).
Control range: –10.0 dB to +10.0 dB
Control step: 0.5 dB
Initial setting:
FR.L/FR.R/SWFR/PR.L/PR.R: 0 dB
CNTR/SUR.L/SUR.R/SBL/SBR: –1.0 dB
B)SP LEVEL

1/2

B)SP LEVEL

2/2

CROSS OVER

. FR.L

. SBL

FR.R
CNTR
SUR.L
SUR.R

SBR
SWFR

FREQ;;;;80Hz

y
If your subwoofer can adjust the output volume and the crossover
frequency, set the volume to about half way (or slightly less) and
set the crossover frequency to the maximum.

Subwoofer phase SUBWOOFER PHASE
Use this feature to switch the phase of your subwoofer if
bass sounds are lacking or unclear.
A)SPEAKER SET

>NORMAL

Choice

REVERSE

Functions

NORMAL
(normal)

Does not change the phase of your subwoofer.

REVERSE
(reverse)

Sets the phase of your subwoofer to reverse.

Adjusted speaker

FR.L

Front left speaker

FR.R

Front right speaker

CNTR

Center speaker

SUR.L

Surround left speaker

SUR.R

Surround right speaker

SBL

Surround back left speaker

SBR

Surround back right speaker

SWFR

Subwoofer

PR.L

Presence left speaker

PR.R

Presence right speaker

ADVANCED
OPERATION

SUBWOOFER PHASE

SP LEVEL

y
• If your subwoofer can adjust the output volume and the
crossover frequency, set the volume to about half way (or
slightly less) and set the crossover frequency to the maximum.
• Set “TEST TONE” to “ON” to output the test tone for the
“SPEAKER LEVEL” setting (see page 90).

Notes
• The available speaker channels differ depending on the setting
of the speakers.
• Instead of “SBL” and “SBR”, “SB” is displayed if “SUR. B L/R
SP” is set to either “SMLx1” or “LRGx1” (see page 88).

English

89 En

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

■ Speaker distance C)SP DISTANCE
Use this feature to manually adjust the distance of each
speaker and the delay applied to the respective channel.
Ideally, each speaker should be the same distance from the
main listening position. However, this is not possible in
most home situations. Thus, a certain amount of delay
must be applied to the sound from each speaker so that all
sounds will arrive at the listening position at the same
time.
1/2

C)SP DISTANCE

■ Test tone D)TEST TONE
Turns the test tone output on or off for the “SPEAKER
SET”, “SP LEVEL”, and “SP DISTANCE” settings.

2/2
D)TEST TONE

. UNIT;;;;;;;;feet

. SBL;;;;;;;;8.0ft

FRONT L;;;10.0ft
FRONT R;;;10.0ft
CENTER;;;;;8.5ft
SUR. L;;;;;8.0ft
SUR. R;;;;;8.0ft

>OFF

SBR;;;;;;;;8.0ft
SWFR;;;;;;;10.0ft
PRNS L;;;;;10.0ft
PRNS R;;;;;10.0ft

[

[]/[]: Up/Down
[p]/[[]: Adjust

p

[]/[]: Up/Down
[p]/[[]: Select

[

• The available speaker channels differ depending on the setting
of the speakers.
• Instead of “SBL” and “SBR”, “SUR.B” is displayed if “SUR.B
L/R SP” is set to either “SMLx1” or “LRGx1” (see page 88).

Unit for the speaker distance adjustment UNIT
Initial setting:
[U.S.A. and Canada models]: feet (ft)
[Other models]: meters (m)
Choice

ON

p

C)SP DISTANCE

Notes

Functions

meters (m)

Adjusts speaker distances in meters.

feet (ft)

Adjusts speaker distances in feet.

[p]/[[]: Select
[ENTER]: Return

Choice

Functions

OFF

This unit does not output the test tone for the
“SPEAKER SET”, “SP LEVEL”, and “SP
DISTANCE” settings.

ON

This unit outputs the test tone for the
“SPEAKER SET”, “SP LEVEL”, and “SP
DISTANCE” settings.

y
Speaker distances
Control range: 0.30 to 24.00 m (1.0 to 80.0 ft)
Control step: 0.10 m (0.5 ft)
Initial setting:
FRONT L/FRONT R/SWFR/PRNS L/PRNS R: 3.00 m
(10.0 ft)
CENTER: 2.60 m (8.5 ft)
SUR. L/SUR. R/SBL/SBR: 2.40 m (8.0 ft)
SP DISTANCE

Adjusted speaker

FRONT L

Front left speaker

FRONT R

Front right speaker

CENTER

Center speaker

SUR. L

Surround left speaker

SUR. R

Surround right speaker

SBL

Surround back left speaker

SBR

Surround back right speaker

SWFR

Subwoofer

PRNS L

Presence left speaker

PRNS R

Presence right speaker

90 En

If you use a handheld sound pressure level meter, hold at arm’s
length and point upwards so that the meter is in the listening
position. With the meter set to the 70 dB scale and to C SLOW,
calibrate each speaker to 75 dB.

Note
This function is automatically turned off if you exit from “BASIC
MENU”.

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

2 VOLUME MENU
Use this menu to manually adjust the various volume
settings.

Adaptive DSP level ADAPTIVE DSP LEVEL
Use this feature to make fine adjustments of the DSP
effect level (see page 75) automatically in conjunction
with the volume level.
Choice

2 VOLUME MENU

AUTO
OFF

Does not adjust the DSP effect level
automatically.

. ADAPTIVE DRC;;;;OFF

ADAPTIVE DSP
LEVEL;;;;OFF
MUTE TYPE;;;;FULL
MAX VOL.;;;;+16.5dB
INIT. VOL.;;;;;;OFF

Functions
Adjusts the DSP effect level in conjunction with
the volume level.

p

[

[]/[]: Up/Down
[p]/[[]: Select

Note

Output level

AUTO

OFF

Input level

OFF

Input level

VOLUME: low

Choice

AUTO

VOLUME: high

Functions

AUTO

Adjusts the dynamic range automatically.

OFF

Does not adjust the dynamic range automatically.

y
• You can also adjust the dynamic range of the bitstream signal
sources by using “DYNAMIC RANGE” in “SOUND MENU”
(see page 93).
• This function is also useful for listening with your headphones.

Note
The adaptive dynamic range control feature does not function
when this unit is in the Pure Direct mode (see page 52).

Even if you set “ADAPTIVE DSP LEVEL” to “AUTO”, this unit
does not change but the fine-tunes the specified value of “DSP
LEVEL” (see page 75).

Muting type MUTE TYPE
Use this feature to adjust how much the mute function
reduces the output volume (see page 45).
Choice

Functions

FULL

Mutes all the audio output.

–20dB

Reduces the current volume by 20 dB.

Maximum volume MAX VOL.
Use this feature to set the maximum volume level in the
main zone. This feature is useful to avoid the unexpected
loud sound by mistake. For example, the original volume
range is –80.0 dB to +16.5 dB. However, when “MAX
VOL.” is set to –5.0 dB, the volume range becomes
–80.0 dB to –5.0 dB.
Control range: –30.0 dB to +15.0 dB, +16.5 dB
Control step: 5.0 dB

ADVANCED
OPERATION

Output level

Adaptive dynamic range control
ADAPTIVE DRC
Use this feature to adjust the dynamic range in
conjunction with the volume level. This feature is useful
when you are listening at lower volumes or at night. When
“ADAPTIVE DRC” is set to “AUTO”, this unit controls
the dynamic range as follows:
– If the VOLUME setting is low:
the dynamic range is narrow
– If the VOLUME setting is high:
the dynamic range is wide

Notes
• When this unit is in the auto setup procedure, the volume level
is automatically set to 0 dB regardless of the current “MAX
VOL.” setting.
• The “MAX VOL.” setting takes priority over the initial volume
setting. For example, if “INI.VOL.” is set to –20.0 dB and
“MAX VOL.” is set to –30.0 dB, the volume level is
automatically set to –30.0 dB when you turn on the power of
this unit next time.
• Use “MAX VOL.” in “ZONE SET” to set the initial volume
level in Zone 2.

Initial volume INIT. VOL.
Use this feature to set the volume level of the main zone
when the power of this unit is turned on.
Choices: OFF, MUTE, –80.0 dB to +16.5 dB
Control step: 0.5 dB

The “MAX VOL.” setting takes priority over the initial volume
setting.

91 En

English

Note

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

Use this feature to adjust the audio parameters.
3 SOUND MENU

. A)EQUALIZER

B)LFE LEVEL
C)DYNAMIC RANGE
D)LIPSYNC
E)EXTD SUR.

Graphic equalizer GEQ
Use this feature to match the tonal quality of the center,
surround L/R and surround back L/R, and surround back
speakers with that of the front L/R speakers. You can
adjust 7 frequency bands (63 Hz, 160 Hz, 400 Hz, 1 kHz,
2.5 kHz, 6.3 kHz, 16 kHz).
Control range: –6.0 dB to +6.0 dB
Control step: 0.5 dB

p

[

[]/[]: Up/Down
[ENTER]: Enter

A)EQUALIZER

A)EQUALIZER

1/2

Equalizer type select EQ TYPE SELECT
Use this feature to select the type of equalizer.

. 2.5kHz
6.3kHz
16kHz

0dB
0dB
0dB

[]/[]: Up/Down
[p]/[[]: Adjust

[

[

Use this feature to select the parametric equalizer or the
graphic equalizer.

0dB
0dB
0dB
0dB

p

63Hz
160Hz
400Hz
1kHz
[]/[]: Up/Down
[p]/[[]: Select

■ Equalizer A)EQUALIZER

2/2

TEST >OFF ON
CHANNEL;;;;FRONT L

TEST >OFF ON
. CHANNEL;;;;FRONT L

p

3 SOUND MENU

y
Press 8k / n to select a frequency band and 8l / h to adjust
the selected frequency band.

A)EQUALIZER

OFF

[p]/[[]: Select
[ENTER]: Enter

Functions

AUTO PEQ

Uses the parametric equalizer adjusted in
“AUTO SETUP” (see page 33).

GEQ

Adjusts the built-in 7-frequency band graphic
equalizer so that the tonal quality of the speakers
matches. Press 8ENTER to display the graphic
equalizer screen.

OFF

The “GEQ” parameter can be adjusted only when “GEQ” is
selected in “EQ TYPE SELECT”.

Test tone TEST
Use this feature to make adjustments of “GEQ” while
listening to a test tone. To select “TEST”, press 8 k / n
repeatedly in the graphic equalizer screen.
A)EQUALIZER

1/2

. TEST

>OFF ON
CHANNEL;;;;FRONT L

63Hz
160Hz
400Hz
1kHz
[]/[]: Up/Down
[p]/[[]: Select

Deactivates the equalizing feature.

[

Choice

Note

0dB
0dB
0dB
0dB

p

EQ TYPE SELECT
AUTO PEQ >GEQ
[NATURAL]

y
Currently applied parametric equalizer type (see page 33) appears
under “AUTO PEQ”.

Choice
OFF

Does not output test tones and output the
currently selected source component.

ON

Outputs test tones from the selected speakers.

Note
You can select “AUTO PEQ” only when you carry out “AUTO
SETUP” in advance (see page 32). In this case, “AUTO PEQ” is
automatically selected as the default setting.

92 En

Functions

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

■ Low-frequency effect level

■ Dynamic range C)DYNAMIC RANGE

B)LFE LEVEL
Use this feature to adjust the output level of the LFE (lowfrequency effect) channel according to the capacity of
your subwoofer or headphones. The LFE channel carries
low-frequency special effects which are only added to
certain scenes. This setting is effective when the input
signal contains the LFE channel.
Control range: –20 to 0 dB
Control step: 1 dB

Use this feature to select the amount of dynamic range
compression to be applied to your speakers or
headphones. This setting is effective only when this unit is
decoding bitstream signals.
C)DYNAMIC RANGE
SPEAKER;;;;;;;;;MAX

. HEADPHONE;;;;;;;MAX

p

[

[]/[]: Up/Down
[p]/[[]: Select

B)LFE LEVEL

. SPEAKER;;;;;;0dB
HEADPHONE;;;;0dB

p

[

[]/[]: Up/Down
[p]/[[]: Adjust

Speakers SPEAKER
Adjusts the speaker LFE level.

Speakers SPEAKER
Adjusts the dynamic range compression for the speakers.
Headphones HEADPHONE
Adjusts the dynamic range compression for the
headphones.
Choice

Headphones HEADPHONE
Adjusts the headphone LFE level.

• MIN: Adjusts the dynamic range to narrow
when this unit is decoding bitstream signals
(except Dolby TrueHD).
• AUTO: Adjusts the dynamic range according
to the instruction of the input source signals
when this unit is decoding Dolby TrueHD
signals.

STD

Adjusts the dynamic range to medium. When
this unit is decoding Dolby TrueHD signals, the
dynamic range control is always active
regardless of the instruction of the input source
signals.

MAX

Preserves the greatest amount of dynamic range.

ADVANCED
OPERATION

MIN/AUTO

Note
Depending on the settings of “LFE/BASS OUT” (see page 87),
some signals may not be output at the SUBWOOFER PRE OUT
jack.

Functions

English

93 En

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

■ Audio and video synchronization
(lip sync) D)LIPSYNC
Use this feature to adjust the audio and video
synchronization.

■ Extended surround E)EXTD SUR.
Use this feature to enjoy 6.1/7.1-channel playback for
multi-channel sources using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx,
Dolby Digital EX, or DTS-ES decoders by using the
connected surround back speakers.

D)LIPSYNC
E)EXTD SUR.

. HDMI AUTO;;;;;;OFF

AUTO;;;;;;;;;---ms
(offset;;;---ms)
MANUAL;;;;;;;;;0ms

. EXTD SUR.;;;;;;AUTO

p

[

[]/[]: Up/Down
[p]/[[]: Select

HDMI automatic lip sync mode HDMI AUTO
If the connected video monitor is connected to the HDMI
OUT jack of this unit and compatible with the automatic
audio and video synchronization function (automatic lip
sync), this unit adjusts the audio and video
synchronization automatically. Use this feature to activate
or deactivate the automatic lip sync.
Choices: ON, OFF
If the connected video monitor is compatible
with the automatic lip sync:
Select “ON”. Use “AUTO” to make fine adjustments of
the audio and video synchronization.
If the video monitor is not compatible with the
automatic lip sync or you do not want to use
the automatic lip sync:
Select “OFF”. Use “MANUAL” to adjust the audio and
video synchronization.
Auto delay AUTO
Use this feature to make fine adjustments of the audio and
video synchronization when you set “HDMI AUTO” to
“ON”.
Control range: 0 to 240 ms
Control step: 1 ms
y
“offset” indicates the difference between the value of the audio
delay that this unit sets automatically and the value of the audio
delay that you set in “AUTO”. This unit stores the value of
“offset” and applies the value to other automatic lip sync
compatible video monitors.

Manual delay MANUAL
Use this feature to adjust the delay of the sound output
manually to synchronize audio with video images when
you set “HDMI AUTO” to “OFF”.
Control range: 0 to 240 ms
Control step: 1 ms

94 En

[p]/[[]: Select
[ENTER]: Return

Choice

Functions

AUTO

Activates the optimum decoder to play back
signals in 6.1/7.1 channels when this unit
recognizes a signal flag being input.

PLIIxMovie

Plays back Dolby Digital or DTS signals in 7.1
channels using the Pro Logic IIx movie decoder.

PLIIxMusic

Plays back Dolby Digital or DTS signals in 6.1/
7.1 channels using the Pro Logic IIx music
decoder.

EX/ES

Plays back Dolby Digital or DTS signals in 6.1/
7.1 channels using the Dolby Digital EX or DTSES decoder.

OFF

Does not use any decoders to create 6.1/7.1
channels.

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

4 INPUT MENU
Use this menu to adjust the parameters of each input
source.
1/2

p

[

B)
XM
C)
PHONO
D)
TUNER
E)
CD
F) MD/CD-R
G)
DVD
[]/[]: Up/Down
[ENTER]: Enter

4 INPUT MENU

2/2

. H) DTV/CBL

I)
V-AUX
J)
DOCK
K) BLUETOOTH
L)
DVR
M)
VCR
N) MULTI CH
[]/[]: Up/Down
[ENTER]: Enter

p

. A) SIRIUS

[

4 INPUT MENU

Input/output assignment
I/O ASSIGNMENT
Use this feature to assign the input/output jacks according
to the component to be used if the initial settings of this
unit do not correspond to your needs. Change the
parameter to reassign the respective jacks and effectively
connect more components.
Once the input/output jacks are reassigned, you can select
the corresponding component by using the RINPUT
selector on the front panel (or the input selector buttons on
the remote control).
L)

Input source

Parameter
INPUT RENAME
VOL. TRIM
PARENTAL LOCK

B)XM
(U.S.A. and Canada
models only)

INPUT RENAME
VOL. TRIM

D)TUNER

INPUT RENAME
VOL. TRIM

N)MULTI CH

INPUT RENAME
VOL. TRIM
BGV
INPUT CH
FRONT

C)PHONO
E)CD
F)MD/CD-R
G)DVD
H)DTV/CBL
I)V-AUX
L)DVR
M)VCR

I/O ASSIGNMENT
INPUT RENAME
VOL. TRIM
DECODER MODE

J)DOCK

INPUT RENAME
VOL. TRIM
STANDBY CHARGE

K)BLUETOOTH

INPUT RENAME
VOL. TRIM
START PAIRING

COAXIAL IN;;;;NONE
OPTICAL IN;;;;NONE
OPTICAL OUT;;;NONE
HDMI IN;;;;;;;;[3]

Current( DTV/CBL )
[p]/[[]: Select
[ENTER]: Enter

y
• “NONE” appears in the OSD when any input source is not
assigned to the input/output jack.
• Set “OPTICAL OUT” to “(1)” for the digital recording
component that you connect to the DIGITAL OUTPUT jack.
• You cannot select a specific item more than once for the same
type of jack.
• An asterisk (*) appears to the right of the input/output jack
names that have been changed from their previous settings.
• The currently assigned input source for the selected input/
output jack appears in the OSD (“Current( DTV/CBL )” in the
display example above).

ADVANCED
OPERATION

A)SIRIUS
(U.S.A. and Canada
models only)

DVR

. COMPONENT IN;;;[B]*

Note
Some parameters described above may not be available for all
input sources and some parameters are only available for specific
input sources.

English

95 En

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

Input rename INPUT RENAME
Use this feature to change the name of the input source
that appears in the OSD and in the front panel display.
L)

DVR

Decoder mode DECODER MODE
Use this feature to switch the decoder activation mode.
When you select “DTS” and digital audio signals are
input, this unit always activates the DTS decoder and only
plays back the DTS digital audio signals.

INPUT RENAME
DVR .

E)

DVR

p

[p]/[[]: Position
[ ]/[ ]: Character
[ENTER]: Enter
[RETURN]: Return

[

CD

I/O ASSIGNMENT
INPUT RENAME
VOL. TRIM;;;;;0.0dB
. DECODER MODE;;;AUTO

1

2

Press 8l / h to place the “_” (underscore)
under the space or the character you want to
edit.
Press 8k / n to select the character you
want to use and then press 8l / h to move
to the next space.

Choice

p

[

[]/[]: Up/Down
[p]/[[]: Select

Functions

AUTO

Automatically detects digital audio signal input
types and selects the appropriate decoder.

DTS

Activates the DTS decoder and plays back only
DTS digital audio signals when digital audio
signals are input.

Notes

Note

• You can use up to 9 characters for each input.
• Press 8n to change the character in the following order,
or press 8k to go in the reverse order:
A to Z, 0 to 9, a to z, symbols (#, *, –, +, etc.), space.

“DECODER MODE” is only available when the digital audio
input jacks (HDMI, OPTICAL, and/or COAXIAL) are assigned
to the selected input source.

3

Repeat steps 1 through 2 to rename each
input source.

4

Press 8ENTER to complete.

Volume trim VOL. TRIM
Use this feature to adjust the level of the signal input at
each jack. This feature is useful if you want to balance the
level of each input source to avoid sudden changes in
volume when switching between input sources.
Control range: –6.0 dB to +6.0 dB
Control step: 0.5 dB
Initial setting: 0.0 dB
D)

TUNER

INPUT RENAME
. VOL. TRIM;;;;+6.0dB

p

[

[]/[]: Up/Down
[p]/[[]: Adjust

y
This parameter also affects the signals output at the audio ZONE
OUT jacks.

96 En

SIRIUS Satellite Radio parental lock
PARENTAL LOCK
Use this feature to set the code number for locking the
desired SIRIUS Satellite Radio channels. Refer to “Setting
the Parental Lock” on page 67 for details.
Charge on standby STANDBY CHARGE
Use this feature to select whether this unit charges the
battery of the stationed iPod or not when this unit is in the
standby mode.
Choice

Functions

AUTO

Charges the battery of the stationed iPod when
this unit is turned on and in the standby mode.

OFF

Charges the battery of the stationed iPod only
when this unit is turned on.

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

To ensure security, a time limit of 8 minutes is set for
the pairing operation. You are recommended to read
and fully understand all the instructions before starting.

2

3

Press 8ENTER to start pairing.
The connected Bluetooth adapter starts searching
Bluetooth components. “Searching...” appears in the
video monitor.

Automatically selects the last selected video
source as the background video source.

DVD, DTV/
CBL, DVR,
VCR, V-AUX

Selects the corresponding input source as the
background video source.

OFF

Does not play the video source in the
background.

Input channels INPUT CH
Use this setting to select the number of channels input
from an external decoder (see page 25).
Choices: 6CH, 8CH
N) MULTI CH
INPUT RENAME
VOL. TRIM;;;;;0.0dB
BGV;;;;;;;;;;;;LAST
. INPUT CH;;;;;;;;6CH

To cancel the pairing, press 9RETURN to exit from
“START PAIRING”.

Press 9RETURN to exit from “START
PAIRING”.

Notes
• If the connected Bluetooth adapter cannot find any Bluetooth
components, “Not found” appears.
• If a Bluetooth adapter is not connected to this unit, “No
Bluetooth Adapter” appears.

[]/[]: Up/Down
[ENTER]: Select

If the connected component outputs discrete
6-channel audio signals.
Select “6CH”.
If the connected component outputs discrete
8-channel audio signals.
Select “8CH”. Also set “FRONT” (see below) to the
analog audio jacks at which the front left and right
channel signals output from the connected component
are input.

ADVANCED
OPERATION

y

4

LAST

Check that the Bluetooth component detects
the Bluetooth adapter.
If the Bluetooth component the Bluetooth adapter,
“YBA-10 YAMAHA” (example) appears in the
Bluetooth device list.
Select the Bluetooth adapter in the Bluetooth
device list and then enter the pass key
“0000” on the Bluetooth component.
Once this unit completes the pairing successfully,
“Pairing completed” appears.

Functions

[

1

Choice

p

Start pairing START PAIRING
Use this feature to start pairing the connected Yamaha
Bluetooth adapter (such as YBA-10, sold separately) with
your Bluetooth component. For details about the pairing,
refer to “Pairing the Bluetooth™ adapter and your
Bluetooth component” on page 72.

Front left and right channels input jack FRONT
If you selected “8CH” in “INPUT CH”, you can select the
analog audio jacks at which the front left and right channel
signals output from the connected external decoder is
input.
Choices: CD, MD/CD-R, DVD, DTV/CBL, DVR, VCR,
V-AUX
N) MULTI CH

Multi-channel input BGV BGV
Use this feature to select the video source played in the
background of the sources input at the MULTI CH INPUT
jacks.

INPUT RENAME
VOL. TRIM;;;;;0.0dB
BGV;;;;;;;;;;;;LAST
INPUT CH;;;;;;;;8CH
. FRONT;;;;;;;;;;;DVD

p

[

[]/[]: Up/Down
[ENTER]: Select

N) MULTI CH
INPUT RENAME
VOL. TRIM;;;;;0.0dB

. BGV;;;;;;;;;;;;LAST
INPUT CH;;;;;;;;6CH

p

[

[]/[]: Up/Down
[ENTER]: Select

Note
“FRONT” parameter appears only when you set “INPUT CH” to
“8CH”.

English

97 En

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

5 OPTION MENU
Use this menu to adjust the optional system parameters.

Amplifier function OSD display time OSD-AMP
Use this feature to set the amount of time to display the
status information screen after you perform a certain
operation.
Choice

5 OPTION MENU

. A)DISPLAY SET

B)VIDEO SET
C)MEMORY GUARD
D)INIT. CONFIG
E)HDMI SET
F)ZONE2 SET

ON
10S

Turns off the OSD 10 seconds after you perform
a certain operation.

30S

Turns off the OSD 30 seconds after you perform
a certain operation.

p

[]/[]: Up/Down
[ENTER]: Enter

[

Functions
Displays the OSD unceasingly during an
operation.

■ Display settings A)DISPLAY SET

Use “VIDEO” of “INIT” in “ADVANCED SETUP” to set “OSD
SHIFT” to the factory presets (see page 112).
A)DISPLAY SET

Front panel display scroll FL SCROLL
Use this feature to set the mode to display the HD Radio
(U.S.A model only), XM Satellite Radio information,
SIRIUS Satellite Radio information, or iPod menu (such
as song title or channel name) in the front panel display.
Choice

. DIMMER;;;;;;;;;;;;0
OSD SHIFT;;;;;;;;+5
OSD-SOURCE;;;;;;30S
OSD-AMP;;;;;;;;;30S
FL SCROLL;;;;;;CONT

CONT

Continuous mode.
Select this to display the operation status in the
front panel display in a continuous manner.

ONCE

Scroll-once mode.
Select this to display the operation status in the
front panel display by the first 14 alphanumeric
characters after scrolling all characters once.

p

OSD shift OSD SHIFT
Use this feature to adjust the vertical position of the OSD.
Control range: –5 (downward) to +5 (upward)
Control step: 1
Initial setting: 0
• Press 8l to lower the position of the OSD.
• Press 8h to raise the position of the OSD.
Source feature OSD display time OSD-SOURCE
Use this feature to set the amount of time to display the
HD Radio (U.S.A. model only), XM Satellite Radio, or
SIRIUS Satellite Radio information or iPod menu in the
OSD after you perform a certain operation.
Choice
ON

Functions
Displays the OSD unceasingly during an
operation.

10S

Turns off the OSD 10 seconds after you perform
a certain operation.

30S

Turns off the OSD 30 seconds after you perform
a certain operation.

98 En

■ Video settings B)VIDEO SET
Note
Use “VIDEO” of “INIT” in “ADVANCED SETUP” to set the
parameters in “VIDEO SET” to the factory presets (see
page 112).
B)VIDEO SET

. VIDEO CONV.;;;;;;ON

HDMI RES.;;;;*THRGH

[]/[]: Up/Down
[p]/[[]: Select

[

[

[]/[]: Up/Down
[p]/[[]: Adjust

Dimmer DIMMER
Use this feature to adjust the brightness of the front panel
display.
Control range: – 4 to 0
Control step: 1
• Press 8l to make the front panel display dimmer.
• Press 8h to make the front panel display brighter.

Functions

p

Note

Video conversion VIDEO CONV.
Use this feature to set whether to convert the video signals
input at the VIDEO, S VIDEO, and COMPONENT
VIDEO jacks.
Choice

Functions

ON

Converts composite, S-video, and component
video signals interchangeably and up-converts
composite, S-video, and component video
signals to HDMI video signals.

OFF

Does not convert any signals.

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

Notes
• This unit does not convert 480 line video signals and 576 line
video signals interchangeably.
• The analog component video signals with 480i (NTSC)/576i
(PAL) of resolution are converted into the S-video or composite
video signals and output at the S VIDEO MONITOR OUT and
VIDEO MONITOR OUT jacks.
• The converted video signals are only output at the MONITOR
OUT jacks. When recording a video source, you must make the
same type of video connections between each component.
• When composite video or S-video signals from a VCR are
converted into component video signals, the picture quality may
suffer depending on your VCR.
• Unconventional signals input at the composite video or S-video
jacks cannot be converted or may be output abnormally. In such
cases, set “VIDEO CONV.” to “OFF”.

HDMI resolution HDMI RES.
Use this feature to activate or deactivate the HDMI upscaling of the analog video signals input at the VIDEO, S
VIDEO and COMPONENT VIDEO jacks so that the upscaled video signals are output at the HDMI OUT jack.
This unit up-scales the video signals as follows:
• 480i (NTSC)/576i (PAL) → 480p/576p, 1080i, 720p,
or 1080p
• 480p/576p → 1080i, 720p, or 1080p

HDMI RESOLUTION
>*THROUGH
* 720p
*1080p

* 480p
*1080i

[p]/[[]: Select
[ENTER]: Enter

Choice
THROUGH

B)VIDEO SET
VIDEO CONV.;;;;;;ON
HDMI RES.;;;;*1080p

. HDMI ASPECT;;;THRGH

[p]/[[]: Up/Down
[ENTER]: Select

Choice

Functions

THRGH

Does not make any adjustments to the aspect
ratio for the HDMI video signal sources.

16:9

Displays video images with the aspect ratio of
4:3 on your video monitor with the aspect ratio
of 16:9. Black stripes appear on the right and left
sides as a result.

SMART

Fits video images with the aspect ratio of 4:3 to
your video monitor with the aspect ratio of 16:9.

Notes
• When “HDMI RES.” is set to “THROUGH”, you cannot make
any adjustments to “HDMI ASPECT”.
• If the aspect ratio of the input video source is other than 4:3, this
unit automatically ignores the setting of “HDMI ASPECT”.
• When “HDMI ASPECT” is set to “SMART”, the video images
of the edge of the video monitor are rather stretched.
• When the video signals are input at HDMI IN jacks or the
signals are input with 720p, 1080i or 1080p of resolution, the
setting of “HDMI ASPECT” does not affect the video signals
output at the HDMI OUT jack.

ADVANCED
OPERATION

B)VIDEO SET

HDMI aspect ratio HDMI ASPECT
Use this feature to select the adjustment of aspect ratio for
analog video signals output at the HDMI OUT jack.

Functions
Does not up-scale any analog video signals.

480p (or 576p), Up-scales analog video signals to 480p or 576p,
1080i, 720p, or 1080p of resolution.
1080i, 720p,
1080p

Notes

English

• This unit does not up-scale the analog component video signals
with 720p or 1080i of resolution.
• The “HDMI RES.” parameter appears only when you set
“VIDEO CONV.” to “ON”.
• If you connect your video monitor via HDMI connection, this
unit automatically detects the available video signal resolution
of the video monitor, and an asterisk (*) appears on the left of
the available video signal resolution(s).
• If this unit cannot detect the available video signal resolution(s)
of the connected video monitor, set “MON. CHK” (see
page 112) to “SKIP” and then set “HDMI RES.” again.
• This unit does not convert between 480 line video signals and
576 line video signals.

99 En

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

■ Memory guard C)MEMORY GUARD
Use this feature to prevent accidental changes to sound
field program parameter and other system settings.
C)MEMORY GUARD
>OFF

ON

Audio select AUDIO SELECT
Use this feature to designate the default audio input jack
select setting (see page 44) for the input sources connected
to the DIGITAL INPUT jacks when you turn on the power
of this unit.
Choice
AUTO

Automatically detects the type of input signals
and selects the appropriate audio input jack
select setting.

LAST

Automatically selects the last input jack select
setting used for the connected input source.

[p]/[[]: Select
[ENTER]: Return

Choice

Functions

OFF

Turns off the “MEMORY GUARD” feature.

ON

Protects:
– sound field program parameters
– “AUTO SETUP” items
– all speaker levels
– “MANUAL SETUP” items

Decoder mode DECODER MODE
Use this feature to designate the default decoder mode
(see page 96) for the input sources connected to the
DIGITAL INPUT jacks when you turn on the power of
this unit.
Choice

Notes
• You can change the following parameters even if “MEMORY
GUARD” is set to “ON”:
– “EXTD SUR.” in “SOUND MENU” (see page 94)
– “DECODER MODE” in “INPUT MENU” (see page 96)
– “PARENTAL LOCK” in “INPUT MENU” (see page 96)
– “MEMORY GUARD”
• When “MEMORY GUARD” is set to “ON”, “ G ” appears at the
top right of the “SET MENU” screen.
• You can change the settings of “SUR.” in the sound field
program parameter screen (see page 79) even if “MEMORY
GUARD” is set to “ON”.

■ Initial configuration D)INIT. CONFIG
Use this feature to select the settings of the audio input
jack select, active decoders and extended surround when
you turn on this unit.
D)INIT. CONFIG

. AUDIO SELECT;;AUTO
DECODER MODE;;AUTO
EXTD SUR.;;;;;AUTO

[p]/[[]: Select
[ENTER]: Return

100 En

Functions

Functions

AUTO

Automatically detects the type of input signals
and select the appropriate decoder mode setting.

LAST

Automatically selects the last decoder mode
setting used for the connected input source.

Extended surround EXTD SUR.
Use this feature to designate the extended decoder mode
(see page 94) for the input sources connected to the
DIGITAL INPUT jacks when you turn on the power of
this unit.
Choice

Functions

AUTO

Automatically detects the digital audio input
signals and activates the appropriate decoder.

LAST

Automatically selects the last decoder mode set
for “EXTD SUR.” in “SOUND MENU”.

Customizing this unit (MANUAL SETUP)

■ HDMI set E)HDMI SET

■ Zone 2 settings F)ZONE2 SET

Use this feature to select the component to play back
HDMI audio signals.

F)ZONE2 SET

. MAX VOL.;;;+16.5dB
INIT. VOL.;;;;;OFF

E)HDMI SET
S. AUDIO;;;;HTR-6180

[p]/[[]: Select
[ENTER]: Return

Support audio S.AUDIO
Use this feature to select whether to play back HDMI
audio signals on this unit or on another HDMI component
connected to the HDMI OUT jack on the rear panel of this
unit.
Choice

Functions

HTR-6180

Plays back HDMI audio signals on this unit. The
HDMI audio signals input at the HDMI input
jacks of this unit are not output to the HDMI
component connected to the HDMI OUT jack on
the rear panel of this unit.

OTHER

Plays back HDMI audio signals on another
HDMI component connected to the HDMI OUT
jack.

• This unit transmits audio and video signals input at the HDMI
input jacks to the HDMI out jack only when this unit is turned
on even if “S.AUDIO” is set to “OTHER”.
• Available audio/video signals depend on the specification of the
connected video monitor. Refer to the instruction manual of
each connected component.

Zone 2 Maximum volume MAX VOL.
Use this feature to set the maximum volume level in the
Zone 2.
Control range: – 30.0 dB to +15.0 dB, +16.5 dB
Control step: 5.0 dB
Notes
• The “MAX VOL.” setting takes priority over the “INI.VOL.”
setting. For example, when “INI.VOL.” is set to –20.0 dB and
then “MAX VOL.” is set to –30.0 dB, the volume level is
automatically set to –30.0 dB when you turn on the power of
this unit next time.
• The “MAX VOL.” setting does not affect the output level at the
“ZONE 2 OUT” jacks.

Zone 2 Initial volume INI.VOL.
Use this feature to set the volume level of Zone 2 when the
power of this unit is turned on.
Choices: OFF, MUTE, –80.0 dB to +16.5 dB
Control step: 0.5 dB
Notes
• The “MAX VOL.” setting takes priority over the “INI.VOL.”
setting.
• When you select “FRONT B”, “PRNS”, “Zone B”, or “NONE”
in “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” (see page 87), “Zone 2 SP Not
Assigned” appears in the OSD and the “ZONE2 SET”
parameter is not available.
• The “INI.VOL.” setting does not affect the output level at the
“ZONE 2 OUT” jacks.

ADVANCED
OPERATION

Notes

p

[

[]/[]: Up/Down
[p]/[[]: Adjust

English

101 En

REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES

Remote control features
In addition to controlling this unit, the remote control can also operate other audiovisual components made by Yamaha
and other manufacturers. To control your TV or other components, you must set up the appropriate remote control code
for each input source (see page 104).

Controlling this unit, a TV, or other components
■ Controlling this unit

■ Controlling a TV

Set the operation mode selector to FAMP to control this
unit.

Set the operation mode selector to FTV to control your
TV. To control your TV, you must set the appropriate
remote control code for 4DTV/CBL or 4PHONO (see
page 104). When you set the remote control codes for both
4DTV/CBL and 4PHONO, priority is given to the one
set for 4DTV/CBL.

CODE SET
CODE SET

*1

TRANSMIT

TRANSMIT

POWER

POWER

TV

AV

POWER

STANDBY

A

CBL
DTV

CD

CD-R

DVD

DVR

VCR

PHONO

XM

POWER

TV

AV

*3

SIRIUS

DOCK
V-AUX

TUNER

POWER

*1

POWER

STANDBY

SIRIUS

A

DOCK

CBL

V-AUX

DTV

CD

CD-R

DVD

DVR

VCR

PHONO

TV VOL

TV CH

TUNER

XM

AMP

AMP

SOURCE

TV VOL

TV CH

VOLUME

Set to AMP

SOURCE

VOLUME
TV

TV

TV MUTE

*2

2

STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

5

6

MULTI CH IN

AUDIO SEL

9

0

TV MUTE

MUTE

TV INPUT

PROG

1

ENHANCER

SUR. DECODE

3

4
PARAMETER

7

SLEEP

10

ENHANCER

2

STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

5

6

MULTI CH IN

AUDIO SEL

9

0

8

ENT

MUTE

TV INPUT

PROG

1

3

MENU
SRCH MODE

A-E/CAT.

A-E/CAT.
RETURN

RETURN

DISPLAY

INFO

PRG SELECT

PRG SELECT

REC

REC

SCENE

SCENE

2

3

1

4

Notes
These buttons always control this unit regardless of the
operation mode selector position.
*2 These buttons control this unit only when the component
operation mode selector is set to FAMP.
*3 4A is the optional component control area button. You can
control the desired component without changing the input
source of this unit.

2

3

4

Notes
*1

These buttons always control your TV regardless of the
operation mode selector position.
Remote control

*2

102 En

DISPLAY

MEMORY

INFO

*1

*2

MENU
SRCH MODE
ENTER

MEMORY

*1

8

ENT

SET MENU

TITLE
BAND

ENTER

1

4

SLEEP

10

LEVEL

SET MENU

TITLE

SUR. DECODE

PARAMETER

7

PRESET/CH

PRESET/CH
LEVEL

BAND

Set to TV

Digital TV/Cable TV

TV POWER

Turns the power on or off.

TV VOL +/–

Increases or decreases the volume
level.

TV CH +/–

Changes the channel number.

TV MUTE

Mutes the audio output.

TV INPUT

Changes the input source.

These buttons control your TV only when the operation mode
selector is set to FTV. For details, see the “Digital TV/Cable
TV” column on page 103.

Remote control features

■ Controlling other components
Set the operation mode selector to FSOURCE to control
other components selected with the input selector buttons
(4). You must set the appropriate remote control code for
each input source in advance (see page 104). The
following table shows the function of each control button
used to control other components assigned to each input
selector button (4). Be advised that some buttons may not
correctly operate the selected component.

PROG
CODE SET

[1]

POWER

TV

AV

TUNER

XM

DOCK

CBL

V-AUX

DTV

POWER

STANDBY

SIRIUS

A

CD

CD-R

[2]
[3]

ENHANCER

1

2

STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

5

6

MULTI CH IN

AUDIO SEL

9

0

TRANSMIT

POWER

3

DVR

PHONO

VCR

TV CH

VOLUME

PRESET/CH

TV MUTE

SET MENU

TITLE

MENU

[8]

SRCH MODE

[4]

ENTER
A-E/CAT.

[5]

RETURN

[9]

DISPLAY

MEMORY

[6]

MUTE

TV INPUT

[7]

ENT

LEVEL

TV

y

8
SLEEP

AMP

SOURCE

TV VOL

4

10

BAND
DVD

SUR. DECODE

PARAMETER

7

INFO

PRG SELECT

REC

SCENE
PROG

1

2

ENHANCER

SUR. DECODE

3

4

1

2

3

4

The remote control has 12 modes (control areas) to control
components so that the remote control can operate up to 12
different components.
Remote
control

DVD player/
recorder

VCR

Digital TV/
Cable TV

LD player

CD player

MD/CD
recorder

[1] AV POWER

Power *1

Power *1

Power *2

Power *1

Power *1

Power *1

[2] 1-9, 0, +10

Numeric buttons

Numeric buttons

Numeric buttons

Numeric buttons

Numeric buttons

Numeric buttons

[3] TITLE

Title

[4] PRESET/CH
Up
k

Tuner

Preset stations
(1-8)/Numeric
buttons
Band

Up

Preset up (1-8)/
Tuning up

VCR channel
down

Down

Preset down
(1-8)/Tuning
down

A-E/CAT. l Left

Left

Preset down
(A-E)

A-E/CAT. h Right

Right

Preset up
(A-E)

ENTER

Hold

PRESET/CH
n

Down

Enter

Enter

[5] RETURN

Return

Return

[6] REC

Disc skip (player)
Rec
Rec (recorder)

Rec *2

p

Play

Play *2

Play

Memory

Play

Disc skip

Rec

Play

Play

w/INFO

Search backward Search backward Search backward Search backward Search backward Search backward Information

f

Search forward

Search forward

Search forward *2 Search forward

Search forward

Search forward

e

Pause

Pause

Pause *2

Pause

Pause

Pause

b

Skip backward

Skip backward

Skip backward *2

Skip backward

Skip backward

Skip backward

Audio program
down

a

Skip forward

Skip forward

Skip forward *2

Skip forward

Skip forward

Skip forward

Audio program
up

s

ADVANCED
OPERATION

VCR channel up

*2

Stop

Stop

Stop *2

Stop

Stop

Stop

[7] ENT

Title/Index

Enter

Enter

Chapter/Time

Index

Index

Enter

[8] MENU

Menu

[9] DISPLAY

Display

Display

Display

Display

Display

Menu
Display

Display

Search mode

Notes
*1
*2

This button is operational only when the original remote control supplied with the component has a POWER button.
These buttons operate your VCR or DVD recorder only when you set the appropriate remote control code for DVR (see page 104).

English

103 En

Remote control features

Setting remote control codes

1

You can control other components by setting the
appropriate remote control codes. For a complete list of
available remote control codes, refer to “List of remote
control codes” at the end of this manual.

Press one of the input selector buttons (4)
on the remote control to select the control
area you want to set up.

Remote control code default settings
Input
source

Component
category

Manufacturer

Default
code

TUNER

TUNER

Yamaha

82915

XM

TUNER

Yamaha

82918

SIRIUS

TUNER

Yamaha

82176

A

–

–

–

V-AUX

OTHER AUDIO
ACCESSORIES
(iPod)

Yamaha

82981

DTV/CBL

–

–

–

2

CD

Yamaha

62907

MD/CD-R

CD-R

Yamaha

71292

DVD

DVD

Yamaha

42543

DVR

DVR

Yamaha

52544

VCR

–

–

–

PHONO

–

–

–

Note
You may not be able to operate your Yamaha component even if a
Yamaha remote control code is preset as listed above. In this case,
try setting another Yamaha remote control code.

XM

DOCK

CBL

V-AUX

DTV

CD

CD-R

DVD

DVR

VCR

PHONO

SIRIUS

MD

Press 2CODE SET using a ballpoint pen or
a similar object.
The BTRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice, and the selected input selector button
lights up.
TRANSMIT

Flashes
TRANSMIT

CODE SET

CD

A

TUNER

POWER

POWER

TV

AV

STANDBY

POWER

DVD

Lights up

3

Press the numeric buttons (0 to 9) (6) to
enter the five-digit remote control code for
the component to be used.
The BTRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice, and the remote control code for the
selected component is set.
PROG

1

2

STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

5

6

MULTI CH IN

AUDIO SEL

9

0

ENHANCER

SUR. DECODE

3

4
PARAMETER

7

TRANSMIT

8

Flashes

y
Refer to “List of remote control codes” at the end of this
manual.

Notes
• If the manufacturer of your component has more than one
code, try each of them until you find the correct one.
• If you do not press any buttons within 30 seconds in step
3, the setup process is canceled. If this happens, repeat the
setup procedure.
• If you enter the code number “9980”, the remote control
code previously set for the selected control area is cleared.

104 En

Remote control features

Resetting all remote control codes
Use this feature to clear all the remote control codes
previously set and reset all of them to the initial factory
settings.
Press 2CODE SET using a ballpoint pen or
a similar object.
The BTRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice.

1

TRANSMIT

TRANSMIT

CODE SET

POWER

POWER

TV

AV

STANDBY

POWER

Flashes

2

Press the numeric buttons (6) to enter the
code number “9981”.
The BTRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice, and all the remote control codes
previously set are cleared and reset to the initial
factory settings.
PROG

2

STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

5

6

MULTI CH IN

AUDIO SEL

9

0

ENHANCER

SUR. DECODE

3

4
PARAMETER

7

ADVANCED
OPERATION

1

TRANSMIT

8

Flashes

y
If you do not press any buttons within 30 seconds after step 1, the
clearing process is canceled. In this case, repeat the clearing
procedure.

English

105 En

USING MULTI-ZONE CONFIGURATION

Using multi-zone configuration
This unit allows you to configure a multi-zone audio system. The Zone 2 feature allows you to set this unit to reproduce
separate input sources in the main zone and the second zone (Zone 2). You can control this unit from the second zone
using the supplied remote control.
Only analog signals are sent to the second zone. Any source you want to listen to in the second zone must be
connected to the analog AUDIO IN jacks of this unit.

Connecting Zone 2
You need the following additional equipment to use the multi-zone functions of this unit:
• An infrared signal receiver in the second zone.
• An infrared signal emitter in the main zone. This emitter transmits the infrared signals from the remote control via the
infrared signal receiver in the second zone to a CD player or a DVD player, etc. in the main zone.
• An amplifier and speakers in the second zone.
y
• Since there are many possible ways to connect and use this unit in a multi-zone configuration, we recommend that you consult with
your nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center about the Zone 2 connections that best meet your requirements.
• Some Yamaha models are able to connect directly to the REMOTE jacks of this unit. If you own these products, you may not need to
use an infrared signal emitter. Up to 6 Yamaha components can be connected as shown below.

REMOTE

REMOTE

IN

Infrared signal
receiver

OUT

REMOTE

IN

OUT

Yamaha
component

This unit

REMOTE

IN

OUT

Yamaha
component

■ Using the external amplifier
Connect the amplifier/receiver in the second zone and other components to this unit as follows.
From the ZONE 2 OUT jacks

Amplifier
Main zone

Second zone
(Zone 2)
Infrared signal receiver
Remote control

DVD player (etc.)

This unit

Infrared signal emitter

From the REMOTE OUT jack

From the REMOTE IN jack

Note
To avoid unexpected noise, DO NOT USE the Zone 2 feature with CDs encoded in DTS.

106 En

Using multi-zone configuration

■ Using the internal amplifier of this unit
Important safety notice
The EXTRA SP speaker terminals of this Receiver should not be connected to a Passive Loudspeaker Selector Box or
more than one loudspeaker per channel.
Connection to a Passive Loudspeaker Selector Box or multiple speakers per channel could create an abnormally low
impedance load resulting in amplifier damage. See this owner’s manual for correct usage.
Compliance with minimum speaker impedance information for all channels must be maintained at all times. This
information is found on the back panel of your Receiver.
Connect the speakers in the second zone to the EXTRA SP speaker terminals and then set the “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” to
“ZONE2” (see page 87).

FRONT B/ZONE2/
PRESENCE
EXTRA SP L

R

Second zone
(Zone 2)

This unit
Main zone

• You can use the speakers connected EXTRA SP speaker terminals as the front speaker system of another zone. Set “EXTRA SP
ASSIGN” to “ZONE B” (see page 87).
• When you use the internal amplifiers for the Zone 2 speakers, you can adjust the volume level and set the initial volume level and
maximum volume level of the Zone 2 speakers (see page 101).

ADVANCED
OPERATION

y

Controlling Zone 2
You can select and control Zone 2 by using the control
buttons on the front panel or on the remote control. The
available operations are as follows:
• Selecting the input source of Zone 2.
• Tuning into FM or AM when “TUNER” is selected as
the input source of Zone 2 (see page 53).
• Tuning into XM Satellite Radio when “XM” is selected
as the input source of Zone 2 (see page 59) (U.S.A. and
Canada models only).
• Tuning into SIRIUS Satellite Radio when “SIRIUS” is
selected as the input source of Zone 2 (see page 64)
(U.S.A. and Canada models only).
• Enjoying music stored on your iPod stationed in a
Yamaha iPod universal dock (such as YDS-10 sold
separately) connected to the DOCK terminal of this
unit when “V-AUX” is selected as the input source
(see page 70).

■ Controlling Zone 2 with the front panel
Turning on Zone 2
Press HZONE 2 ON/OFF to turn on Zone 2.
Activating the Zone 2 operation mode
Press IZONE CONTROL to control Zone 2.
The ZONE2 indicator flashes in the front panel display for
approximately 10 seconds.
ZONE2
Flashes

Note
English

You must complete each step while the ZONE2 indicator is
flashing in the front panel display. Otherwise, the Zone 2 mode is
automatically canceled and this unit returns to the normal
operation mode. In this case, repeat the Zone 2 selection
procedure.

107 En

Using multi-zone configuration

Operate the following operations after activating the Zone 2
operation mode.

2

Press the numeric buttons (6) to enter the
code number “9992”.

Operating Zone 2

PROG

Rotate the RINPUT selector to select the
desired input source while the ZONE2 indicator
is flashing in the front panel display.
• Select “TUNER” as the input source to use the TUNER
features in Zone 2. For details about the TUNER
operations, see “FM/AM tuning” on page 53.
• Select “XM” as the input source to use the XM
Satellite Radio features in Zone 2. For details about the
XM Satellite Radio operations, see “XM Satellite
Radio tuning” on page 59.
• Select “SIRIUS” as the input source to use the SIRIUS
Satellite Radio features in Zone 2. For details about the
SIRIUS Satellite Radio operations, see “SIRIUS
Satellite Radio™ tuning” on page 64.
• Select “V-AUX” as the input source to use iPod
features or Bluetooth features in Zone 2. For details
about the iPod operations, see “Using iPod™” on
page 70 or “Using Bluetooth™ components” on
page 72.

ENHANCER

1

2

STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

5

6

MULTI CH IN

AUDIO SEL

9

0

3

SUR. DECODE

4
PARAMETER

7

TRANSMIT

8

Flashes

■ Controlling Zone 2 with the remote
control
Turning on Zone 2
Press and hold DPOWER or CSTANDBY and
then press 4
to set the remote control to the
Zone 2 mode.
• Press DPOWER when the main zone is turned on.
• Press CSTANDBY when the main zone is turned off.

The BTRANSMIT indicator on the remote control lights
up while the remote control is set to the Zone 2 mode.
POWER

While holding
down

Set Zone 2 to the standby mode

TRANSMIT

Press HZONE 2 ON/OFF to set Zone 2 to the
standby mode.

or

PHONO

STANDBY

Lights up

y
Press LSYSTEM OFF to set the main zone and Zone 2 to the
standby mode simultaneously.

■ Setting the remote control to the Zone 2
mode
The remote control is originally set to the main mode to
control the main zone. To control Zone 2 with the remote
control, you must first set the remote control to the Zone 2
mode.

1

Press 2CODE SET using a ballpoint pen or
a similar object.
The BTRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice.

Notes
• When the remote control is set to the Zone 2 mode,
DPOWER, CSTANDBY, EVOLUME +/–, GMUTE, and
the input selector buttons (4) are set to control Zone 2.
However, the rest of the remote control buttons remain in the
main mode.
• The remote control automatically exits from the Zone 2 mode in
the following cases:
– when you do not make any operations within 10 seconds after
the remote control is set to the Zone 2 mode.
– when you press a remote control button other than
DPOWER, CSTANDBY, EVOLUME +/–, GMUTE, the
ASCENE buttons and the input selector buttons (4).

Activating the Zone 2 operation mode
TRANSMIT

TRANSMIT

CODE SET

POWER

POWER

TV

AV

STANDBY

Press DPOWER to turn on Zone 2.

POWER

Flashes

Operating Zone 2
Press one of the input selector buttons (4) to
select the desired input source of Zone 2.
Setting Zone 2 to the standby mode
Press CSTANDBY to set Zone 2 to the standby
mode.

108 En

ADVANCED SETUP

Advanced setup
This unit has additional menus that are displayed in the front panel display. The advanced setup menu offers additional
operations to adjust and customize the way this unit operates. Change the initial settings (indicated in bold under each
parameter) to reflect the needs of your listening environment.
Notes
• The settings you make are reflected next time you press KMAIN ZONE ON/OFF to turn on this unit (see page 29).
• Only KMAIN ZONE ON/OFF, LSYSTEM OFF, MTONE CONTROL and the NPROGRAM selector are effective while you
are using the advanced setup menu.
• No other operations can be made while you are using the advanced setup menu.
• The advanced setup menu is only available in the front panel display.

Using the advanced setup
1

Press LSYSTEM OFF on the front panel to
set this unit to the standby mode.

2

Press and hold MTONE CONTROL and
then press KMAIN ZONE ON/OFF to turn
on this unit.
This unit turns on, and the advanced setup menu
appears in the front panel display.

■ Speaker impedance SP IMP.
Use this feature to set the speaker impedance of this unit
so that it matches that of your speakers.
Choices: 8Ω MIN, 6ΩMIN
• Select “8ΩMIN” to set the speaker impedance to 8 Ω.
• Select “6ΩMIN” to set the speaker impedance to 6 Ω.
SP IMP.

Speaker

Impedance level
If you use one set (A or B),
the impedance of each
speaker must be 8 Ω or
higher.

While holding
down

If you use two sets (A and
B), the impedance of each
speaker must be 16 Ω or
higher.*

MAIN ZONE

8ΩMIN

ON/OFF

ADVANCED
OPERATION

Front
TONE CONTROL

Center

3

Rotate the NPROGRAM selector to select
the parameter you want to adjust.
The name of the selected parameter appears in the
front panel display.

Surround
Surround back

If you use one set (A or B),
the impedance of each
speaker must be 4 Ω or
higher.

SPIMP.-8MIN
Currently selected
parameter

4
5

Front

Currently selected
parameter setting

Center
Surround

Press LSYSTEM OFF to save the new
setting and set this unit to the standby mode.

The impedance of each
speaker must be 6 Ω or
higher.

Surround back
*

The Canada model cannot use two separate speaker systems
(A and B) simultaneously when “SP IMP.” is set to “8ΩMIN”.

English

The settings you made are reflected next time you turn on
this unit.

If you use two sets (A and
B), the impedance of each
speaker must be 8 Ω or
higher.

6ΩMIN

Press MTONE CONTROL repeatedly to
change the selected parameter setting.

y

The impedance of each
speaker must be 8 Ω or
higher.

109 En

Advanced setup

See page 109 for the operation of the advanced setup.

■ Remote control AMP ID REMOTE AMP
Use this feature to set the AMP ID of this unit for remote
control recognition. This feature is useful when you
operate this unit and the other Yamaha receivers/
amplifiers in the same room separately.
Choices: ID1, ID2
• Select “ID1” when the remote control AMP ID code is
set to “00001”.
• Select “ID2” when the remote control AMP ID code is
set to “00002”.
Setting remote control AMP ID codes
You need to set the remote control AMP ID code for the
remote control.

■ Remote control TUNER ID REMOTE TU
Use this feature to set the TUNER ID of this unit for
remote control recognition.
Choices: ID1, ID2
• Select “ID1” when the remote control TUNER ID code
is set to “82915”.
• Select “ID2” when the remote control TUNER ID code
is set to “82178”.
Setting remote control TUNER ID codes
You need to set the remote control TUNER ID library
code for the remote control.

1

Press 4TUNER to select “TUNER” as the
input source.
TUNER

Press 2CODE SET using a ballpoint pen or
a similar object.
The BTRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice.

1

TRANSMIT

TRANSMIT

CODE SET

POWER

POWER

TV

AV

STANDBY

2

Press 2CODE SET using a ballpoint pen or
a similar object.
The BTRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice.

POWER

Flashes

2

Press the numeric buttons (6) to enter the
code number “00001” or “00002”.
The BTRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice, and the AMP ID code is changed.
PROG

1

2

STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

5

6

MULTI CH IN

AUDIO SEL

9

0

AMP ID
code *1

ENHANCER

SUR. DECODE

3

4
PARAMETER

7

00002

3

To operate this unit using
an alternative code.

TV

AV

PROG

TRANSMIT

ID2

2

STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

5

6

MULTI CH IN

AUDIO SEL

9

0

TUNER ID
code *1

82178
*1
*2

110 En

3

SUR. DECODE

4
PARAMETER

7

TRANSMIT

8

Flashes

Function

82915
To operate this unit using
(initial setting) the default code.

*1

The remote control setting
*2 The setting of this unit

POWER

ENHANCER

1

Remote
control AMP
ID *2
ID1
(initial setting)

STANDBY

Press the numeric buttons (6) to enter the
code number “82915” or “82178”.
The BTRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice, and the TUNER ID code is changed.

Flashes

00001
To operate this unit using
(initial setting) the default code.

POWER

Flashes

8

Function

TRANSMIT

TRANSMIT

CODE SET

POWER

To operate this unit using
an alternative code.

The remote control setting
The setting of this unit

Remote
control
TUNER ID *2
ID1
(initial setting)
ID2

Advanced setup

See page 109 for the operation of the advanced setup.

■ Remote control XM ID REMOTE XM
(U.S.A. and Canada models only)
Use this feature to set the XM ID of this unit for remote
control recognition.
Choices: ID1, ID2
• Select “ID1” when the remote control XM ID code is
set to “82918”.
• Select “ID2” when the remote control XM ID code is
set to “82179”.
Setting remote control XM ID codes
You need to set the remote control XM ID code for the
remote control.

1

■ Remote control SIRIUS ID REMOTE SR
(U.S.A. and Canada models only)
Use this feature to set the SIRIUS ID of this unit for
remote control recognition.
Choices: ID1, ID2
• Select “ID1” when the remote control SIRIUS ID code
is set to “82176”.
• Select “ID2” when the remote control SIRIUS ID code
is set to “82177”.
Setting remote control SIRIUS ID codes
You need to set the remote control SIRIUS ID code for the
remote control.

1

Press 4TUNER to select “SIRIUS” as the
input source.

Press 4XM to select “XM” as the input
source.

SIRIUS

XM

2
2

TRANSMIT

TRANSMIT

CODE SET

POWER

POWER

TV

AV

STANDBY

ADVANCED
OPERATION

Press 2CODE SET using a ballpoint pen or
a similar object.
The BTRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice.

Press 2CODE SET using a ballpoint pen or
a similar object.
The BTRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice.

POWER

Flashes
TRANSMIT

TRANSMIT

CODE SET

POWER

POWER

TV

AV

STANDBY

POWER

Flashes

3

3

Press the numeric buttons (6) to enter the
code number “82918” or “82179”.
The BTRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice, and the XM ID code is changed.
PROG

1

2

STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

5

6

MULTI CH IN

AUDIO SEL

9

0

ENHANCER

SUR. DECODE

3

4
PARAMETER

7

Press the numeric buttons (6) to enter the
code number “82176” or “82177”.
The BTRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice, and the SIRIUS ID code is changed.
PROG

ENHANCER

1

2

STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

5

6

MULTI CH IN

AUDIO SEL

9

0

*2

7

TRANSMIT

8

Flashes

Flashes

Function

To operate this unit using
an alternative code.

Remote
control XM
ID *2

82176
To operate this unit using
(initial setting) the default code.
82177

ID1
(initial setting)
*1

ID2

Function

*2

To operate this unit using
an alternative code.

Remote
control
SIRIUS ID *2
ID1
(initial setting)
ID2

The remote control setting
The setting of this unit

English

*1

4
PARAMETER

8

82918
To operate this unit using
(initial setting) the default code.
82179

SUR. DECODE

TRANSMIT

SIRIUS ID
code *1
XM ID code
*1

3

The remote control setting
The setting of this unit

111 En

Advanced setup

See page 109 for the operation of the advanced setup.

■ SIRIUS Satellite Radio Parental Lock
personal identification number reset
SR PIN
Use this feature to set the code number (personal
identification number) for the SIRIUS Satellite Radio
Parental Lock feature to the initial factory setting. This
feature is useful when you forget or want to change the
current code number.
Choices: RESET, CANCEL
• Select “RESET” to set the code number to the initial
factory setting.
• Select “CANCEL” to set the code number to the initial
factory setting.
Note
Even if you set “SR PIN” to “RESET”, this unit does not unlock
the locked channels. The initial factory setting of the Parental
Lock code number is “0000”.

■ Bi-amplifier setting BI-AMP
Use this feature to activate or deactivate the bi-amplifier
function (see page 16).
Choices: ON, OFF
• Select “ON” if you want to activate the bi-amplifier
function. “SUR.B L/R SP” is set to “NONE”
automatically, and this unit outputs the front channel
audio signals at the SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP
speaker terminals.
• Select “OFF” if you want to deactivate the bi-amplifier
function.
Note
When “BI-AMP” is set to “ON”, you can only select “FRONT
B”, “ZONE B”, or “NONE” in “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” (see
page 87).

■ SCENE IR code setting SCENE IR
Use this feature to output the remote control signals at the
REMOTE OUT jack automatically when this unit is in the
SCENE mode.
Choices: ON, OFF
• Select “ON” when the component connected to the
REMOTE OUT jack is the Yamaha component and has
the capability of the SCENE control signals. This unit
automatically sends the remote control signals to the
component.
• Select “OFF” when the component connected to the
REMOTE OUT jack is not the Yamaha component and
does not have the capability of the SCENE control
signals.
Note
If noises are output when you operate the SCENE function, set
“SCENE IR” to “OFF”.

112 En

■ Monitor check MON.CHK
Use this feature to activate or deactivate the monitor check
function of this unit. When “MON. CHK” is set to “YES”,
this unit receives the information of the available video
signal resolutions from the video monitor connected via
HDMI and you can only select the resolutions supported
by the video monitor in “HDMI RES.” (see page 99).
When “MON. CHK” is set to “SKIP”, you can select any
resolution in “HDMI RES.”.
Choices: YES, SKIP

■ Parameter initialization INIT
Use this feature to reset the parameters of this unit to the
initial factory settings. You can select the category of
parameters to be initialized.
Choices: DSP PARAM, VIDEO, ALL, CANCEL
• Select “DSP PARAM” to initialize all the parameters
of the sound field programs (see page 74).
• Select “VIDEO” to initialize the parameters in
“VIDEO SET” (see page 98) and “OSD SHIFT” in
“DISPLAY SET” (see page 98).
• Select “ALL” to initialize all the parameters of this
unit.
• Select “CANCEL” to cancel the initialization
procedure.
Note
Use “INITIALIZE” in the sound field program menu to initialize
the parameters of the desired program (see page 74).

TROUBLESHOOTING

Troubleshooting
Refer to the table below when this unit does not function properly. If the problem you are experiencing is not listed below
or if the instruction below does not help, turn off this unit, disconnect the power cable, and contact the nearest authorized
Yamaha dealer or service center.

■ General
Problem
This unit fails to turn
on or enters the
standby mode soon
after the power is
turned on.

No sound.

The power cable is not connected or the
plug is not completely inserted.

Remedy
Connect the power cable firmly.

See
page
—

The speaker impedance setting is incorrect. Set the speaker impedance to match your speakers.

28

The protection circuitry has been activated. Make sure that all speaker wire connections on this
unit and on all speakers are secure and that the wires
for each connection do not touch anything other than
their respective connections.

14

This unit has been exposed to a strong
external electric shock (such as lightning or
strong static electricity).

—

Set this unit to the standby mode, disconnect the power
cable, plug it back in after 30 seconds and then use this
unit normally.

Incorrect input or output cable connections. Connect the cables properly. If the problem persists,
the cables may be defective.

20-26

The optimizer microphone is connected.

Disconnect the optimizer microphone.

36

Audio input jack select is set to “HDMI”,
“COAX/OPT” or “ANALOG”.

Set Audio input jack select to “AUTO”.

44

Audio input jack select is set to
“ANALOG” while playing a source
encoded in Dolby Digital or DTS.

Set Audio input jack select to “AUTO” or
“COAX/OPT”.

44

No appropriate input source has been
selected.

Select an appropriate input source with the INPUT
selector on the front panel (or the input selector
buttons on the remote control).

Speaker connections are not secure.

Secure the connections.

14

The front speakers to be used have not been
selected properly.

Select the front speakers by pressing ASPEAKERS
on the front panel repeatedly.

43

The volume is turned down.

Turn up the volume.

—

The sound is muted.

Press GMUTE or EVOLUME +/– on the remote
control to resume audio output and then adjust the
volume.

45

Signals this unit cannot reproduce are
being input from a source component, such
as a CD-ROM.

Play a source whose signals can be reproduced by this
unit.

—

The HDMI components connected to this
unit do not support the HDCP copy
protection standards.

Connect HDMI components that support the HDCP
copy protection standards.

18

“S.AUDIO” is set to “OTHER” and
“HDMI” audio signals are not being played
back on this unit.

Set “S.AUDIO” to “HTR-6180” in “MANUAL
SETUP”.

101

The output and input for the picture are
Set “VIDEO CONV.” to “ON” or connect your source
connected to different types of video jacks. components in the same way as you connect your
video monitor to this unit.

42, 43

ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION

No picture.

Cause

98

Non-standard video signals are input.
The sound suddenly
goes off.

Check that the speaker impedance setting is correct.

28, 109

Check that the speaker wires are not touching each
other and then turn this unit back on.

—

The sleep timer has turned this unit off.

Turn this unit on, and play the source again.

—

The sound is muted.

Press GMUTE or EVOLUME +/– on the remote
control to resume audio output.

45

Incorrect cable connections.

Connect the cables properly. If the problem persists,
the cables may be defective.

14

Incorrect settings in “SP LEVEL”.

Adjust the “SP LEVEL” settings.

89

113 En

English

Sound is heard from
the speaker on one
side only.

The protection circuitry has been activated
because of a short circuit, etc.

Troubleshooting

Problem

Cause

Remedy

See
page

Only the center
speaker outputs
substantial sound.

When playing a monaural source with a
sound field program, the source signal is
directed to the center channel, and the front
and surround speakers output effect
sounds.

No sound is heard
from the center
speaker.

“CENTER SP” in “SET MENU” is set to
“NONE”.

Set “CENTER SP” to “SMALL” or “LARGE”.

88

One of the sound field programs (except
for “7ch Stereo”) has been selected.

Try another sound field program.

48

No sound is heard
from the presence
speakers.

The sound field programs are turned off.

Press OSTRAIGHT to turn them on.

51

You are using a source or program
combination that does not output sound
from all channels.

Try another sound field program.

42

“EXTRA SP ASSIGN” is set to a setting
other than “PRESENCE”.

Set “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” to “PRESENCE”.

87

No sound is heard
from the surround
speakers.

“SUR. L/R SP” in “SET MENU” is set to
“NONE”.

Set “SUR. L/R SP” to “SML” or “LRG”.

88

This unit is in the “STRAIGHT” mode and
a monaural source is being played back.

Press OSTRAIGHT on the front panel so that
“STRAIGHT” disappears from the front panel display.

51

No sound is heard
from the surround
back speakers.

“SUR. L/R SP” in “SET MENU” is set to
“NONE” and “SUR.B L/R SP” is
automatically set to “NONE”.

Set “SUR. L/R SP” and “SUR.B L/R SP” to a setting
other than “NONE”.

88

“SUR.B L/R SP” in “SET MENU” is set to
“NONE”.

Set “SUR.B L/R SP” to a setting other than “NONE”.

88

Zone 2 speaker
settings are not
available in “SET
MENU”.

“EXTRA SP ASSIGN” is set to a setting
other than “ZONE2”.

Set “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” to “ZONE2”.

87

FRONT B speakers
cannot be activated.

“EXTRA SP ASSIGN” is set to a setting
other than “FRONT B”.

Set “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” to “FRONT B”.

87

No sound from the
center, surround or
surround back
speakers when the
FRONT B speakers are
activated.

“EXTRA SP ASSIGN” is set to
“ZONE B”.

Set “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” to “FRONT B”.

87

Presence speaker
settings are not
available in “SET
MENU”.

“EXTRA SP ASSIGN” is set to a setting
other than “PRESENCE”.

Set “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” to “PRESENCE”.

87

No sound is heard
from the subwoofer.

“LFE/BASS OUT” in “SET MENU” is set
to “FRONT” when a Dolby Digital or DTS
signal is being played.

Set “LFE/BASS OUT” to “SWFR” or “BOTH”.

87

“LFE/BASS OUT” in “SET MENU” is set
to “SWFR” or “FRONT” when a
2-channel source is being played.

Set “LFE/BASS OUT” to “BOTH”.

87

The source does not contain low-frequency
signals.
Dolby Digital or DTS
sources cannot be
played. (Dolby Digital
or DTS indicator in the
front panel display
does not light up.)

The connected component is not set to
output Dolby Digital or DTS digital
signals.

Make an appropriate setting following the operating
instructions for your component.

—

Audio input jack select is set to
“ANALOG”.

Set Audio input jack select to “AUTO”.

44

A humming sound is
heard.

Incorrect cable connections.

Connect the audio cables firmly. If the problem
persists, the cables may be defective.

—

No connection from the turntable to the
GND terminal.

Connect the grounding cable of your turntable to the
GND terminal of this unit.

23

The record is being played on a turntable
with an MC cartridge.

Connect your turntable to this unit through an MChead amplifier.

23

The volume level is
low while a record is
being played.

114 En

Troubleshooting

Problem

Cause

Remedy

The volume level
cannot be increased,
or the sound is
distorted.

The component connected to the AUDIO
Turn on the power of the component.
OUT (REC) jacks of this unit is turned off.

The sound effects
cannot be recorded.

It is not possible to record the sound effects
with a recording component.

A source cannot be
recorded by a digital
recording component
connected to the
DIGITAL OUTPUT jack.

The source component is not connected to
the DIGITAL INPUT jacks of this unit.

A source cannot be
recorded by an analog
component connected
to the AUDIO OUT
(REC) jacks.

See
page
—

Connect the source component to the DIGITAL
INPUT jacks.

21, 23

(U.S.A. model only)
HD Radio signals are not output at the
DIGITAL OUTPUT jacks.

Connect the recording component to the analog
AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks.

—

The source component is not connected to
the analog AUDIO IN jacks of this unit.

Connect the source component to the analog AUDIO
IN jacks.

23

Some components cannot record Dolby
Digital or DTS sources.

XM Satellite Radio and SIRIUS Satellite
Radio signals are not output at the AUDIO
OUT (REC) jacks.
“MEMORY GUARD” in “SET MENU” is
set to “ON”.

Set “MEMORY GUARD” to “OFF”.

100

This unit does not
operate properly.

The internal microcomputer has been
frozen by an external electric shock (such
as lightning or excessive static electricity)
or by a power supply with low voltage.

Disconnect the power cable from the AC wall outlet
and then plug it in again after about 30 seconds.

—

No sound is heard
from the connected
HDMI component.

The HDMI component does not accept the
multi-channel audio signals.

Convert the multi-channel audio signals to the
2-channel audio signals at the source component such
as a DVD player.

—

“CHECK SP WIRES”
appears in the front
panel display.

Speaker cables are short-circuited.

Make sure all speaker cables are connected correctly.

14

There is noise
interference from
digital or radio
frequency equipment.

This unit is too close to the digital or highfrequency equipment.

Move this unit further away from such equipment.

—

The picture is
disturbed.

The video source uses scrambled or
encoded signals to prevent dubbing.

This unit suddenly
enters the standby
mode.

The internal temperature is too high and the Wait about 1 hour for this unit to cool down and then
overheat protection circuitry has been
turn it back on.
activated.

—

ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION

The sound field
parameters and some
other settings of this
unit cannot be
changed.

■ HDMI
Problem
No picture or sound.

Cause

Remedy

See
page

The number of the connected HDMI
components is over the limit.

Reduce the number of the connected HDMI
components.

—

HDCP authentication failed.

Check that the connected HDMI components support
the HDCP copy protection standards.

—

English

115 En

Troubleshooting

■ Tuner (FM/AM)
Problem

Cause

FM stereo reception is
noisy.

FM

AM

Remedy

The characteristics of FM stereo
broadcasts may cause this problem
when the transmitter is too far away or
the antenna input is poor.

There is distortion, and
There is multi-path interference.
clear reception cannot be
obtained even with a
good FM antenna.
The desired station
cannot be tuned into with
the automatic tuning
method.

The signal is too weak.

Previously preset
stations can no longer be
tuned into.

See
page

Check the antenna connections.

27

Try using a high-quality directional FM
antenna.

—

Use the manual tuning method.

53

Adjust the antenna position to eliminate multipath interference.

—

Use a high-quality directional FM antenna.

—

Use the manual tuning method.

53

This unit has been disconnected for a
long period.

Preset the stations again.

54

The desired station
cannot be tuned into with
the automatic tuning
method.

The signal is weak or the antenna
connections are loose.

Tighten the AM loop antenna connections and
orient the antenna for the best reception.

—

Use the manual tuning method.

53

There are continuous
crackling and hissing
noises.

Noise can result from lightning,
fluorescent lamps, motors, thermostats
and other electrical equipment.

Use an outdoor antenna and a ground wire.
This will help somewhat, but it is difficult to
eliminate all noise.

—

There are buzzing and
whining noises.

A TV set is being used nearby.

Move this unit away from the TV set.

—

■ HD Radio (U.S.A. model only)
See
page

Problem

Cause

Remedy

This unit cannot
receive the HD Radio
signals of the selected
radio station.

The radio station provides analog FM/AM
radio service only.

Select other radio stations that provides the HD Radio
service.

53

Tuning mode is set to “MANUAL
TUNING.

Set the tuning mode to “AUTO TUNING”.

53

The signal is too weak.

Adjust the antenna position.

—

Use a high-quality FM/AM antenna.

—

This unit cannot select
other audio programs
than the main
program.

The radio station provides an audio
program only.

Select an FM HD Radio station that provides multiple
audio programs.

53

HD Radio information
does not appear.

The radio station does not provide the
information.

Select other radio stations that provides the HD Radio
information.

53

116 En

Troubleshooting

■ XM Satellite Radio
If an operation takes longer than usual or an error occurs, one of the following messages may appear in the front panel
display. In this case, read the cause and follow the corresponding remedies.
Status message

See
page

Remedy

CHECK XM TUNER

The XM Mini-Tuner is not installed in the
XM Mini-Tuner Dock or the XM MiniTuner dock is not connected to this unit.

Confirm the XM Mini-Tuner is fully seated in the dock
and check the XM Mini-Tuner dock cable is connected
to this unit.

59, 63

CHECK ANTENNA

The XM antenna is not connected to the
XM Mini-Tuner Dock or the XM antenna
cable has become damaged.

Check that the XM antenna is securely connected to
the XM Mini-Tuner Dock and check the antenna cable
for damage. Replace the XM antenna if the cable is
damaged.

59

LOADING

The XM Mini-Tuner is acquiring audio or
program information from the XM satellite
signal. This message can also occur in
weak XM signal conditions. Note that this
unit may not respond to some operations
while this message is displayed.

This message should disappear in a few seconds in
good signal conditions. If you see this message often,
reposition the XM antenna to get better signal
reception. Use the “ANTENNA INFO” information in
the front panel or “XM Information” screen in the
video monitor to check the antenna reception level.

63

NO SIGNAL

The XM Mini-Tuner is not receiving the
XM satellite signal. Something may be
blocking the XM antenna’s view of the
satellites or the antenna is not properly
aimed.

Check for antenna obstructions and reposition the XM
antenna to get better signal reception. Use the
“ANTENNA INFO” information in the front panel or
“XM Information” screen in the video monitor to
check the antenna reception level. See instructions
supplied with the XM Mini-Tuner and Dock for
antenna installation information.

59

OFF AIR

The XM channel you selected is not
currently broadcasting.

Check back at a later time; in the mean time, select
another channel.

—

CH UNAUTH

You may be attempting to tune to an XM
channel that is blocked or that you cannot
receive with your XM subscription
package.

Consult the latest channel guide at
http://www.xmradio.com/ (US residents) and
http://www.xmradio.ca/ (Canadian residents) for the
current list of channels. For information on receiving
this channel, visit http://www.xmradio.com/ (US
residents) and http://www.xmradio.ca/ (Canadian
residents) or contact XM Satellite Radio at
1-800-967-2346 (US residents) and 1-877-438-9677
(Canadian residents).

60

CH UNAVAIL

The selected channel is not available. The
channel may have been reassigned to a
different channel number. This message
may occur initially with a new XM MiniTuner or an XM Mini-Tuner that has not
received XM’s signal for an extended
period.

Consult the latest channel guide at
http://www.xmradio.com/ (US residents) and
http://www.xmradio.ca/ (Canadian residents) for the
current list of channels. For cases of a new XM MiniTuner or an XM Mini-Tuner that has not received
XM’s signal for an extended period, allow the XM
Mini-Tuner to receive the XM satellite signal for at
least 5 minutes and then try to select the channel again.

—

- - - -

No artist name or song title is available for
this selection.

No action required.

—

ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION

Cause

English

117 En

Troubleshooting

■ SIRIUS Satellite Radio
If an operation takes longer than usual or an error occurs, one of the following messages may appear in the front panel
display. In this case, read the cause and follow the corresponding remedies.
Status message

Cause

Remedy

See
page

ANTENNA ERROR

The antenna is not connected to the
SiriusConnect tuner properly.

Check the connection of the antenna and
SiriusConnect tuner.

64

CHECK SR TUNER

The SiriusConnect tuner is not connected
to the SIRIUS jack of this unit correctly.

Check the connection of the SiriusConnect tuner and
this unit.

64

The SiriusConnect tuner is not connected
to the AC wall outlet.

Connect the power cable of the SiriusConnect tuner to
the AC wall outlet.

64

NOT SUPPORTED

This unit does not support the connected
SIRIUS Satellite Radio tuner.

Connect the SiriusConnect tuner that this unit
supports,

64

ACQUIRING

The signal is too weak.

Adjust the orientation of the antenna of the
SiriusConnect tuner. Use the “ANTENNA INFO”
information in the front panel display or “SIRIUS
Information” screen in the video monitor to check the
antenna reception level.

UPDATING

The SiriusConnect tuner is updating the
channel list.

Wait until the updating is complete.

—

The period of the subscription is end.

Contact SIRIUS Satellite Radio to renew the
subscription.

65

F/W UPDATING

The SiriusConnect tuner is updating the
firmware.

Wait until the updating is complete.

—

CALL SIRIUS
(CALL 888-539SIRIUS TO
SUBSCRIBE)

The selected channel is not subscribed.

Contact SIRIUS Satellite Radio to subscribe the
selected channel.
URL: https://activate.siriusradio.com/
Phone: 1-888-539-SIRIUS (1-888-539-7474)

65

Select another channel.

65

SUB UPDATED
INVALID

The subscription information is updated.
Select another channel.

65

Not Available

The operation you made is not available.

The selected channel is currently out of
service.

64, 69

■ Remote control
Problem
The remote control
does not work or
function properly.

Cause

Remedy

Wrong distance or angle.

The remote control will function within a maximum
range of 6 m (20 ft) and no more than 30 degrees offaxis from the front panel.

31

Direct sunlight or lighting (from an inverter
type of fluorescent lamp, etc.) is striking
the remote control sensor of this unit.

Reposition this unit.

—

The batteries are weak.

Replace all batteries.

—

The operation mode selector is set
incorrectly.

Set the operation mode selector correctly.
When operating this unit, set it to the FAMP position.
When operating the component selected by the input
selector button, set it to the FSOURCE position.
When operating the TV set in the 4DTV or
4PHONO area, set it to the FTV position.

—

The remote control code was not correctly
set.

Set the remote control code correctly using “List of
remote control codes” at the end of this manual.

104

Try setting another code of the same manufacturer
using “List of remote control codes” at the end of this
manual.

104

The ID code of the remote control and the Match the remote control ID of this unit with the
remote control ID of this unit do not match. corresponding remote control ID code.

118 En

See
page

110

Troubleshooting

■ iPod
Note
In case of a transmission error without a status message appearing in the front panel and in the OSD, check the connection to your iPod
(see page 25).
Status message

Loading...

Cause

Remedy

See
page

This unit is in the middle of recognizing the
connection with your iPod.
This unit is in the middle of acquiring song
lists from your iPod.

Connect error

There is a problem with the signal path
from your iPod to this unit.

Unknown iPod

The iPod being used is not supported by
this unit.

iPod connected

Your iPod is properly stationed in a
Yamaha iPod universal dock (such as YDS10, sold separately) connected to the
DOCK terminal of this unit, and the
connection between your iPod and this unit
is complete.

Disconnected

Unable to play

Turn off this unit and reconnect the Yamaha iPod
universal dock to the DOCK terminal of this unit.

25

Try resetting your iPod.

—

Only iPod (Click and Wheel), iPod nano, and iPod
mini are supported.

—

Your iPod was removed from a Yamaha
iPod universal dock (such as YDS-10 sold
separately) connected to the DOCK
terminal of this unit.

Station your iPod back in a Yamaha iPod universal
dock (such as YDS-10 sold separately) connected to
the DOCK terminal of this unit.

25

This unit cannot play back the songs
currently stored on your iPod.

Check that the songs currently stored on your iPod are
playable.

—

Store some other playable music files on your iPod.

—

■ Bluetooth
Status message

Searching...

Cause

Remedy

See
page

ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION

The Bluetooth adapter and the Bluetooth
component is in the middle of the pairing.
The Bluetooth adapter and the Bluetooth
component is in the middle of establishing
the connection.

Completed
Canceled
BT connected

The paring is completed.

Disconnected

The Bluetooth component is disconnected
from the Yamaha Bluetooth adapter (such
as YBA-10, sold separately).

No BT adapter

The Bluetooth adapter is not connected to
the DOCK terminal.

The paring is canceled.
The connection between the Yamaha
Bluetooth adapter (such as YBA-10, sold
separately) and the Bluetooth component is
established.

Connect the Yamaha Bluetooth adapter (such as YBA10, sold separately) to the DOCK terminal.

25

English

119 En

Troubleshooting

■ AUTO SETUP
Before AUTO SETUP
Error message

Cause

Remedy

See
page

Connect MIC!

Optimizer microphone is not connected.

Connect the supplied optimizer microphone
to the OPTIMIZER MIC jack on the front
panel.

Unplug HP!
Memory Guard!

Headphones are connected.

Unplug the headphones.

—

The parameters of this unit are protected.

Set “MEMORY GUARD” to “OFF”.

100

32

During AUTO SETUP
Error message

Cause

Remedy

See
page

E-1:NO FRONT SP
E-2:NO SUR SP
E-3:NO PRNS SP
E-4:SBR->SBL

Front L/R channel signals are not detected.

Check the front L/R speaker connections.

14

A surround channel signal is not detected.

Check the surround speaker connections.

14

A presence channel signal is not detected.

Check the presence speaker connections.

14

Only a right surround back channel signal is
detected.

Connect the surround back speaker to the
LEFT SURROUND BACK SPEAKERS
terminal if you only have one surround back
speaker.

14

E-5:NOISY

Background noise is too loud.

Try running “AUTO SETUP” in a quiet
environment.

—

Turn off noisy electric equipment like air
conditioners or move them away from the
optimizer microphone.

—

E-6:CHECK SUR.

Surround back speakers are connected,
though surround L/R speakers are not.

Connect surround speakers when you use
surround back speakers.

14

E-7:NO MIC

The optimizer microphone was unplugged
during the “AUTO SETUP” procedure.

Connect the supplied optimizer microphone
to the OPTIMIZER MIC jack on the front
panel.

32

E-8:NO SIGNAL

The optimizer microphone does not detect
test tones.

Check the microphone setting.

32

Check the speaker connections and
placement.

14

E-9:USER CANCEL

The “AUTO SETUP” procedure was
cancelled due to user activity.

Run “AUTO SETUP” again.

32

E-10:INTERNAL ERROR

An internal error occurred.

Run “AUTO SETUP” again.

32

120 En

Troubleshooting

After AUTO SETUP
Warning message

Cause

Remedy

See
page

W-1:OUT OF PHASE

Speaker polarity is not correct. This message
may appear depending on the speakers even
when the speakers are connected correctly.

Check the speaker connections for proper
polarity (+ or –).

14

W-2:OVER 24m (80ft)

The distance between the speaker and the
listening position is over 24 m (80 ft).

Bring the speaker closer to the listening
position.

—

W-3:LEVEL ERROR

The difference of volume level among
speakers is excessive.

Readjust the speaker installation so that all
speakers are set in locations with similar
conditions.

—

W-4:CHECK PRNS

“EXTRA SP ASSIGN” is set to
“PRESENCE”, though the presence channel
signals are not detected.

Check the speaker connections.

14

Use speakers of similar quality.

—

When “SWFR: TOO LOUD”or “SWFR:
TOO LOW” appears in the result screen, the
output volume of the subwoofer.

32

Check the presence speaker connections.

14

Set “EXTRA SP ASSIGN” to a setting other
than “PRESENCE”.

33

Notes
• If the “ERROR” or “WARNING” screens appears, check the cause of the problem, then run “AUTO SETUP” again.
• If a warning message “W-1”, “W-2”, or “W-3” appears, corrections are made, but they may not be optimal.
• If an error message “E-10” occurs repeatedly, contact a qualified Yamaha service center.

ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
English

121 En

RESETTING THE SYSTEM

Resetting the system
Use this feature to reset all the parameters of this unit to the initial factory settings.
Notes
• This procedure completely resets all the parameters of this unit including the “SET MENU” parameters.
• The initial factory settings are activated next time you turn on this unit.

y
To cancel the initialization procedure at any time without making any changes, press LSYSTEM OFF on the front panel.

1

Press LSYSTEM OFF on the front panel to
set this unit to the standby mode.

2

Press and hold MTONE CONTROL and
then press KMAIN ZONE ON/OFF to turn
on this unit.
This unit turns on, and the advanced setup menu
appears in the front panel display.
TONE CONTROL

While holding
down

MAIN ZONE

ON/OFF

3

Rotate the NPROGRAM selector to select
“INIT”.

4

Press MTONE CONTROL repeatedly to
select “ALL”.
y
Select “CANCEL” to cancel the initialization procedure
without making any changes.

5

Press L SYSTEM OFF to confirm your
selection and set this unit to the standby
mode.

122 En

GLOSSARY

Glossary
■ Audio and video synchronization
(lip sync)
Lip sync, an abbreviation for lip synchronization, is a technical
term that involves both a problem and a capability of maintaining
audio and video signals synchronized during post-production and
transmission. Whereas the audio and video latency requires
complex end-user adjustments, HDMI version 1.3 incorporates an
automatic audio and video syncing capability that allows devices
to perform this synchronization automatically and accurately
without user interaction.

■ Bi-amplification connection
A bi-amplification connection uses two amplifiers for a speaker.
One amplifier is connected to the woofer section of a loudspeaker
while the other is connected to the combined mid and tweeter
section. With this arrangement each amplifier operates over a
restricted frequency range. This restricted range presents each
amplifier with a much simpler job and each amplifier is less likely
to influence the sound in some way. The internal crossover of the
speaker consists of a LPF (low pass filter) and a HPF (high pass
filter). As its name implies, the LPF passes frequencies below a
cutoff and rejects frequencies above the cutoff frequency.
Likewise, the HPF passes frequencies above its cutoff.

■ Component video signal
With the component video signal system, the video signal is
separated into the Y signal for the luminance and the PB and PR
signals for the chrominance. Color can be reproduced more
faithfully with this system because each of these signals is
independent. The component signal is also called the “color
difference signal” because the luminance signal is subtracted
from the color signal. A monitor with component input jacks is
required in order to output component signals.

With the composite video signal system, the video signal is
composed of three basic elements of a video picture: color,
brightness and synchronization data. A composite video jack on a
video component transmits these three elements combined.

■ Deep Color
Deep Color refers to the use of various color depths in displays,
up from the 24-bit depths in previous versions of the HDMI
specification. This extra bit depth allows HDTVs and other
displays go from millions of colors to billions of colors and
eliminate on-screen color banding for smooth tonal transitions
and subtle gradations between colors. The increased contrast ratio
can represent many times more shades of gray between black and
white. Also Deep Color increases the number of available colors
within the boundaries defined by the RGB or YCbCr color space.

Dolby Digital is a digital surround sound system that gives you
completely independent multi-channel audio. With 3 front
channels (front L/R and center), and 2 surround stereo channels,
Dolby Digital provides 5 full-range audio channels. With an
additional channel especially for bass effects, called LFE (Low
Frequency Effect), the system has a total of 5.1-channels (LFE is
counted as 0.1 channel). By using 2-channel stereo for the
surround speakers, more accurate moving sound effects and
surround sound environment are possible than with Dolby
Surround. The wide dynamic range from maximum to minimum
volume reproduced by the 5 full-range channels and the precise
sound orientation generated using digital sound processing
provide listeners with unprecedented excitement and realism.
With this unit, any sound environment from monaural up to a 5.1channel configuration can be freely selected for your enjoyment.

■ Dolby Digital EX
Dolby Digital EX creates 6 full-bandwidth output channels from
5.1-channel sources. This is done using a matrix decoder that
derives 3 surround channels from the 2 in the original recording.
For the best results, Dolby Digital EX should be used with movie
sound tracks recorded with Dolby Digital Surround EX. With this
additional channel, you can experience more dynamic and
realistic moving sound especially with scenes with
“fly-over” and “fly-around” effects.

■ Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital Plus is an advanced audio technology developed
for high-definition programming and media including HD
broadcasts, HD DVD, and Blu-ray Disc. Selected as a mandatory
audio standard for HD DVD and as an optional audio standard for
Blu-ray Disc, this technology delivers multichannel sound with
discrete channel output. Supporting bitrates up to 6.0 Mbps,
Dolby Digital Plus can carry up to 7.1 discreet audio channels
simultaneously. Supported by HDMI version 1.3 and designed for
the optical disc players and AV receivers/amplifiers of the future,
Dolby Digital Plus also remains fully compatible with the
existing multichannel audio systems that incorporate Dolby
Digital.

ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION

■ Composite video signal

■ Dolby Digital

■ Dolby Pro Logic II
Dolby Pro Logic II is an improved technique used to decode vast
numbers of existing Dolby Surround sources. This new
technology enables a discrete 5-channel playback with 2 front left
and right channels, 1 center channel, and 2 surround left and right
channels instead of only 1 surround channel for conventional Pro
Logic technology. There are three modes available: “Music
mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources and
“Game mode” for game sources.

■ Dolby Pro Logic IIx

123 En

English

Dolby Pro Logic IIx is a new technology enabling discrete multichannel playback from 2-channel or multi-channel sources. There
are three modes available: “Music mode” for music sources,
“Movie mode” for movie sources (for 2-channel sources only)
and “Game mode” for game sources.

Glossary

■ Dolby Surround

■ DTS Express

Dolby Surround uses a 4-channel analog recording system to
reproduce realistic and dynamic sound effects: 2 front left and
right channels (stereo), a center channel for dialog (monaural),
and a surround channel for special sound effects (monaural). The
surround channel reproduces sound within a narrow frequency
range. Dolby Surround is widely used with nearly all video tapes
and laser discs, and in many TV and cable broadcasts as well. The
Dolby Pro Logic decoder built into this unit employs a digital
signal processing system that automatically stabilizes the volume
on each channel to enhance moving sound effects and
directionality.

DTS Express is an advanced audio technology for the optional
feature on Blu-ray Disc or HD DVD, which offers high-quality,
low bit rate audio optimized for network streaming, and Internet
applications. DTS Express is used for the Secondary Audio
feature of Blu-ray Disc or the Sub Audio feature of HD DVD.
These features deliver audio commentaries (for example, the
additional commentaries made by the director of a film) on
demand by the users via the Internet, etc. DTS Express signals are
mixed down with the main audio stream on the player
component, and the component sends the mixed audio stream to
the AV receivers/amplifiers via digital coaxial, digital optical, or
analog connections.

■ Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD is an advanced lossless audio technology
developed for high-definition disc-based media including HD
DVD and Blu-ray Disc. Selected as a mandatory audio standard
for HD DVD and as an optional audio standard for Blu-ray Disc,
this technology delivers sound that is bit-for-bit identical to the
studio master, offering a high-definition home theater experience.
Supporting bitrates up to 18.0 Mbps, Dolby TrueHD can carry up
to 8 discrete channels of 24-bit/96 kHz audio simultaneously.
Supported by HDMI version 1.3 and designed for the optical disc
players and AV receivers/amplifiers of the future, Dolby TrueHD
also remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel
audio systems and retains the metadata capability of Dolby
Digital, allowing dialog normalization and dynamic range
control.

■ DSD
Direct Stream Digital (DSD) technology stores audio signals on
digital storage media, such as Super Audio CDs. Using DSD,
signals are stored as single bit values at a high-frequency
sampling rate of 2.8224 MHz, while noise shaping and
oversampling are used to reduce distortion, a common occurrence
with very high quantization of audio signals. Due to the high
sampling rate, better audio quality can be achieved than that
offered by the PCM format used for normal audio CDs.

■ DTS 96/24
DTS 96/24 offers an unprecedented level of audio quality for
multi-channel sound on DVD video, and is fully backwardcompatible with all DTS decoders. “96” refers to a 96 kHz
sampling rate compared to the typical 48 kHz sampling rate. “24”
refers to 24-bit word length. DTS 96/24 offers sound quality
transparent to the original 96/24 master, and 96/24 5.1-channel
sound with full-quality full-motion video for music programs and
motion picture soundtracks on DVD video.

■ DTS Digital Surround
DTS digital surround was developed to replace the analog
soundtracks of movies with a 6.1-channel digital sound track, and
is now rapidly gaining popularity in movie theaters around the
world. DTS, Inc. has developed a home theater system so that you
can enjoy the depth of sound and natural spatial representation of
DTS digital surround in your home. This system produces
practically distortion-free 6.1-channel sound (technically, front
left and right, center, surround left and right, and LFE 0.1
(subwoofer) channels for a total of 5.1 channels). This unit
incorporates a DTS-ES decoder that enables 6.1-channel
reproduction by adding the surround back channel to the existing
5.1-channel format.

124 En

■ DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is an high resolution audio
technology developed for high-definition disc-based media
including HD DVD and Blu-ray Disc. Selected as an optional
audio standard for both HD DVD and Blu-ray Disc, this
technology delivers sound that is virtually indistinguishable from
the original, offering a high-definition home theater experience.
Supporting bitrates up to 3.0 Mbps for HD DVD and 6.0 Mbps
for Blu-ray Disc, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio can carry up
to 7.1 discrete channels of 24-bit/96 kHz audio simultaneously.
Supported by HDMI version 1.3 and designed for the optical disc
players and AV receivers/amplifiers of the future, DTS-HD High
Resolution Audio also remains fully compatible with the existing
multichannel audio systems that incorporate DTS Digital
Surround.

■ DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS-HD Master Audio is an advanced lossless audio technology
developed for high-definition disc-based media including HD
DVD and Blu-ray Disc. Selected as a mandatory audio standard
for both HD DVD and Blu-ray Disc, this technology delivers
sound that is bit-for-bit identical to the studio master, offering a
high-definition home theater experience. Supporting bitrates up to
18.0 Mbps for HD DVD and up to 24.5 Mbps for Blu-ray Disc,
DTS-HD Master Audio can carry up to 7.1 discrete channels of
24-bit/96 kHz audio simultaneously. Supported by HDMI version
1.3 and designed for the optical disc players and AV receivers/
amplifiers of the future, DTS-HD Master Audio also remains
fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems
that incorporate DTS Digital Surround.

■ HDMI
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) is the first
industry-supported, uncompressed, all-digital audio/video
interface. Providing an interface between any source (such as a
set-top box or AV receiver) and an audio/video monitor (such as a
digital television), HDMI supports standard, enhanced or highdefinition video as well as multi-channel digital audio using a
single cable. HDMI transmits all ATSC HDTV standards and
supports 8-channel digital audio, with bandwidth to spare to
accommodate future enhancements and requirements.
When used in combination with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital
Content Protection), HDMI provides a secure audio/video
interface that meets the security requirements of content
providers and system operators. For further information on
HDMI, visit the HDMI website at
“http://www.hdmi.org/”.

Glossary

■ LFE 0.1 channel

■ “x.v.Color”

This channel reproduces low-frequency signals. The frequency
range of this channel is from 20 Hz to 120 Hz. This channel is
counted as 0.1 because it only enforces a low-frequency range
compared to the full-range reproduced by the other 5/6 channels
in Dolby Digital or DTS 5.1/6.1-channel systems.

A color space standard supported by HDMI version 1.3. It is a
more extensive color space than sRGB, and allows the expression
of colors that could not be expressed before. While remaining
compatible with the color gamut of sRGB standards, “x.v.Color”
expands the color space and can thus produce more vivid, natural
images. It is particularly effective for still pictures and computer
graphics.

■ Neo:6
Neo:6 decodes the conventional 2-channel sources for 6- channel
playback by the specific decoder. It enables playback with the
full-range channels with higher separation just like digital
discrete signal playback. There are two modes available: “Music
mode” for music sources and “Cinema mode” for movie sources.

■ Neural Surround
Neural Surround™ represents the latest advancement in surround
technology and has been adopted by XM Satellite Radio for
digital radio broadcast of surround recordings and live events in
surround sound. Neural Surround™ employs psychoacoustic
frequency domain processing which allows delivery of a more
detailed sound stage with superior channel separation and
localization of audio elements. System playback is scalable from
5.1 to 7.1 multi-channel surround playback.

■ PCM (Linear PCM)
Linear PCM is a signal format under which an analog audio
signal is digitized, recorded and transmitted without using any
compression. This is used as a method of recording CDs and
DVD audio. The PCM system uses a technique for sampling the
size of the analog signal per very small unit of time. Standing for
“Pulse Code Modulation”, the analog signal is encoded as pulses
and then modulated for recording.

■ Sampling frequency and number of
quantized bits

ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION

When digitizing an analog audio signal, the number of times the
signal is sampled per second is called the sampling frequency,
while the degree of fineness when converting the sound level into
a numeric value is called the number of quantized bits. The range
of rates that can be played back is determined based on the
sampling rate, while the dynamic range representing the sound
level difference is determined by the number of quantized bits. In
principle, the higher the sampling frequency, the wider the range
of frequencies that can be played back, and the higher the number
of quantized bits, the more finely the sound level can be
reproduced.

■ SRS CS II (SRS Circle Surround II)
SRS CS II (SRS Circle Surround II) is a high-performance
6.1 channel matrix surround sound decoding system. It is the
next-generation of the original SRS Circle Surround technology,
incorporating powerful industry-first features including the dialog
clarity enhancement technology and added cinema-like bass to
the front channels and subwoofer.

■ S-video signal

English

With the S-video signal system, the video signal normally
transmitted using a pin cable is separated and transmitted as the Y
signal for the luminance and the C signal for the chrominance
through the S-video cable. Using the S VIDEO jack eliminates
video signal transmission loss and allows recording and playback
of even more beautiful images.

125 En

SOUND FIELD PROGRAM INFORMATION

Sound field program information
■ Elements of a sound field

■ SILENT CINEMA

What really creates the rich, full tones of a live instrument
are the multiple reflections from the walls of the room. In
addition to making the sound live, these reflections enable
us to tell where the player is situated as well as the size
and shape of the room in which we are sitting.
There are two distinct types of sound reflections that
combine to make up the sound field in addition to the
direct sound coming straight to our ears from the player’s
instrument.

Yamaha has developed a natural, realistic sound effect
DSP algorithm for headphones. Parameters for
headphones have been set for each sound field so that
accurate representations of all the sound field programs
can be enjoyed on headphones.

Early reflections
Reflected sounds reach our ears extremely rapidly (50 ms
to 100 ms after the direct sound), after reflecting from one
surface only (for example, from a wall or the ceiling).
Early reflections actually add clarity to the direct sound.
Reverberations
These are caused by reflections from more than one
surface (for example, from the walls, and the ceiling) so
numerous that they merge together to form a continuous
sonic afterglow. They are non-directional and lessen the
clarity of the direct sound.
Direct sound, early reflections and subsequent
reverberations taken together help us to determine the
subjective size and shape of the room, and it is this
information that the digital sound field processor
reproduces in order to create sound fields.
If you could create the appropriate early reflections and
subsequent reverberations in your listening room, you
would be able to create your own listening environment.
The acoustics in your room could be changed to those of a
concert hall, a dance floor, or a room with virtually any
size at all. This ability to create sound fields at will is
exactly what Yamaha has done with the digital sound field
processor.

■ CINEMA DSP
Since the Dolby Surround and DTS systems were
originally designed for use in movie theaters, their effect
is best felt in a theater having many speakers designed for
acoustic effects. Since home conditions, such as room
size, wall material, number of speakers, and so on, can
differ so widely, it is inevitable that there are differences in
the sound heard. Based on a wealth of actually measured
data, Yamaha CINEMA DSP uses Yamaha original sound
field technology to combine Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby
Digital and DTS systems to provide the audiovisual
experience of a movie theater in the listening room of your
own home.

126 En

■ Virtual CINEMA DSP
Yamaha has developed a Virtual CINEMA DSP algorithm
that allows you to enjoy DSP sound field surround effects
even without any surround speakers by using virtual
surround speakers. It is even possible to enjoy Virtual
CINEMA DSP using a minimal two-speaker system that
does not include a center speaker.

■ Compressed Music Enhancer
The Compressed Music Enhancer feature of this unit
enhances your listening experience by regenerating the
missing harmonics in a compression artifact. As a result,
flattened complexity due to the loss of high-frequency
fidelity as well as lack of bass due to the loss of lowfrequency bass is compensated, providing improved
performance of the overall sound system.

SPECIFICATIONS

Specifications
AUDIO SECTION

• Volume Control ...................................... MUTE/–80 dB to 16.5 dB

• Minimum RMS Output Power for Front, Center, Surround,
Surround back
1 kHz, 0.7% THD, 8 Ω ....................................................... 120 W

• Tone Control (Front L/R)
BASS Boost/Cut ...................................................... ±10 dB/50 Hz
BASS Turnover Frequency .................................................350 Hz
TREBLE Boost/Cut .............................................. ±10 dB/20 kHz
TREBLE Turnover Frequency ...........................................3.5 kHz

• Dynamic Power (IHF)
Front L/R, 8/6/4/2 Ω ...................................... 140/175/205/250 W
• Maximum Output Power [Russia model]
Speaker impedance setting: 8 Ω, 1 kHz, 0.7% THD, 4 Ω
.......................................................................................... 155 W
• Dynamic Headroom [U.S.A. and Canada models]
8 Ω .................................................................................... 1.25 dB
• IEC Output Power [Russia model]
Front L/R, 1 kHz, 0.06% THD, 8 Ω ................................... 115 W
• Damping Factor (IHF)
Front L/R, SPEAKERS A, 20 Hz to 20 kHz, 8 Ω
................................................................................. 120 or more

• Filter Characteristics (fc=40/60/80/90/100/110/120/160/200 Hz)
H.P.F.
(FRONT SP, CENTER SP, SUR. L/R SP, SUR.B L/R SP:
SMALL/SML) ............................................................12 dB/oct.
L.P.F. (Subwoofer) .........................................................24 dB/oct.

VIDEO SECTION
• Video Format (Gray Back)
[U.S.A. and Canada models] ............................................... NTSC
[Russia model] ....................................................................... PAL
• Video Format (Video Conversion) ................................. NTSC/PAL

• Input Sensitivity/Input Impedance
PHONO (MM)........................................................ 3.5 mV/47 kΩ
CD, etc. ................................................................. 200 mV/47 kΩ
MULTI CH INPUT ............................................... 200 mV/47 kΩ

• Signal Level
Composite ................................................................. 1 Vp-p/75 Ω
S-video ............................ 1 Vp-p/75 Ω (Y), 0.286 Vp-p/75 Ω (C)
Component ................... 1 Vp-p/75 Ω (Y), 0.7 Vp-p/75 Ω (PB/PR)

• Maximum Input Voltage
PHONO (MM)
1 kHz, 0.1% THD .............................................. 60 mV or more
CD, etc.
Effect On, 1 kHz, 0.5% THD .............................. 2.3 V or more

• Maximum Input Level (Video Conversion Off)
............................................................................... 1.5 Vp-p or more

• Rated Output Voltage/Output Impedance
OUT (REC) .......................................................... 200 mV/1.2 kΩ
PRE OUT .................................................................. 1.0 V/1.2 kΩ
SUBWOOFER (2ch Stereo, FRONT SP: SMALL)
................................................................................ 1.0 V/1.2 kΩ
ZONE 2 OUT ...................................................... 200 mV/1.2 kΩ
• Headphone Jack Rated Output/Impedance
CD, etc. (1 kHz, 50 mV, 8 Ω) ............................... 150 mV/100 Ω

• RIAA Equalization Deviation
PHONO (MM) .............................................................. 0 ± 0.5 dB
• Total Harmonic Distortion
PHONO (MM) to OUT (REC)
20 Hz to 20 kHz, 1 V ............................................ 0.02% or less
CD, etc. to Front L/R
2ch Stereo, 20 Hz to 20 kHz, 50 W, 8 Ω .............. 0.06% or less
• Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network)
PHONO (MM, 5 mV) to OUT (REC)
[Russia model] ....................................................... 81 dB or more
[Other models] ....................................................... 86 dB or more
CD, etc. (Effect Off, 250 mV) to Front L/R
........................................................................... 100 dB or more

• Frequency Response (MONITOR OUT)
Component (Video Conversion Off)
.............................................................. 5 Hz to 100 MHz, –3 dB

FM SECTION
• Tuning Range
[U.S.A. and Canada models] ........................... 87.5 to 107.9 MHz
[Russia model] ............................................ 87.50 to 108.00 MHz
• 50 dB Quieting Sensitivity (IHF)
1 kHz, 100% MOD., Mono ............................... 2.8 µV (20.2 dBf)
• Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF)
Mono/Stereo .............................................................. 73 dB/70 dB
HD Radio (U.S.A. model) .................................................... 80 dB
• Harmonic Distortion (1 kHz)
Mono/Stereo .......................................................................... 0.5%
HD Radio (U.S.A. model) ................................................... 0.03%

ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION

• Frequency Response
CD to Front L/R, 10 Hz to 100 kHz
...................................................................................... +0/–3 dB

• Signal to Noise Ratio
.................................................................................... 50 dB or more

• Antenna Input (unbalanced) ..................................................... 75 Ω

AM SECTION
• Tuning Range
[U.S.A. and Canada models] .............................. 530 to 1710 kHz
[Russia model] ................................................... 531 to 1611 kHz

• Residual Noise (IHF-A Network)
Front L/R ............................................................... 150 µV or less

English

• Channel Separation (1 kHz/10 kHz)
PHONO (shortened) to Front L/R ............... 60 dB/55 dB or more
CD, etc. (5.1 kΩ shortened) to Front L/R
................................................................... 60 dB/45 dB or more

127 En

Specifications

GENERAL
• Power Supply
[U.S.A. and Canada models] .............................. AC 120 V, 60 Hz
[Russia model] ................................................... AC 230 V, 50 Hz
• Power Consumption
[U.S.A. and Canada models] ................................. 400 W/500 VA
[Russia model] ................................................................... 440 W
• Standby Power Consumption
[U.S.A. and Canada models] .................................... 0.8 W or less
[Russia model] ......................................................... 0.1 W or less
• AC Outlets
[U.S.A., Canada, and China models]
.......................................................... 2 (Total 100 W maximum)
[Russia model] ..................................... 2 (Total 50 W maximum)
• Dimensions (W x H x D) ................................ 435 x 171 x 393 mm
(17-1/8 x 6-3/4 x 15-1/2 in)
• Weight ............................................................. 11.9 kg (26 lbs 4 oz)

* Specifications are subject to change without notice.

128 En

INDEX

Index
■

Numerics

1 BASIC MENU, Manual setup .......... 82
2 VOLUME MENU, Manual setup ..... 83
2ch STEREO,
Sound field program ........................ 50
3 SOUND MENU, Manual setup ........ 83
4 INPUT MENU, Manual setup .......... 84
5 OPTION MENU, Manual setup ....... 84
7ch Enhancer,
Sound field program ........................ 50
7ch STEREO,
Sound field program ........................ 50
96/24 indicator ..................................... 30

■

A

■

B

B)LFE LEVEL, Sound menu ...............93
B)SP LEVEL, Basic menu ...................89
B)VIDEO SET, Option menu ..............98
BASIC MENU, Manual setup ..............87
Basic menu, Manual setup ...................82
Basic SIRIUS Satellite Radio
operation ..........................................65
Bass cross over, Speaker settings .........89
BGV, Input menu .................................97
BI-AMP, Advanced setup ..................112
Bi-Amplifier, Advanced setup ...........112
Bluetooth adapter connection ...............25
Bluetooth component playback ............72
Bluetooth component use .....................72
Bluetooth, Troubleshooting ................119
BT connected,
Bluetooth status message ...............119

■

C

129 En

English

C)DYNAMIC RANGE,
Sound menu .....................................93
C)MEMORY GUARD,
Option menu ...................................100
C)SP DISTANCE, Basic menu ............90
C. IMAGE, Decoder parameter ...........81
Cable plugs ...........................................17
CALL SIRIUS,
SIRIUS Satellite Radio
status message ................................118
Canceled, Troubleshooting ................119
CAT SEARCH, SIRIUS tuning ...........66
CAT SEARCH, XM tuning .................61
Category Search mode,
SIRIUS tuning ..................................66
CD player connection ...........................23
Cellar Club, Sound field program ........49
CENTER PRE OUT jack
connection ........................................24
CENTER SP, Speaker settings .............88
Center speaker level,
Sound field parameter ......................79
Center speaker, Speaker settings ..........88
CENTER WIDTH,
Decoder parameter ...........................81
CH UNAUTH, XM Satellite Radio
status message ................................117
CH UNAVAIL, XM Satellite Radio
status message ................................117
Chamber, Sound field program ............48

Charge on standby, Input menu ........... 96
CHECK ANTENNA, XM Satellite Radio
status message ............................... 117
CHECK PRNS, Automatic setup warning
message ......................................... 121
CHECK SR TUNER, SIRIUS Satellite
Radio status message ..................... 118
CHECK SUR., Automatic setup error
message ......................................... 120
CHECK XM TUNER, XM Satellite Radio
status message ............................... 117
CINEMA DSP indicator ...................... 31
CLASSICAL,
Sound field category ........................ 48
Completed, Bluetooth
status message ............................... 119
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks .............. 17
Compressed Music Enhancer .............. 50
Connect error, iPod status message ... 119
Connect MIC!, Automatic setup
error message ................................. 120
Connection, AM antenna
connection ....................................... 27
Connection, audio components ........... 23
Connection, Bluetooth adapter ............ 25
Connection, CD player ........................ 23
Connection,
CENTER PRE OUT jack ................ 24
Connection, DVD player ..................... 21
Connection, DVD recorder .................. 22
Connection, External amplifier ........... 24
Connection, external decoder .............. 25
Connection, FM antenna ..................... 27
Connection,
FRONT PRE OUT jacks ................. 24
Connection, iPod universal dock ......... 25
Connection, Multi-format player ......... 25
Connection, Power cable ..................... 28
Connection, projector .......................... 20
Connection, PVR ................................. 22
Connection, set-top boxes ................... 22
Connection,
SiriusConnect tuner ......................... 64
Connection, speaker cable ................... 16
Connection,
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT jack ....... 24
Connection,
SUR.BACK PRE OUT jacks .......... 24
Connection,
SURROUND PRE OUT jacks ........ 24
Connection, Turntable ......................... 23
Connection, TV monitor ...................... 20
Connection, VCR ................................ 22
Connection,
XM Mini-Tuner Dock ..................... 59
CROSS OVER, Speaker settings ........ 89
CSII Cinema, Decoder type ................. 80
CSII Music, Decoder type ................... 80
CT LEVEL, Sound field parameter ..... 79
Current status display .......................... 44

ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION

A)DISPLAY SET, Option menu ......... 98
A)EQUALIZER, Sound menu ............. 92
A)SPEAKER SET, Basic menu ........... 87
AC OUTLETS (SWITCHED) ............. 28
ACQUIRING, SIRIUS Satellite Radio
status message ................................ 118
Action Game,
Sound field program ........................ 49
ADAPTIVE DRC indicator ................. 30
ADAPTIVE DRC, Volume menu ....... 91
ADAPTIVE DSP LEVEL,
Volume menu .................................. 91
Adaptive DSP level, Volume menu ..... 91
Adaptive dynamic range control,
Volume menu .................................. 91
Advanced setup .................................. 109
Advanced sound configurations ........... 74
Adventure, Sound field program ......... 50
ALL CH SEARCH, SIRIUS tuning .... 66
ALL CH SEARCH, XM tuning ........... 61
All Channel Search mode,
XM tuning .................................. 61, 66
All remote control codes
resetting ......................................... 104
AM antenna connection ....................... 27
AM tuning ............................................ 53
Amplifier function OSD display time,
Display settings ................................ 98
ANTENNA ERROR, SIRIUS Satellite
Radio status message ..................... 118
Audio and video synchronization,
Sound menu ..................................... 94
Audio cable plugs ................................ 17
Audio components connection ............. 23
Audio information ................................ 46
Audio input jacks selection .................. 44
AUDIO jacks ....................................... 17
Audio jacks .......................................... 17
AUDIO SELECT ................................. 44
AUDIO SELECT, Initial
configuration .................................. 100
Audio select,
Initial configuration ....................... 100
Audio signal flow ................................. 19
Auto delay, Lip sync ............................ 94

AUTO SETUP ...............................32, 82
Auto setup ............................................82
AUTO SETUP, Troubleshooting .......120
AUTO TUNING ..................................53
AUTO, Lip sync ...................................94
Automatic tuning mode,
FM/AM tuning .................................53
Available decoders with Sound field
programs ..........................................79

Index

■

D

D)INIT. CONFIG, Option menu ....... 100
D)LIPSYNC, Sound menu .................. 94
D)TEST TONE, Basic menu ............... 90
Decoder descriptions ............................ 80
Decoder indicators ............................... 30
DECODER MODE,
Initial configuration ....................... 100
Decoder mode,
Initial configuration ....................... 100
DECODER MODE, Input menu ......... 96
Decoder mode, Input menu .................. 96
Decoder selection ................................. 79
DEVICE OVER,
HDMI error message ....................... 46
DIALG.LIFT,
Sound field parameter ...................... 75
Dialogue lift,
Sound field parameter ...................... 75
DIGITAL COAXIAL jacks ................. 17
DIGITAL OPTICAL jacks .................. 17
DIMENSION, Decoder parameter ...... 81
DIMMER, Display settings ................. 98
Dimmer, Display settings .................... 98
Direct number access mode,
SIRIUS tuning ................................. 66
Direct number access mode,
XM tuning ....................................... 61
DIRECT, Sound field parameter ......... 79
Disconnected,
Bluetooth status message ............... 119
Disconnected,
iPod status message ....................... 119
Display settings, Option menu ............. 98
Displaying HD Radio information ....... 58
DIST, Auto setup result ....................... 34
DOCK indicator ................................... 30
Drama, Sound field program ............... 50
DSP effect sound level,
Sound field parameter ...................... 75
DSP indicators ..................................... 31
DSP LEVEL,
Sound field parameter ...................... 75
DVD player connection ....................... 21
DVD recorder connection .................... 22
Dynamic range, Sound menu ............... 93

■

E

E)EXTD SUR., Sound menu ............... 94
E)HDMI SET, Option menu .............. 101
E-1:NO FRONT SP, Automatic setup
error message ................................. 120
E-10:INTERNAL ERROR, Automatic
setup error message ....................... 120
E-2:NO SUR SP, Automatic setup
error message ................................. 120
E-3:NO PRNS SP, Automatic setup error
message .......................................... 120
E-4:SBR->SBL, Automatic setup error
message .......................................... 120
E-5:NOISY, Automatic setup error
message .......................................... 120
E-6:CHECK SUR., Automatic setup error
message .......................................... 120

130 En

E-7:NO MIC, Automatic setup error
message ..........................................120
E-8:NO SIGNAL, Automatic setup error
message ..........................................120
E-9:USER CANCEL, Automatic setup
error message .................................120
EFFECT LEVEL,
Sound field parameter ......................79
ENHANCER indicator .........................30
ENTERTAINMENT,
Sound field category ........................49
EQ TYPE SELECT, Equalizer ............92
EQ, Auto setup parameter ....................33
Equalizer type select, Equalizer ...........92
Equalizer, Sound menu ........................92
EXTD SUR., Initial configuration .....100
Extended surround,
Initial configuration .......................100
Extended surround, Sound menu .........94
External amplifier connection ..............24
External decoder connection ................25
EXTRA SP ASSIGN, Auto setup
parameter .........................................33
EXTRA SP ASSIGN,
Speaker settings ...............................87
Extra speaker assignment,
Auto setup parameter .......................33
Extra speaker assignment,
Speaker settings ...............................87

HDMI .................................................. 18
HDMI ASPECT .................................. 99
HDMI aspect ratio ............................... 99
HDMI AUTO, Lip sync ...................... 94
HDMI auto, Lip sync ........................... 94
HDMI indicator ................................... 30
HDMI RES., Video settings ................ 99
HDMI resolution, Video settings ........ 99
HDMI set, Option menu .................... 101
HDMI, troubleshooting ..................... 115
HEADPHONE, Dynamic range .......... 93
HEADPHONE,
Low frequency effect level .............. 93
Headphones ......................................... 45
Headphones indicator .......................... 30
Headphones, Dynamic range ............... 93
Headphones,
Low frequency effect level .............. 93

■

I

GEQ, Equalizer ....................................92
Graphic equalizer, Equalizer ................92

I/O ASSIGNMENT, Input menu ......... 95
Infrared window .................................. 31
INI.VOL., Zone 2 settings ................. 101
INIT, Advanced setup ....................... 112
INIT.DLY,
Sound field parameter ..................... 76
INIT.VOL., Volume menu .................. 91
Initial configuration,
Option menu .................................. 100
Initial delay,
Sound field parameter ..................... 76
INTERNAL ERROR, Automatic setup
error message ................................ 120
Initial volume, Volume menu .............. 91
INPUT CH, Input menu ...................... 97
Input channel and speaker
indicators ......................................... 31
Input channel indicators ...................... 31
Input channels, Input menu ................. 97
INPUT MENU, Manual setup ............. 95
Input menu, Manual setup ................... 84
INPUT RENAME, Input menu ........... 96
Input rename, Input menu ................... 96
Input signal indicators ......................... 30
Input source indicators ........................ 30
Input source information display ......... 46
Input/output assignment,
Input menu ...................................... 95
INVALID, SIRIUS Satellite Radio
status message ............................... 118
iPod universal dock connection ........... 25
iPod use ............................................... 70
iPod, Troubleshooting ....................... 119

■

■

■

F

F)ZONE2 SET, Option menu ............101
F/W UPDATING, SIRIUS Satellite Radio
status message ................................118
FL SCROLL, Display settings .............98
FM antenna ..........................................27
FM antenna connection ........................27
FM tuning .............................................53
FOCUS .................................................81
Front input, Input menu .......................97
Front panel display ...............................30
Front panel display scroll,
Display settings ................................98
FRONT PRE OUT jack
connection ........................................24
FRONT SP, Speaker settings ...............88
Front speaker set selection ...................43
Front speakers, Speaker settings ..........88
FRONT, Input menu ............................97

■

G

H

Hall in Munich,
Sound field program ........................48
Hall in Vienna,
Sound field program ........................48
HD Radio .............................................57
HD Radio information display .............58
HD Radio, Troubleshooting ...............116
HDCP ERROR,
HDMI error message .......................46

J

Jacks .................................................... 17

■

L

LEVEL ERROR, Automatic setup
warning message ........................... 121
LFE/BASS OUT, Speaker settings ..... 87
LFE/Bass out, Speaker settings ........... 87
Lip Sync, Sound menu ........................ 94

Index

LIVE/CLUB,
Sound field category ........................ 49
LIVENESS, Sound field parameter ..... 77
Liveness, Sound field parameter .......... 77
LOADING, XM Satellite Radio status
message .......................................... 117
Loading..., iPod status message ......... 119
Low-frequency effect level,
Sound menu ..................................... 93
LVL, Auto setup result ........................ 34

NO SUR SP, Automatic setup
error message .................................120
NOISY, Automatic setup
error message .................................120
Not Available, SIRIUS Satellite Radio
status message ................................118
NOT SUPPORTED, SIRIUS Satellite
Radio status message .....................118
Number of speakers,
Auto setup result ..............................34

■

■

M

■

N

■

P

P.INIT.DLY,
Sound field parameter ......................76
P.ROOM SIZE,
Sound field parameter ......................77
Pairing, Bluetooth operation ................72
PANORAMA, Decoder parameter ......81
Parameter initialization,
Advanced setup ..............................112
Parametric equalizer type,
Auto setup parameter .......................33
Parental Lock .......................................67
Parental Lock .......................................67
PARENTAL LOCK, Input menu .........68
PHONES jack .......................................45
PL LEVEL, Sound field parameter ......79
Playing video sources
in the background .............................45
PLII Game, Decoder type ....................80
PLII Movie, Decoder type ..............79, 80
PLII Music, Decoder type ....................80
PLIIx Game, Decoder type ..................80
PLIIx Movie, Decoder type ............79, 80
PLIIx Music, Decoder type ..................80
Power cable connection ........................28
PR LEVEL,
Sound field parameter ......................79
Presence left speaker level,
Sound field parameter ......................79
Presence right speaker level,
Sound field parameter ......................79

■

R

Rear panel ............................................ 10
REMOTE AMP, Advanced setup ..... 110
Remote control AMP ID,
Advanced setup ............................. 110
Remote control code
default settings ............................... 104
Remote control codes ........................... iii
Remote control codes setting ............. 104
Remote control SIRIUS ID,
Advanced setup ............................. 111
Remote control TUNER ID,
Advanced setup ............................. 110
Remote control XM ID,
Advanced setup ............................. 111
REMOTE IN/OUT jacks ..................... 26
REMOTE SR, Advanced setup ......... 111
REMOTE TU, Advanced setup ......... 110
REMOTE XM, Advanced setup ........ 111
Rename, SCENE template ................... 40
Repeat .................................................. 71
Repeat, iPod playback ......................... 71
Resetting the system .......................... 122
REV.DELAY,
Sound field parameter ..................... 78
REV.LEVEL,
Sound field parameter ..................... 78
REV.TIME,
Sound field parameter ..................... 78
Reverberation delay,
Sound field parameter ..................... 78
Reverberation level,
Sound field parameter ..................... 78
Reverberation time,
Sound field parameter ..................... 78
Roleplaying Game,
Sound field program ........................ 49
ROOM SIZE,
Sound field parameter ..................... 77
Room size,
Sound field parameter ..................... 77

131 En

English

Neo:6 Cinema, Decoder type ......... 79, 80
Neo:6 Music, Decoder type ................. 80
Neural Sur., Decoder type .................... 80
No BT Adapter, Bluetooth status
message .......................................... 119
NO FRONT SP, Automatic setup
error message ................................. 120
NO MIC, Automatic setup
error message ................................. 120
NO PRNS SP, Automatic setup
error message ................................. 120
NO SIGNAL, Automatic setup
error message ................................. 120
NO SIGNAL, XM Satellite Radio
status message ................................ 117

O

OFF AIR, XM Satellite Radio status
message ..........................................117
Operation mode selector ......................31
OPTIMIZER MIC jack ........................32
OPTION MENU, Manual setup ...........98
Option menu, Manual setup .................84
OSD SHIFT, Display settings ..............98
OSD shift, Display settings ..................98
OSD-AMP, Display settings ................98
OSD-SOURCE, Display settings .........98
Other components controlling
by remote control ...........................103
Other components controlling,
Remote control ...............................103
OUT OF PHASE, Automatic setup
warning message ............................121
Out of Res., HDMI message ................46
OVER 24m (80ft), Automatic setup
warning message ............................121

ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION

Manual delay, Lip sync ........................ 94
MANUAL SETUP ............................... 82
Manual setup ........................................ 82
MANUAL TUNING ............................ 53
Manual tuning mode,
FM/AM tuning ................................. 53
MANUAL, Lip sync ............................ 94
MAX VOL., Volume menu ................. 91
MAX VOL., Zone 2 settings ............. 101
Maximum volume, Volume menu ....... 91
Memory Guard!, Automatic setup
error message ................................. 120
Memory guard, Option menu ............. 100
MON.CHK, Advanced setup ............. 112
Monitor check, Advanced setup ........ 112
Mono Movie, Sound field program ..... 50
MOVIE, Sound field category ............. 49
MULTI CH INPUT component
selection ........................................... 43
MULTI CH INPUT jacks .................... 25
Multi-channel input BGV, Input menu,
BGV, Input menu ............................ 97
Multi-channel source playback
with headphones .............................. 51
Multi-format player connection ........... 25
Multi-information display .................... 31
MULTI-ZONE Configuration ........... 106
MUSIC ENHANCER,
Sound field category ........................ 50
Music Video,
Sound field program ........................ 49
MUTE .................................................. 45
MUTE indicator ................................... 30
Muting .................................................. 45

Presence sound field initial delay, Sound
field parameter ................................. 76
Presence sound field room size, Sound
field parameter ................................. 77
Presence speaker indicators ................. 31
Presence speaker using ........................ 13
Preset channel setting,
XM tuning ................................. 62, 67
Preset SCENE templates ..................... 39
Preset Search mode,
SIRIUS tuning ................................. 66
Preset Search mode, XM tuning .......... 61
PRESET SEARCH, SIRIUS tuning .... 66
PRESET SEARCH, XM tuning .......... 61
PRESET TUNING .............................. 53
Preset tuning mode,
FM/AM tuning ................................ 53
Pro Logic, Decoder type ...................... 80
Projector connection ............................ 20
Pure Direct ........................................... 52
Pure hi-fi sound ................................... 52
PVR connection ................................... 22

Index

■

S

S VIDEO jacks ..................................... 17
S.Audio, HDMI set ............................ 101
S.INIT.DLY,
Sound field parameter ...................... 76
S.LIVENESS,
Sound field parameter ...................... 77
S.ROOM SIZE,
Sound field parameter ...................... 77
SB INI.DLY,
Sound field parameter ...................... 76
SB LEVEL,
Sound field parameter ...................... 79
SB LIVENESS,
Sound field parameter ...................... 77
SB ROOM SIZE,
Sound field parameter ...................... 77
SBR->SBL, Automatic setup error
message .......................................... 120
SCENE 1 ................................................ 8
SCENE 2 ................................................ 8
SCENE 3 ................................................ 8
SCENE 4 ................................................ 8
SCENE IR code setting,
Advanced setup ............................. 112
SCENE IR, Advanced setup .............. 112
SCENE template rename ..................... 40
Sci-Fi, Sound field program ................. 49
Searching...,
Bluetooth status message ............... 119
Selecting
HD Radio audio programs ............... 57
Selection, Audio input jacks ................ 44
Selection, Front speaker set ................. 43
Selection,
MULTI CH INPUT component ...... 43
Selection, SCENE template ................. 37
SET MENU usage ............................... 86
Set-top box connection ........................ 22
Shuffle, iPod playback ......................... 71
SIGNAL INFO .................................... 46
Signal information ............................... 85
SILENT CINEMA ............................... 51
SILENT CINEMA indicator ................ 31
Sirius ID ............................................... 65
SIRIUS Parental Lock personal
identification number reset,
Advanced setup ............................. 112
SIRIUS Satellite Radio ........................ 64
SIRIUS Satellite Radio activation ....... 65
SIRIUS Satellite Radio Parental Lock,
Input menu ....................................... 68
SIRIUS Satellite Radio,
Troubleshooting ............................. 118
SiriusConnect tuner
connection ........................................ 64
SL LEVEL,
Sound field parameter ...................... 79
SLEEP indicator .................................. 31
Sleep timer ........................................... 47
Sound field indicators .......................... 30
Sound field parameter changing .......... 74
Sound field programs ........................... 48

132 En

Sound field programs
with headphones ..............................51
Sound field programs
without surround speakers ...............51
SOUND MENU, Manual setup ...........92
Sound menu, Manual setup ..................83
Source feature OSD display time,
Display settings ................................98
SP A B indicators .................................31
SP IMP., Advanced setup ..................109
SP, Auto setup result ............................34
Speaker cable connection .....................16
Speaker distance,
Auto setup result ..............................34
Speaker distance,
Basic menu .......................................90
Speaker distances .................................90
Speaker impedance setting ...................28
Speaker impedance,
Advanced setup ..............................109
Speaker level adjustment .....................52
Speaker level, Auto setup result ...........34
Speaker level, Basic menu ...................89
Speaker settings, Basic menu ...............87
SPEAKER, Dynamic range .................93
SPEAKER,
Low frequency effect level ..............93
Speakers, Dynamic range .....................93
Speakers,
Low frequency effect level ..............93
Specifications .....................................127
Spectacle, Sound field program ...........49
Sports, Sound field program ................49
SR LEVEL,
Sound field parameter ......................79
SR PIN, Advanced setup ....................112
Standard, Sound field program ............49
STANDBY CHARGE,
Input menu .......................................96
Standby mode, Main zone ....................29
Standby mode, Zone 2 .......................108
START PAIRING, Input menu ...........97
STEREO, Sound field category ...........50
Straight .................................................51
Straight Enhancer,
Sound field program ........................50
STRAIGHT mode ................................51
SUB UPDATED, SIRIUS Satellite Radio
status message ................................118
SUBWOOFER PHASE,
Speaker settings ...............................89
Subwoofer phase, Speaker settings ......89
SUBWOOFER PRE OUT jack
connection ........................................24
Supplied accessories ..............................2
Support audio, HDMI set ...................101
SUR. L/R SP, Speaker settings ............88
SUR.B L/R SP, Speaker settings .........88
SUR.BACK PRE OUT jack
connection ........................................24
Surround back left/right speakers,
Speaker settings ...............................88
Surround back sound field initial delay,
Sound field parameter ......................76

Surround back sound field liveness,
Sound field parameter ..................... 77
Surround back sound field room size,
Sound field parameter ..................... 77
Surround back speaker level,
Sound field parameter ..................... 79
Surround decode mode ........................ 79
Surround left speaker level,
Sound field parameter ..................... 79
Surround left/right speakers,
Speaker settings ............................... 88
SURROUND PRE OUT jack
connection ....................................... 24
Surround right speaker level,
Sound field parameter ..................... 79
Surround sound field initial delay,
Sound field parameter ..................... 76
Surround sound field liveness,
Sound field parameter ..................... 77
Surround sound field room size,
Sound field parameter ..................... 77
SYSTEM OFF ..................................... 29

■

T

Test tone, Basic menu ......................... 90
Test tone, Equalizer ............................. 92
TEST, Equalizer .................................. 92
The Bottom Line,
Sound field program ........................ 49
The Roxy Theatre,
Sound field program ........................ 49
Tonal quality adjustment ..................... 52
TRANSMIT indicator ......................... 31
Troubleshooting ................................. 113
TruBass ................................................ 81
Tuner indicators ................................... 30
Tuner, Troubleshooting ..................... 116
Turning off .......................................... 29
Turning on ........................................... 29
Turntable connection ........................... 23
TV Controlling, remote control ......... 102
TV monitor connection ....................... 20

■

U

Unable to play,
iPod status message ....................... 119
UNIT, Speaker distance ...................... 90
Unit, Speaker distance ......................... 90
Unknown iPod,
iPod status message ....................... 119
Unplug HP!, Automatic setup
error message ................................ 120
Unprocessed input sources .................. 51
UPDATING, SIRIUS Satellite Radio
status message ............................... 118
USER CANCEL,
Automatic setup error message ..... 120

■

V

VCR connection .................................. 22
VIDEO AUX jacks .............................. 26
VIDEO CONV.,
Video settings .................................. 98

Index

Video conversion,
Video settings .................................. 98
Video information ................................ 46
VIDEO jacks ........................................ 17
Video jacks .......................................... 17
Video signal flow ................................. 19
Video sources in the background ......... 45
Virtual CINEMA DSP ......................... 51
VIRTUAL indicator ............................. 31
VOL. TRIM, Input menu ..................... 96
VOLUME level indicator .................... 30
Volume menu, Manual setup ............... 83
Volume Trim, Input menu ................... 96

■

W

W-1:OUT OF PHASE, Automatic setup
warning message ............................ 121
W-2:OVER 24m (80ft), Automatic setup
warning message ............................ 121
W-3:LEVEL ERROR, Automatic setup
warning message ............................ 121
W-4:CHECK PRNS, Automatic setup
warning message ............................ 121

■

X

XM Mini-Tuner Dock .......................... 59
XM Mini-Tuner Dock connection ....... 59
XM satellite radio activation ................ 60
XM Satellite Radio display .................. 63
XM satellite radio tuning ..................... 59
XM Satellite Radio,
Troubleshooting ............................. 117
XM Satellite Radio .............................. 59

■

Y

YPAO indicator ................................... 30

■

Z
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION

Zone 2 ................................................ 106
Zone 2 Initial volume,
Zone 2 settings ............................... 101
Zone 2 Maximum volume,
Zone 2 settings .............................. 101
Zone 2 settings, Option menu ............ 101
Zone B .................................................. 43
ZONE2 indicator .................................. 31

133 En

English

“ASPEAKERS” or “4DVD”
(example) indicates the name of
the parts on the front panel or the
remote control. Refer to the
attached sheet or the pages at the
end of this manual for the
information about each position of
the parts.

■ Front panel

A B

C D

E

F

G

H

I

J

VOLUME

SPEAKERS

EDIT
SEARCH MODE

BAND

CATEGORY
A/B/C/D/E

PRESET/TUNING/CH

MEMORY

INFO

ZONE 2
ON/OFF

ZONE
CONTROL

SCENE

1

2

3

4

PROGRAM

MAIN ZONE
SYSTEM OFF

PHONES

TONE CONTROL

INPUT
STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

AUDIO SELECT

VIDEO AUX

OPTIMIZER MIC

ON/OFF

SILENT CINEMA

K

i

L

EFFECT

M

N O

S VIDEO

P

Q

R

S

VIDEO

L

AUDIO

R

OPTICAL

■ Remote control

B

1
2
3

4

CODE SET

TRANSMIT

POWER

POWER

TV

AV

C
POWER

STANDBY

D
A

SIRIUS

TUNER

XM

DOCK

CBL

V-AUX

DTV

CD

CD-R

DVD

DVR

VCR

PHONO

MD

AMP

SOURCE

5

TV VOL

TV CH

VOLUME

E
F
K

TV

TV MUTE

PROG
PROG

6

1

2

STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

5

6

MULTI CH IN

AUDIO SEL

9

0

ENHANCER

SUR. DECODE

3

4
PARAMETER

7

PRESET/CH

7

TITLE

MENU

BAND

SRCH MODE

8
9

ENT

SET MENU

LEVEL

1

2

ENHANCER

SUR. DECODE

3

4

STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

5

6

MULTI CH IN

AUDIO SEL

9

0

PARAMETER

7

8

8
SLEEP

10

M

G

MUTE

TV INPUT

L

H
I

N O

P

Q

R

ENTER
A-E/CAT.
RETURN

DISPLAY

J

MEMORY
INFO

PRG SELECT

0
REC

SCENE

1

2

3

APPENDIX

A

4

ii

List of remote control codes

CABLE TV RECEIVER
3M
A-MARK
ABC

10033
10008, 10144
10003, 10007,
10008, 10011,
10014, 10033,
10237
ACCUPHASE 10003, 10007,
10011, 10014
ACORN
10237
ACTION
10237
ACTIVE
10237
AICHI DENSHI11512
AMERICAST 10899
AMINO
11602, 11822
ARCHER
10237
BCC
10276
BELL & HOWELL
10014
BELL SOUTH 10899
BRITISH TELECOM
10003
CENTURY
10008
CLEARMASTER
10883
CLEARMAX 10883
COMTRONICS 10040
COOL BOX
10883
COOLMAX
10883
DIGEO
11187
DIGI
10637
DIRECTOR
10476
DUMONT
10637
DX ANTENNA 11500, 11502
EMERSON
10014
EVERQUEST 10040
FOSGATE
10276
FUJITSU
11497
GC ELECTRONICS
10040
GE
10144
GENERAL INSTRUMENT
10003, 10011,
10012, 10014,
10276, 10476,
10810
GIBRALTER 10003
GMI
10883
GOLDSTAR 10040, 10144
HAMLIN
10009, 10259,
10273
HITACHI
10003, 10008,
10009, 10011,
10033
HOUSTON
10011
HYTEK
10007
HYTEX
10007
I3 MICRO
11602
INSIGHT
10476, 10810
JEBSEE
10014
JERROLD
10003, 10011,
10012, 10014,
10276, 10476,
10810
MACOM
10033
MASPRO
11510
MEMOREX
10000
MITSUBISHI 10003

iii

MOTOROLA

10014, 10276,
10476, 10810,
11106, 11187,
11254, 11376
MULTITECH 10883
MYRIO
11602, 11822
NEC
11496
NOVA VISION 10008
NOVAPLEX
10008
NSC
10012, 10637
OAK
10007
PACE
10008, 10237,
10877, 11877
PANASONIC 10000, 10008,
10107, 10144,
10375, 11488,
11758, 11759,
11760, 11936,
11937, 11938
PANTHER
10637
PARAGON
10000, 10008,
10525
PENNEY
10000, 10637
PHILIPS
10259, 10317,
11305
PIONEER
10144, 10533,
10877, 11021,
11500, 11782,
11877
PRISM
10012
PULSAR
10000, 10040
PULSER
10040
QUASAR
10000
R-LINE
10040
RADIOSHACK 10883
RCA
11256
REGAL
10259, 10273,
10276, 10279
REMBRANDT 10011, 10040
RUNCO
10000
SAMSUNG
10003, 10040,
10144
SCIENTIFIC ATLANTA
10000, 10003,
10008, 10012,
10237, 10477,
10877, 11510,
11877
SEJIN
11602
SIGNAL
10011, 10040
SIGNATURE 10011
SL MARX
10040
SONY
11006, 11460
SPRUCER
10144
STARCOM
10003, 10014
STARGATE
10014, 10040
STORM
10637
SUMITOMO 11500, 11503,
11504
SUPERCABLE 10276
SUPERMAX 10883
TELEAVIA
10040
TELEVIEW
10040
THOMSON
11256
TIMELESS
10040
TOCOM
10012
TORX
10003
TOSHIBA
10000, 11509
TRISTAR
10883
TV86
10040

UNITED ARTISTS
10007
UNITED CABLE
10003, 10011,
10014, 10276
US ELECTRONICS
10003, 10008,
10276
V2
10883
VIDEOWAY
10000
VIEWMASTER10883
VISION
10883
VORTEX VIEW10883
ZENITH
10000, 10525,
10899

CABLE/PVR
COMBINATION
AMERICAST 10899
AMINO
11822
DIGEO
11187
GENERAL INSTRUMENT
10810
JERROLD
10810
MOTOROLA 10810, 11106,
11187, 11376
MYRIO
11822
PACE
10237, 11877
PIONEER
10877, 11877
RCA
11256
SCIENTIFIC ATLANTA
10877, 11877
SONY
11006
SUPERCABLE 10276
THOMSON
11256
ZENITH
10899

DBS/PVR
COMBINATION
BELL EXPRESSVU
10775, 11170
DIRECTV
10099, 10392,
10639, 11076,
11142, 11377,
11392, 11442,
11443, 11444,
11640
DISH NETWORK SYSTEM
10775, 11505
DISHPRO
10775, 11505
ECHOSTAR
10775, 11170,
11505
EXPRESSVU 10775
HUGHES NETWORK SYSTEMS
11142, 11442,
11443, 11444
JVC
11170
MOTOROLA 10869
PHILIPS
11142, 11442
PROSCAN
10392
RCA
11392
SAMSUNG
11442
SHARP
11489
SONY
10639, 11640
STAR CHOICE 10869
TIVO
11142, 11442,
11443, 11444

ZENITH

11810

SATELLITE RECEIVER
AIWA
11514, 11515
ALPHASTAR 10772
AMSTRAD
10338
AUSTAR
10879
BELL EXPRESSVU
10775, 11170
CHAPARRAL 10216
COOLSAT
11806
CROSSDIGITAL
11109
DIRECTV
10099, 10247,
10392, 10566,
10639, 10724,
10749, 10819,
11076, 11108,
11109, 11142,
11377, 11392,
11414, 11442,
11443, 11444,
11609, 11639,
11640, 11749,
11856
DISH NETWORK SYSTEM
10775, 11005,
11170, 11505,
11775
DISHPRO
10775, 11005,
11505, 11775
DX ANTENNA 11530
ECHOSTAR
10775, 11005,
11170, 11505,
11775
ESAT
10879
EXPRESSVU 10775, 11775
FORTEC STAR 11821, 11948
FOXTEL
10879, 11356
FUNAI
10338, 11377
GE
10392, 10566
GENERAL INSTRUMENT
10869
GOI
10775, 11775
GOODMANS 11246
HISENSE
11535
HITACHI
10214, 10749,
10819, 11250,
11518, 11523,
11525
HOUSTON
10775
HTS
10775, 11775
HUGHES NETWORK SYSTEMS
10749, 11142,
11442, 11443,
11444, 11749
HUMAX
11781, 11790
ILO
11535
INNOVA
10099
JERROLD
10869
JVC
10492, 10775,
11170, 11507,
11531, 11532,
11775, 11793,
11797
LG
11226, 11414
MAGNAVOX 10722, 10724
MASPRO
11520, 11530
MATSUSHITA 10214
MCINTOSH
10869

MEMOREX
MITSUBISHI
MOTOROLA
NEC

TV
3M
A-MARK
ACCURIAN
ACCUSCAN
ACTION

21616
20047, 20054,
20160
21803
20047
20030

ADMIRAL

20017, 20047,
20051, 20054,
20093, 20179,
20180, 20264,
20463
ADVENT
20761, 20783,
20815, 20817,
20842
ADVENTURI 20000
AGNA
20150
AIKO
20092
AIWA
21180
AKAI
20030, 20060,
20145, 20672,
20702, 20812,
21207, 21675,
21676, 21688,
21689, 21690,
21692, 21693,
21935
ALARON
20170, 20179
ALBA
20037
ALBATRON 20700, 20843
ALFIDE
20672
ALLERON
20030, 20170
AMBASSADOR
20150
AMERICA ACTION
20180
AMERICAN HIGH
20000, 20060
AMSTRAD
20171
AMTRON
20000, 20180
ANAM
20180
ANAM NATIONAL
20161
AOC
20030, 20180,
21365, 21590
APEX DIGITAL
20156, 20748,
20765, 20767,
20879, 20890,
21217
ASTAR
21531, 21548,
21738
AUDINAC
20180
AUDIOVOX
20092, 20179,
20180, 20451,
20623, 20802,
20875, 21284
AVENTURA 20171
BAYCREST
20186
BAYSONIC
20180
BEAUMARK 20017, 20030,
20178, 20179
BELCOR
20030
BELL & HOWELL
20054, 20093,
20154, 20179
BENQ
21032, 21212,
21315
BOXLIGHT
20893
BRADFORD 20180
BRILLIAN
21007, 21255,
21257, 21258
BROCKWOOD 20030, 20178
BROKSONIC 20180, 20236,
20463, 21935
BROTHER
20264
BYD:SIGN
21309, 21311,
21485, 21486
CADIA
21283
CANDLE
20030, 20186

CAPEHART

20017, 20030,
20036, 20092,
20178
CARNIVALE 20030
CARVER
20054, 20170
CASIO
21205
CCE
20037
CELEBRITY 20000
CELERA
20765
CHAMPION 21362
CHANGHONG 20156, 20765,
20767, 20783
CINERAL
20092, 20451
CITEK
20047
CITIZEN
20000, 20030,
20054, 20060,
20092, 20171,
20180, 20186,
20451, 20463,
21669, 21671,
21672, 21935
CLARION
20180
CLASSIC
20030, 20092
COLORTYME 20017, 20030,
20047, 20054,
20060, 20178
COMMERCIAL SOLUTIONS
20047, 21447
CONIC
20178
CONTEC
20180
CRAIG
20161, 20171,
20179, 20180
CROSLEY
20000, 20030,
20054, 20171,
20180
CROWN
20093, 20180,
20672
CROWN MUSTANG
20672
CURTIS MATHES
20000, 20030,
20037, 20047,
20051, 20054,
20060, 20093,
20145, 20154,
20166, 20178,
20179, 20180,
20451, 20702,
21147, 21347
CXC
20180
CYTRON
21326
DAEWOO
20036, 20092,
20178, 20264,
20451, 20623,
20661, 20672,
21661, 21755,
21756
DAYTON
20092
DAYTRON
20030, 20036,
20092, 20178
DELL
21080, 21178,
21264, 21403
DELTA
21369
DENON
20145, 20511
DREAM VISION
21164, 21297
DUMONT
20017, 20178,
20180
DURABRAND 20171, 20178,
20180, 20463,
21034
DWIN
20093
DYNEX
21463
EATON
20060

ELECTROBAND
20000
ELECTROGRAPH
21623, 21755
ELECTROHOME
20000, 20030,
20150, 20154,
20178, 20463,
21672
EMERALD
20178
EMERSON
20036, 20047,
20150, 20154,
20170, 20171,
20178, 20179,
20180, 20236,
20451, 20463,
20623, 21394
EMPREX
21422, 21546
ENVISION
20030, 20813,
21365
EPSON
20833, 20840,
21122, 21290
ESA
20171, 20812
FISHER
20000, 20054,
20154
FORTRESS
20093
FUJITSU
20179, 20186,
20683, 20809,
20853, 21181,
21607
FUJITSU GENERAL
20186
FUNAI
20000, 20171,
20179, 20180,
20264, 20342,
21271
FUTURETECH 20180
GATEWAY
21001, 21002,
21003, 21004,
21755, 21756
GE
20000, 20030,
20047, 20051,
20060, 20178,
20451, 21147,
21347, 21447
GEMINI
20047
GENERAL
20186
GIBRALTER 20000, 20017,
20030
GO VIDEO
20886
GOLDSTAR 20030, 20036,
20037, 20047,
20054, 20178,
21154, 21378
GOODMANS 20037
GPX
20179
GRADIENTE 20053, 20170
GRAN PRIX 20179
GRANADA
20037
GRUNDIG
20037, 20672,
20683, 20706
GRUNDY
20179, 20180
GRUNPY
20179, 20180
H&B
21366
HAIER
21034, 21748
HALLMARK 20178, 20179,
20180, 20236
HANNSPREE 21348, 21351,
21352, 21745
HARLEY DAVIDSON
20000, 20030,
20060, 20178,
20179, 20180
HARMAN/KARDON
20054

APPENDIX

10724
10749
10856, 10869
10496, 11270,
11519
NETSAT
10099
NEXT LEVEL 10869
OPTIMUS
10724
OPTUS
11356
PACE
11356
PANASAT
10879
PANASONIC 10214, 10247,
10701, 11508,
11526, 11527,
11528
PANSAT
11807
PAYSAT
10724
PHILIPS
10099, 10722,
10724, 10749,
10775, 10819,
11076, 11142,
11442, 11749
PIONEER
11142, 11442
PRIMESTAR 10869
PROSCAN
10392, 10566
PROTON
11535
RADIOSHACK 10566, 10775,
10869
RCA
10143, 10392,
10566, 10775,
10855, 11142,
11392, 11442
SAMSUNG
11108, 11109,
11142, 11276,
11377, 11442,
11609
SANYO
11182, 11219
SHARP
10494, 11489,
11513, 11517
SKY
10099, 10856
SONY
10163, 10275,
10294, 10639,
11524, 11639,
11640
STAR CHOICE 10869
STAR TRAK 10772, 10869
THOMSON
10392, 10566
TIVO
11142, 11442,
11443, 11444
TOSHIBA
10486, 10749,
10790, 11285,
11501, 11516,
11530, 11749
UEC
11356
ULTIMATETV 11392, 11640
ULTRASAT
11806
UNIDEN
10722, 10724,
11521
US DIGITAL 11535
USDTV
11535
VOOM
10869
ZENITH
10856, 11810,
11856

iv

HARVARD
20180
HAVERMY
20093
HEATHKIT
20017
HELIOS
20865
HELLO KITTY 20451
HEWLETT PACKARD
21088, 21089,
21101, 21494,
21502, 21642
HISENSE
20748, 21660
HITACHI
20000, 20017,
20036, 20047,
20051, 20054,
20145, 20178,
20179, 21145,
21150, 21245,
21345, 21378,
21445
HP
21088, 21089,
21101, 21494,
21502, 21642
HUMAX
21501
HYUNDAI
20849, 20865,
21219, 21294
ICE
20264
ILO
21286, 21603,
21684
IMA
20178, 20179,
20180, 20236
INFINITY
20054
INFOCUS
21164, 21430,
21516
INITIAL
21603
INNOVA
20037
INSIGNIA
20171, 21204,
21326, 21517,
21564, 21641,
22002, 21710
INTEQ
20017, 20145
JBL
20054
JCB
20000
JENSEN
20761, 20815,
20817, 21299
JIL
20030
JINXING
20037
JUTAN
20030
JVC
20030, 20036,
20053, 20054,
20160, 20650,
20653, 20731,
21172, 21253,
21302, 21352,
21428, 21774
KAMP
20017, 20180
KAWASHO
20030
KDS
21498
KEC
20060, 20180
KENWOOD
20030, 20180
KLH
20156, 20180,
20765, 20767
KLOSS
20030
KONKA
20180
KOST
21262, 21483
KTV
20030, 20180,
20463
LARK
20154
LG
20030, 20054,
20060, 20178,
20442, 20700,
20856, 21154,
21178, 21265,
21325, 21378,
21423, 21663,
21758

v

LLOYD'S
LOGIK
LUMATRON
LXI

MACY
MAG
MAGNASONIC

20030, 20179,
20180, 20236
20179, 20180,
20236
20037, 20264
20000, 20017,
20030, 20036,
20037, 20047,
20051, 20053,
20054, 20060,
20093, 20154,
20156, 20166,
20171, 20178,
20179
20186
21498

20000, 20030,
20054, 20092,
20093, 20156,
20179
MAGNAVOX 20000, 20030,
20036, 20037,
20047, 20051,
20054, 20060,
20092, 20154,
20171, 20179,
20180, 20186,
20250, 20706,
20802, 21198,
21254, 21365,
21454, 21525,
21755
MAJESTIC
20017
MARANTZ
20030, 20037,
20054, 20704,
20854, 20855,
21154, 21398,
21454
MARK
20037
MATSUI
20036, 20037
MATSUSHITA 20051, 20161,
20250, 20650
MAXENT
21211, 21714,
21755, 21756,
21757
MEGAPOWER 20700
MEGATRON 20047, 20145,
20178
MEMOREX
20030, 20037,
20150, 20154,
20178, 20179,
20180, 20463
MERMAID
20037
MGA
20030, 20150,
20178
MGN TECHNOLOGY
20178
MICRO
21436
MICRO GENIUS
20150
MIDLAND
20017, 20047,
20051
MINATO
20037
MINTEK
21603
MITSUBISHI 20030, 20036,
20093, 20150,
20154, 20160,
20178, 20250,
20836, 20868,
21150, 21171,
21182, 21250,
21392, 21522,
21550
MONIVISION 20700, 20843

MOTOROLA

20051, 20054,
20093, 20150,
20835
MOXELL
20835
MTC
20030, 20060,
20092, 20180
MULTITECH 20179, 20180
NAD
20037, 20156,
20166, 20178,
20866, 21156
NAKAMICHI 21493
NEC
20030, 20036,
20047, 20156,
20170, 20178,
20474, 20704,
20882, 21398,
21456, 21704,
21797
NETTV
21755
NIKKO
20030, 20092,
20178
NIKKODO
20030, 20092,
20178
NIKO
21581, 21618
NISHI
20030
NORCENT
20748, 20824,
21089, 21365,
21589, 21590,
21591
NORWOOD MICRO
21286, 21296,
21303
NTC
20092
NYON
20000
OLEVIA
21144, 21240,
21331, 21610
ONWA
20180
OPTIMUS
20030, 20093,
20150, 20154,
20166, 20178,
20180, 20250,
20650
OPTOMA
20887, 21348,
21622, 21673,
21674
OPTONICA
20093
ORION
20017, 20178,
20179, 20180,
20236, 20463,
21463
PACE
20092
PACIFIC
20037
PALSONIC
20264
PANASONIC 20000, 20030,
20051, 20054,
20156, 20161,
20236, 20250,
20650, 20863,
21168, 21175,
21177, 21291,
21310, 21335,
21410, 21480,
21510
PANDA
20706
PAUSA
20179
PAXONIC
20030, 20060
PCE
20060, 20156,
20179
PENNEY
20000, 20030,
20036, 20037,
20047, 20051,
20060, 20156,
20161, 20178,
20250, 21347,
21378

PETTERS
PHILCO

21523
20030, 20054,
20145, 20179,
20186, 20463
PHILIPS
20030, 20037,
20054, 20171,
20186, 20690,
21154, 21254,
21454, 21455,
21483, 21744
PILOT
20030, 20051,
20060, 20178
PIONEER
20166, 20679,
20866, 21260,
21398, 21457
PLANAR
21496
POLAROID
20765, 20865,
21262, 21276,
21314, 21316,
21326, 21327,
21328, 21341,
21498, 21523,
21538, 21763,
21766, 21767,
21769, 22002
PORTLAND 20092, 20451
PRECISION
20180, 20236
PRIMA
20761, 20783,
20815, 20817
PRINCETON 20700
PRISM
20051, 20250
PROSCAN
20047, 21347,
21447
PROTEC
20037, 20264
PROTON
20178
PROTRON
21320, 21323
PROVIEW
20835, 21401,
21498
PROVISION 20037
PULSAR
20017, 20092
PULSER
20092, 20178
PUNEET
21546
QUARTZ
20150, 20178
QUASAR
20051, 20250,
20650
R-LINE
20037
RABBIT
20047
RADIOSHACK 20030, 20047,
20150, 20154,
20178, 20180
RCA
20000, 20047,
20051, 20054,
20090, 20093,
20178, 20679,
21047, 21147,
21247, 21347,
21447, 21547,
21781, 22002
REALISTIC
20030, 20047,
20150, 20154,
20178, 20180
REVOX
20037
RUNCO
20017, 20030,
20060, 21292,
21397, 21398,
21628, 21629,
21638, 21639,
21679
SAMPO
20030, 20047,
21755, 21756

SAMSUNG

SPECTRONIQ 21498
SQUAREVIEW 20171
SR
2000, 20154,
20171
SSS
20180
STARLITE
20180, 20236
STUDIO EXPERIENCE
20843
SUPERSCAN 20093, 20864
SUPRE-MACY 20186
SUPREME
20000
SV2000
20054
SVA
20587, 20748,
20865, 20870,
20871
SYLVANIA
20000, 20030,
20036, 20037,
20047, 20051,
20054, 20092,
20154, 20171,
20178, 20179,
20186, 21271,
21314, 21394
SYMPHONIC 20000, 20171,
20178, 20179,
20180
SYNTAX
21144, 21240,
21331, 21610
TANDY
20093
TATUNG
20000, 20037,
20051, 21101,
21285, 21286,
21287, 21288,
21361, 21756
TEAC
20037, 20154,
20264, 20706
TECHNICS
20051, 20054,
20250
TECHNOL ACE
20179
TECHNOVOX 20030
TECHWOOD 20051, 20060,
20250
TECO
21040
TEKNIKA
20054, 20060,
20092, 20150,
20178, 20179,
20180, 20186,
20463
TELECOLOR 20017
TELEFUNKEN 20702
TELETON
20186
TEVION
20037
THOMAS
20047, 20178
THOMSON
20047, 21447
TMK
20178, 20180,
20236
TNCI
20017
TOCOM
20156
TOSHIBA
20036, 20060,
20145, 20150,
20154, 20156,
20166, 20264,
20509, 20650,
20832, 20845,
21145, 21156,
21164, 21169,
21173, 21256,
21265, 21306,
21325, 21343,
21356, 21369,
21429, 21456,
21524, 21635,
21656, 21704,
21935

TOTEVISION
TOYOMENKA
TRUETONE
TRUTECH
TVS
ULTRA
UNIVERSAL
UNIVERSUM

20051
20178
20051, 20250
21723
20463
20092, 21323
20047
20036, 20037,
20170, 20264,
20474
US LOGIC
21286, 21303
V
20864, 20885,
21755, 21756
VECTOR RESEARCH
20030
VEOS
21007
VICTOR
20036, 20053,
20160, 20653,
21428
VIDIKRON
20054, 21292,
21302, 21397,
21398, 21628,
21629
VIDTECH
20036, 20178
VIEWSONIC 20857, 20864,
20885, 21330,
21542, 21578,
21627, 21640,
21742, 21755
VIKING
20060
VIORE
21207, 21684
VISART
21336
VIZIO
20864, 20885,
21499, 21755,
21756, 21758
WARDS
20000, 20017,
20030, 20037,
20047, 20051,
20054, 20093,
20154, 20166,
20178, 20179,
20186, 20236,
20866, 21156
WAYCON
20156
WELTON
20178
WESTINGHOUSE
20000, 20451,
20885, 20889,
20890, 21092,
21282, 21577,
21712
WHITE WESTINGHOUSE
20179, 20236,
20451, 20463,
20623, 20889
WINBOOK
21381
WORLD
20180, 20236,
20451, 20463
WYSE
21365
XR-1000
20154, 20171,
20179, 20180
YAMAHA
20030, 20769,
20833, 20839,
21405, 21406,
21407, 21526,
21522
YORX
20030
ZENITH
20000, 20017,
20030, 20037,
20047, 20092,
20093, 20145,
20160, 20171,
20178, 20463,
20812, 21145,
21265

PVR
ABS
31972
ALIENWARE 31972
CYBERPOWER31972
DELL
31972
DIRECTV
30739
GATEWAY
31972
GO VIDEO
30614
HEWLETT PACKARD
31972
HITACHI
30140, 31718
HOWARD COMPUTERS
31972
HP
31972
HUGHES NETWORK SYSTEMS
30739
HUMAX
30739, 31797,
31988
HUSH
31972
IBUYPOWER 31972
JVC
31279
LINKSYS
31972
MEDIA CENTER PC
31972
MICROSOFT 31972
MIND
31972
MITSUBISHI 31714
NIVEUS MEDIA
31972
NORTHGATE 31972
PANASONIC 30614, 30616,
31244, 31732,
31807, 31808,
31809
PHILIPS
30618, 30739
PIONEER
31337, 31803
RCA
30880
REPLAYTV
30614, 30616
SAMSUNG
30739
SHARP
31742, 31810,
31893
SONIC BLUE 30614, 30616
SONY
30636, 31447,
31448, 31636,
31972
STACK 9
31972
SYSTEMAX 31972
TAGAR SYSTEMS
31972
TIVO
30618, 30636,
30739, 31337
TOSHIBA
30828, 31008,
31739, 31972,
31988, 31996
TOUCH
31972
VICTOR
31706
VIEWSONIC 31972
VOODOO
31972
ZT GROUP
31972

VCR
A-MARK

30000, 30037,
30046, 30240,
30278
ABS
31972
ACCURIAN
30000
ADMIRAL
30020, 30039,
30047, 30048,
30060, 30062,
30065, 30104,
30209, 30479
ADVENTURA 30000, 30037,
30240

vi

APPENDIX

20017, 20030,
20036, 20037,
20047, 20054,
20060, 20154,
20178, 20264,
20587, 20702,
20766, 20812,
20814, 21060,
21312, 21395,
21458
SANKY
20030, 20060
SANSUI
20030, 20060,
20463, 21935
SANYO
20000, 20036,
20037, 20047,
20054, 20088,
20154, 20171,
20376, 20424,
20463, 20799,
20893, 21142,
21179, 21755
SAVILLE
20060
SCEPTRE
20878, 21217,
21360, 21599
SCOTCH
20178
SCOTT
20030, 20178,
20179, 20180,
20236, 21711
SEARS
20000, 20017,
20030, 20036,
20037, 20047,
20051, 20053,
20054, 20060,
20093, 20154,
20156, 20166,
20171, 20178,
20179, 21007
SELECO
21297, 21351
SHARP
20036, 20054,
20093, 20179,
20180, 20256,
20787, 20818,
20851, 21165,
21453, 21459,
21602
SHENG CHIA 20093
SHERWOOD 21399
SHIVAKI
20037, 20178
SIEMENS
20145
SIGNATURE 20030, 20047,
20093, 20179
SIGNET
21262
SIM2 MULTIMEDIA
21297
SIMPSON
20030, 20178,
20186
SINGER
20060, 20092
SKY-NORTH 20037
SOLAR DRAPE20000
SOLE
20813
SONY
20000, 20017,
20036, 20053,
20150, 20154,
20810, 20834,
20867, 21100,
21167, 21300,
21317, 21651,
21685
SOUNDESIGN 20178, 20179,
20180, 20186
SOVA
21320
SOYO
21520, 21546
SPECTRAVISION
20156, 20178,
20179, 20186

ADYSON
AIKO
AIWA

30072
30278
30000, 30037,
30124, 30307,
30348, 30479,
31137, 31284,
31291, 31332,
31336
AKAI
30041, 30049,
30061, 30106,
30175, 30242
ALBA
30072, 30209,
30278, 30295
ALIENWARE 31972
ALLEGRO
30039, 31137
AMERICA ACTION
30278
AMERICAN HIGH
30035, 30081
AMSTRAD
30000
ANAM NATIONAL
30226
ASHA
30240
ASTRA
30035, 30240
AUDIO DYNAMICS
30040
AUDIOVOX
30037, 30038,
30054, 30278
AVIS
30000, 30072
BEAUMARK 30240
BELL & HOWELL
30000, 30035,
30039, 30046,
30048, 30104,
30479
BROKSONIC 30002, 30121,
30184, 30208,
30209, 30295,
30348, 30479,
31479
CALIX
30037
CANDLE
30037, 30038
CANON
30034, 30035
CAPEHART
30002, 30020,
30062
CARRERA
30240
CARVER
30035, 30081
CCE
30072, 30278
CINERAL
30278
CINEVISION 31137
CITIZEN
30000, 30035,
30036, 30037,
30209, 30240,
30278, 30479,
31278
CLASSIC
30037
COLORTYME 30035, 30045,
30060, 30278
COLT
30000, 30072
CRAIG
30037, 30047,
30072, 30240,
30271
CRITERION 30000, 30072
CROSLEY
30000, 30035,
30081, 30110,
30149
CROWN
30072, 30278
CURTIS MATHES
30000, 30035,
30041, 30060,
30162, 30240,
30278, 30432,
30643, 30760,
31035
CYBERNEX 30240

vii

CYBERPOWER31972
DAEWOO
30020, 30037,
30045, 30046,
30278, 30561,
30637, 31137,
31278
DAYTRON
30020, 30037,
30278
DBX
30040
DELL
31972
DENON
30042, 30081
DERWENT
30041
DIRECTV
30739
DUAL
30000
DUMONT
30040
DURABRAND 30038, 30039
DYNATECH 30000, 30240
ELECTROHOME
30000, 30037,
30043, 30060,
30061, 30209,
30240
ELECTROPHONIC
30037
EMERALD
30121, 30184
EMEREX
30032
EMERSON
30000, 30002,
30036, 30037,
30043, 30061,
30068, 30121,
30184, 30202,
30208, 30209,
30212, 30240,
30278, 30295,
30348, 30378,
30479, 30510,
30561, 30593,
30637, 31278,
31479, 31593
ESA
31137
FISHER
30000, 30039,
30046, 30047,
30054, 30066,
30104
FUJI
30033, 30035
FUJITSU
30000, 30045
FUNAI
30000, 30037,
30072, 30278,
30593, 31333,
31593
GARRARD
30000
GATEWAY
31972
GE
30000, 30035,
30048, 30060,
30065, 30077,
30149, 30202,
30240, 30760,
30761, 30807,
31035, 31060
GEMINI
30060
GENERAL
30045
GENEXXA
30000, 30037,
30278
GO VIDEO
30240, 30279,
30432, 30526,
30614, 30643,
31137
GOLDSTAR 30000, 30035,
30037, 30038,
30039, 30054,
30278, 31137,
31237

GOODMANS 30000, 30020,
30037, 30062,
30072, 30081,
30278, 30637
GRADIENTE 30000, 30008,
30408
GRANADA
30042, 30081
GRUNDIG
30034, 30081,
30226
HARLEY DAVIDSON
30000
HARMAN/KARDON
30038, 30075,
30081
HARVARD
30068, 30072
HARWOOD
30068, 30072
HEADQUARTER
30046
HEWLETT PACKARD
31972
HI-Q
30000, 30035,
30047
HITACHI
30000, 30035,
30037, 30041,
30042, 30045,
30065, 30082,
30089, 30105,
30140, 30166,
30544, 31037,
31286, 31326,
31718
HOWARD COMPUTERS
31972
HP
31972
HUGHES NETWORK SYSTEMS
30042, 30739
HUMAX
30739, 31797,
31988
HUSH
31972
HYTEK
30000, 30036,
30047, 30072
IBUYPOWER 31972
INSTANT REPLAY
30035, 30226
ITT NOKIA
30041, 30240
JANEIL
30240
JENSEN
30041, 30067
JVC
30008, 30041,
30061, 30067,
30206, 31162,
31279, 31283,
31299, 31329
KEC
30037, 30278
KENWOOD
30038, 30041,
30046, 30067
KLH
30072
KODAK
30035, 30037
KTV
30000
LG
30037, 30038,
30240, 31037,
31137
LIFETEC
30348
LINKSYS
31972
LLOYD'S
30000, 30036,
30038, 30040,
30072, 30208,
30240
LOEWE
30081
LOGIK
30000, 30072,
30240
LUMATRON 30278
LUXOR
30046, 30106
LXI
30000, 30037,
30042, 30054,
30067

M ELECTRONIC
30240
MAGNASONIC
30000, 30020,
30037, 30072,
30082, 30240,
30278, 30593,
31278
MAGNAVOX 30000, 30035,
30037, 30039,
30048, 30054,
30081, 30110,
30149, 30226,
30240, 30563,
30593, 30618,
31593, 31781
MAGNIN
30240
MARANTZ
30035, 30038,
30062, 30081,
31381
MARTA
30037
MATSUI
30036, 30037,
30209, 30295,
30348
MATSUSHITA 30035, 30081,
30162, 30226,
31162
MEDIA CENTER PC
31972
MEDION
30348
MEI
30035
MEMOREX
30000, 30035,
30037, 30039,
30046, 30047,
30048, 30054,
30062, 30072,
30104, 30162,
30209, 30240,
30278, 30307,
30348, 30479,
31037, 31162,
31237, 31262
METZ
30037
MGA
30043, 30060,
30061, 30240
MGN TECHNOLOGY
30240
MICROSOFT 31972
MIDLAND
30240
MIND
31972
MINOLTA
30042, 30105
MITSUBISHI 30000, 30041,
30042, 30043,
30047, 30048,
30060, 30061,
30067, 30075,
30173, 30214,
30242, 30443,
30807, 31343,
31631, 31714
MOTOROLA 30035, 30048
MOVIE WALKER
30072
MTC
30000, 30072,
30240
MTX
30000
MULTITECH 30000, 30039,
30072
NAD
30104, 30240
NEC
30038, 30040,
30041, 30067,
30082, 30104,
31287, 31288
NEW TECH
30072
NIKKO
30037, 30278

PULSAR

30039, 30240,
30278
PULSER
30240
QUARTER
30046
QUARTZ
30035, 30046,
30047
QUASAR
30002, 30035,
30077, 30162,
30226, 31035,
31162
RADIOSHACK 30000, 30035,
30037, 30046,
30047, 30048,
30062, 30066,
30104, 30162,
30240, 31037,
31162
RADIX
30037
RANDEX
30037
RCA
30000, 30035,
30042, 30045,
30048, 30054,
30060, 30065,
30077, 30105,
30106, 30149,
30166, 30202,
30240, 30760,
30761, 30807,
30880, 31035,
31060
REALISTIC
30000, 30035,
30037, 30046,
30047, 30048,
30062, 30065,
30066, 30104,
30121, 30162,
30240, 30278,
31162
REPLAYTV
30614, 30616
RICAVISION 31972
RICOH
30034
RIO
31137
RUNCO
30039
SALORA
30075
SAMSUNG
30000, 30038,
30045, 30060,
30077, 30240,
30432, 30739,
31014
SAMTRON
30240, 30643
SANKY
30039, 30048
SANSUI
30000, 30002,
30041, 30067,
30072, 30082,
30209, 30240,
30271, 30479,
31479
SANYO
30000, 30046,
30047, 30104,
30159, 30240,
30479, 31330,
31331
SCIENTIFIC ATLANTA
30008
SCOTT
30036, 30043,
30045, 30121,
30184, 30208,
30210, 30212

SEARS

30000, 30033,
30034, 30035,
30036, 30037,
30039, 30041,
30042, 30043,
30045, 30046,
30047, 30048,
30054, 30060,
30065, 30066,
30067, 30072,
30104, 30105,
30162, 30209,
31237
SHARP
30000, 30032,
30047, 30048,
30062, 30065,
30807, 30848,
31285, 31742,
31810, 31893
SHINTOM
30000, 30039,
30072, 30208,
30240
SHOGUN
30240
SIEMENS
30037, 30104
SIGNATURE 30000, 30035,
30037, 30046,
30048, 30060,
30065, 30066,
30149, 30479
SINGER
30037, 30072,
30240
SONIC BLUE 30614, 30616,
30643, 31137
SONOGRAPHE30046
SONY
30000, 30032,
30033, 30034,
30035, 30046,
30047, 30049,
30067, 30226,
30636, 31032,
31232, 31295,
31296, 31297,
31447, 31448,
31636, 31702,
31972
SOUNDMASTER
30000
STACK 9
31972
STS
30042, 30105
SV2000
30000, 30072
SVA
30000
SYLVANIA
30000, 30035,
30043, 30081,
30110, 30593,
31593, 31781
SYMPHONIC 30000, 30002,
30240, 30593,
31593
SYSTEMAX 31972
TAGAR SYSTEMS
31972
TANDY
30000, 30104
TASHIKO
30037
TATUNG
30000, 30008,
30041, 30048,
30067, 30081
TEAC
30000, 30041,
30067
TECHNICS
30000, 30035,
30037, 30162
TEKNIKA
30000, 30035,
30037
TELECORDER 30240
TELEFUNKEN 30041, 30208
TEVION
30479

THOMAS
THOMSON

30000, 30002
30041, 30060,
30202
TISONIC
30278
TIVO
30618, 30636,
30739, 31337,
31996
TMK
30000, 30036,
30208, 30240
TNIX
30037
TOCOM
30240
TOSHIBA
30000, 30041,
30042, 30043,
30045, 30054,
30062, 30066,
30209, 30210,
30212, 30240,
30544, 30828,
30845, 31008,
31145, 31289,
31290, 31323,
31325, 31739,
31972, 31988,
31996
TOSONIC
30278
TOTEVISION 30037, 30240
TOUCH
31972
TRIX
30037
ULTRA
30020, 30045,
30278
UNITECH
30240
VECTOR
30045
VECTOR RESEARCH
30038, 30040,
30184
VEXTRA
30072
VICTOR
30008, 30041,
30067, 31283,
31299, 31706
VIDEO CONCEPTS
30040, 30045,
30061, 30210,
30242
VIDEOMAGIC 30037
VIDEOSONIC 30000, 30072,
30240
VIEWSONIC 31972
VILLAIN
30000
VOODOO
31972
WARDS
30000, 30033,
30035, 30037,
30038, 30041,
30042, 30043,
30045, 30046,
30047, 30048,
30060, 30062,
30065, 30072,
30081, 30149,
30212, 30240,
30479, 30760
WHARFEDALE
30593
WHITE WESTINGHOUSE
30000, 30072,
30209, 30278,
30479, 30637
WORLD
30002, 30209,
30479
XR-1000
30000, 30035,
30072, 30208,
30240
YAMAHA
30038, 30041

viii

APPENDIX

NIKKODO
30037, 30278
NIKON
30034
NISHI
30240
NIVEUS MEDIA
31972
NOBLEX
30240
NORTHGATE 31972
OLYMPUS
30035, 30104,
30162, 30226
ONKYO
30222
OPTIMUS
30000, 30035,
30037, 30047,
30048, 30054,
30062, 30104,
30162, 30240,
30432, 30593,
31048, 31062,
31162, 31262
OPTONICA
30062
ORION
30000, 30002,
30036, 30104,
30121, 30184,
30208, 30209,
30240, 30278,
30295, 30479,
31479
PANAMA
30035
PANASONIC 30000, 30020,
30035, 30077,
30162, 30225,
30226, 30378,
30614, 30616,
31035, 31062,
31162, 31244,
31262, 31292,
31293, 31308,
31317, 31732,
31807, 31808,
31809
PENNEY
30000, 30035,
30037, 30038,
30040, 30042,
30047, 30054,
30067, 30077,
30081, 30162,
30240, 31035,
31237
PENTAX
30042, 30065,
30105
PHILCO
30000, 30035,
30081, 30110,
30209, 30479
PHILIPS
30000, 30034,
30035, 30045,
30048, 30062,
30081, 30110,
30162, 30209,
30616, 30618,
30739, 31081,
31181, 31266,
31381
PILOT
30037
PIONEER
30042, 30067,
30081, 30162,
31337, 31803
POLK AUDIO 30081
PORTLAND 30020, 30278
PRESIDIAN
31593
PROFITRONIC 30240
PROSCAN
30060, 30202,
30760, 30761,
31060
PROTEC
30000, 30072
PROTECH
30072

ZENITH

ZT GROUP

30000, 30033,
30034, 30037,
30039, 30041,
30209, 30278,
30479, 30637,
31137, 31139,
31479
31972

DVD PLAYER
3D LAB
ACCURIAN

40503, 40539
40675, 41072,
41416, 41737
ACOUSTIC SOLUTIONS
40730
ADCOM
41094
ADVENT
41016
AFREEY
40698
AIWA
40641
AKAI
40695, 40705,
40770, 40899,
41089
ALBA
40672, 40717
ALCO
40790
ALLEGRO
40869
AMPHION MEDIA WORKS
40872, 41245
AMW
40872, 41245
APEX DIGITAL
40533, 40672,
40717, 40755,
40794, 40795,
40796, 40797,
40830, 40856,
41004, 41020,
41056, 41061,
41100, 41126
ARCAM
40732
ARRGO
41023
ASPIRE DIGITAL
40594, 41168,
41391, 41407
ASTAR
41461, 41489,
41494, 41678,
41679
AUDIOLOGIC 40736
AUDIOVOX
40717, 40790,
41041, 41071,
41072, 41121,
41122
AWA
40730
AXION
41071, 41072
B&K
40655, 40662
BANG & OLUFSEN
41696
BBK
41224
BEL CANTO DESIGN
41571
BLADELIUS 41682
BLAUPUNKT 40717
BLUE PARADE40571
BLUE SKY
40695, 40699
BOSE
41895
BOSS AUDIO SYSTEMS
41680
BRANDT
40651
BROKSONIC 40695, 40868,
41419
BUSH
40690
BYD:SIGN
40872
CALIFORNIA AUDIO LABS
40490
CAMBRIDGE AUDIO
41471

ix

CAMBRIDGE SOUNDWORKS
40690
CARY AUDIO DESIGN
41477
CAVS
41057, 41387
CELESTIAL 41020
CENTREX
40672, 41004
CENTRIOS
41577
CINEA
40831
CINEMATRIX 41052
CINEVISION 40833, 40869,
40876, 41483
CITIZEN
40695, 41003,
41277, 41587,
42116
CLAIRTONE 40571
CLASSE
41543
COBY
40778, 40852,
41077, 41086,
41107, 41165,
41177, 41321,
41351, 41628
CRAIG
40831
CREATIVE
40503, 40539
CURTIS MATHES
41087
CYBERHOME 40816, 40874,
41023, 41024,
41117, 41129,
41502, 41537
CYTRON
40705
D-LINK
41881
DAEWOO
40705, 40770,
40784, 40833,
40869, 41169,
41172, 41234,
41242, 41441,
41443
DANSAI
40770
DAYTEK
40122, 40872
DECCA
40770
DENON
40490, 40634,
41282, 41634,
42134
DENVER
40778
DESAY
41407, 41455
DIAMOND VISION
41316, 41609,
41610
DIGITALMAX 41738
DIGITREX
40672
DISNEY
40675, 41270
DIVIDO
40705
DUAL
40675, 41068,
41085
DURABRAND 41127
DVD2000
40521
ELECTROHOME
41003, 41729,
42116
ELTA
40690
EMERSON
40591, 40675,
40821, 41268
ENCORE
41374
ENTERPRISE 40591
ENTIVO
40503, 40539
ENZER
40770
ESA
40821, 41268,
41443
FIRSTLINE
40651
FISHER
40670
FUNAI
40675, 41268,
41334
GATEWAY
41073, 41077,
41158, 41194

GE

40522, 40717,
40815
GENICA
40750
GO VIDEO
40573, 40715,
40717, 40741,
40744, 40783,
40833, 40869,
41044, 41075,
41099, 41144,
41148, 41158,
41304, 41443,
41483, 41730
GO VISION
41071, 41072
GOLDSTAR
40741, 40801,
40869
GOODMANS 40790
GPX
40699, 40769
GRADIENTE 40490, 40651
GREENHILL 40717
GRUNDIG
40539, 40705
HARMAN/KARDON
40582, 40702
HELIOS
42080
HELLO KITTY 40831
HITACHI
40573, 40664,
41247, 41664,
41764, 41765,
41766
HITEKER
40672
HUMAX
41500, 41588
I-O DATA
41405
ILO
41348, 41472
INITIAL
40717, 41472
INNOVATIVE TECHNOLOGY
41542
INOI
41747
INSIGNIA
41013, 41268,
41712, 42095
INTEGRA
40571, 40627,
41634
INTERVIDEO 41124
IRT
40783
JATON
41078
JBL
40702
JENSEN
40174, 41016
JMB
40695
JSI
41423
JVC
40558, 40623,
40867, 41164,
41241, 41275,
41550, 41590,
41591, 41592,
41594, 41602
JWIN
41049, 41051,
41469, 41675
KALEIDESCAPE
41790
KAWASAKI
40790
KENWOOD
40490, 40534,
40682, 40737
KLH
40717, 40790,
41020, 41149,
41261
KLOSS
40533
KONKA
40711, 40719,
40720, 40721
KOSCH
41677
KOSS
40651, 40769,
40896, 41061,
41423
KREISEN
41421
KRELL
41498
LAFAYETTE 41369
LANDEL
40826

LASONIC

40627, 40798,
41173, 41747
LECSON
41533
LENOXX
41127
LEXICON
40671
LG
40591, 40741,
40801, 40869,
41526, 41600
LITEON
41058, 41158,
41416, 41440,
41656, 41738
LOEWE
40511, 40741
LOGIX
40783
MAGNASONIC40651, 40675
MAGNAVOX 40503, 40539,
40646, 40675,
40821, 41268,
41354, 41472,
41506
MALATA
40782, 41159
MARANTZ
40503, 40539,
40675, 41627
MCINTOSH
41273, 41373,
41533
MEDION
40651
MEMOREX
40695, 40831,
41270
MERIDIAN
41497
MICROSOFT 40522, 41708,
42083
MINATO
40752
MINTEK
40717, 40839,
41472
MITSUBISHI 40521, 41403,
41521, 41629
MIXSONIC
41130
MOMITSU
41082, 41626
MUSTEK
40730
MYRYAD
40894
NAD
40692, 40741
NAIKO
40770
NAKAMICHI 41222
NAXA
41473
NEC
40785, 40869,
41404
NESA
40717
NEUNEO
40509, 41454
NEXT BASE 40826
NEXXTECH 41402
NINTAUS
41051
NORCENT
40719, 40872,
41003, 41107,
41265, 41457,
41461
NOVA
41517, 41518,
41519, 41520
ONKYO
40503, 40627,
40792, 41417,
41418, 41612,
41627, 41769
OPPO
40575, 41224,
41525, 42115
OPTIMUS
40571
OPTOMEDIA ELECTRONICS
40896
ORION
41695
ORITRON
40651
PALSONIC
40672, 40852
PANASONIC 40490, 40503,
40571, 40632,
40703, 41010,
41011, 41282,
41362, 41462,
41490, 41632,
41641, 41762

PHILCO
PHILIPS

SHERWOOD

40633, 40770,
41043, 41077,
41889
SHINSONIC 40533, 40839
SIGMA DESIGNS
40674
SILVERCREST 41368
SLIM ART
40784
SM ELECTRONIC
40690, 40730
SONIC BLUE 40573, 40715,
40783, 40869,
41099
SONY
40533, 40772,
40864, 41033,
41069, 41070,
41431, 41433,
41516, 41533,
41536, 41548,
41633
SOVA
41122
SUNGALE
41074, 41342,
41532
SUPERSCAN 40821
SVA
40717, 40860,
41105
SYLVANIA
40675, 40821,
41268
SYMPHONIC 40675, 40821,
41268, 41334
TAG MCLAREN
40894
TATUNG
40770
TEAC
40571, 40692,
40717, 40790,
40809
TECHNICS
40490, 40703
TECHNIKA
40770
TECHNOSONIC
40730
TECHWOOD 40692
TERAPIN
41031, 41053,
41166
TEVION
40651
THETA DIGITAL
40571
THOMSON
40511, 40522
THULE AUDIO41007
TIVO
41503, 41512,
41588
TOSHIBA
40503, 40539,
40573, 40695,
41045, 41154,
41503, 41510,
41515, 41588,
41595, 41608,
41639, 41769
TREDEX
40799, 40800,
40803, 40804
UNIMAX
40770
UNITED
40730
UNIVERSUM 40591
URBAN CONCEPTS
40503, 40539
US LOGIC
40839
V
41064, 41126,
41226
VENTURER 40790
VIALTA
41509
VICTOR
41241, 41597
VIEWMAGE 41374
VIZIO
41064, 41126,
41226
VOCOPRO
41027, 41360
WESDER
40699

WINTEL
WYSE
XBOX

41131
41652
40522, 41708,
42083
XWAVE
41001
YAMAHA
40490, 40497,
40539, 40545,
40817, 41282,
42543, 42544
YAMAKAWA 40872
ZENITH
40503, 40591,
40741, 40869
ZEUS
40784
ZOECE
41265

BLU-RAY/HD DVD
PLAYER
LG
ONKYO
PANASONIC
PHILIPS
PIONEER
RCA
SAMSUNG
SONY
TOSHIBA

40741
41769
41641
42084
40142
41769
40199
41516
41515, 41769

LD PLAYER
AIWA
CARVER
DENON

40203
40064, 40194
40059, 40172,
40241

DISCO VISION
40023
FUNAI
40203
HARMAN/KARDON
40194
HITACHI
40023
KENWOOD
40236, 40258
MAGNAVOX 40064, 40194,
40217, 40241
MARANTZ
40064, 40194
MITSUBISHI 40059, 40241
NAD
40059
OPTIMUS
40059
PANASONIC 40204
PHILIPS
40064, 40194
PIONEER
40023, 40059,
40241
POLK AUDIO 40194
QUASAR
40204
REALISTIC
40203
SEGA
40023
SHARP
40001
SONY
40193, 40201
TECHNICS
40204
THETA DIGITAL
40194
TOSHIBA
40059
VICTOR
40245
WARDS
40059
YAMAHA
40217

DVD RECORDER
ACCURIAN
50675, 51416
APEX DIGITAL
51056
ASPIRE DIGITAL
51168
ASTAR
51489
BROKSONIC 51419
CITIZEN
52116

COBY
51086
CYBERHOME 51129, 51502
DENON
50490
DIGITALMAX 51738
ELECTROHOME
52116
EMERSON
50675
FUNAI
50675, 51334
GATEWAY
51073, 51158,
51194
GO VIDEO
50741, 51158,
51304, 51730
HITACHI
51664, 51764
ILO
51348
JVC
51164, 51275
KREISEN
51421
LG
50741
LITEON
51158, 51416,
51440, 51738
MAGNAVOX 50646, 50675,
51506
MITSUBISHI 51403, 51629
NEC
51404
PANASONIC 50490, 51010,
51011
PHILIPS
50646, 51340
PIONEER
50631, 51460,
51475, 51476,
51512
POLAROID
51086
PRESIDIAN
51738
RCA
50522
SAMSUNG
50490
SANYO
51583
SENSORY SCIENCE
51158
SHARP
50630, 50675,
51556, 51642,
52550
SONY
51033, 51069,
51070, 51431,
51433, 51536
SYLVANIA
50675
TOSHIBA
51510, 51588,
51639
VICTOR
51597, 51275
YAMAHA
52544
ZENITH
50741

CD PLAYER
ACOUSTIC RESEARCH
60420
ADC
60018
ADCOM
60234
ADMIRAL
60305
AIWA
60157
AKAI
60083, 60643,
61688
ALBA
60625
ANAM NATIONAL
60362
ARCAM
60157
AUDIO PRO 60437
AUDIO RESEARCH
60157
BURMESTER 60420
CAIRN
60157
CALIFORNIA AUDIO LABS
60029, 60303
CAMBRIDGE AUDIO
61731
CAMBRIDGE SOUNDWORKS
60157

APPENDIX

40675, 40690
40503, 40539,
40646, 40671,
40675, 40854,
41260, 41267,
41340, 41354,
41846, 42056,
42084
PHONOTREND40699
PIANODISC 41024
PIONEER
40142, 40525,
40571, 40631,
40632, 40638,
41460, 41475,
41476, 41512,
41571
POLAROID
41013, 41020,
41061, 41086,
41245, 41261,
41316, 41478,
41480, 41482
POLK AUDIO 40539
PORTLAND 40770
PRESIDIAN
40675, 41072,
41738
PRIMA
41016
PRIMARE
40886, 41467,
41618
PRINCETON 40674
PROCEED
40672
PROSCAN
40522
PROSONIC
40699
PROTRON
41461
PROVISION
40778
QWESTAR
40651
RADIONETTE 40741
RADIOSHACK 40571
RCA
40522, 40571,
40717, 40790,
40822, 41013,
41022, 41132,
41193, 41769
REALISTIC
40571
REALMAGIC 40674
REOC
40752
REVOY
40699
RIO
40869
RJTECH
40118, 41360,
41376
ROTEL
40623, 41178,
41734
ROWA
40823, 41004
SABA
40651
SAMPO
40698, 40752,
41501
SAMSUNG
40199, 40490,
40573, 40744,
40820, 40899,
41044, 41075,
41470, 41599,
42069
SANSUI
40695, 41695
SANYO
40670, 40675,
40695, 40873,
41334, 41583
SCHNEIDER 40783
SCHWAIGER 40752
SENSORY SCIENCE
41158
SHARP
40630, 40675,
40752, 41256,
41556, 41642,
42550
SHARPER IMAGE
41117

x

CARVER

60157, 60179,
60437
CARY AUDIO DESIGN
61876
CCE
60643
CLASSIC
61297
CURTIS MATHES
60032
DENON
60003, 60034,
60626, 60766,
60873
DKK
60000
DMX ELECTRONICS
60157
EMERSON
60305
FISHER
60000, 60179,
61325
FUNAI
60305
GARRARD
60420
GEMINI
60625
GENEXXA
60032, 60305
GOLDSTAR 61208
GPX
61296
GRUNDIG
60157
HAFLER
60173
HARMAN/KARDON
60083, 60100,
60157, 60173,
61202
HITACHI
60032
INKEL
60157, 60180
INTEGRA
60101
JERROLD
60003
JVC
60032, 60072,
61294
KENWOOD
60000, 60028,
60029, 60037,
60190, 60626,
60681, 60826,
61683
KLH
61318, 61711
KOSS
61317
KRELL
60157
KYOCERA
60018
LG
61208
LINN
60157
LUXMAN
60328, 60489
LXI
60179, 60305
MAGNAVOX 60038, 60157,
60274, 60305
MARANTZ
60029, 60038,
60157, 60180,
60373, 60435,
60626
MARK LEVINSON
61484
MATSUI
60157
MCINTOSH
60256, 60290,
60660, 61703
MCS
60029, 60043
MEMOREX
60000, 60032,
60179, 60420,
60437, 60468
MGA
60083
MICROMEGA 60157
MIRO
60000
MISSION
60157
MITSUBISHI 60083, 60098,
60808
MODULAIRE 60000, 60032,
60087, 60145,
60179, 60180,
60420, 60437,
60468
MTC
60420, 60625

xi

MYRYAD
NAD
NAKAMICHI
NEC
NIKKO
NSM
ONKYO

60157
61208
60147, 60373
60043, 60234
60362, 60625
60157
60101, 60868,
61327, 61685
OPTIMUS
60000, 60032,
60037, 60087,
60145, 60179,
60305, 60420,
60437, 60468,
61063, 61075
PANASONIC 60029, 60303,
60388, 60752,
61682
PARASOUND 60420
PENNEY
60029
PHILIPS
60157, 60274,
60626
PIONEER
60032, 60305,
60468, 61062,
61063, 61087
POLK AUDIO 60157
PRIMARE
61852
PROCEED
60420
PROTON
60157
QED
60157
QUAD
60157
QUASAR
60029
RADIOSHACK 60000, 60032,
60179, 60180,
60420, 60437,
60468, 61075
RCA
60032, 60053,
60179, 60305,
60420, 60468,
60764, 61062
REALISTIC
60000, 60032,
60087, 60145,
60179, 60180,
60305, 60420,
60437, 60468
REVOX
60157
ROKSAN
60435
ROTEL
60157, 60420
SAE
60157
SAMSUNG
60524
SANSUI
60000, 60157,
60305, 61760
SANYO
60000, 60087,
60179
SCOTT
60305
SEARS
60179, 60305
SHARP
60034, 60037,
60180, 60861,
61684
SHERWOOD 60180, 61067,
61950
SHURE
60043
SONIC FRONTIERS
60157
SONY
60000, 60100,
60185, 60490,
61364, 61790
SOUNDESIGN 60145
STS
60018
SUGDEN
60157
SYLVANIA
60157
SYMPHONIC 60180, 60305
TAG MCLAREN
60157
TANDY
60032
TASCAM
60420

TDK
TEAC
TECHNICS
TECHWOOD
THULE AUDIO

61208
60180, 60362,
60420, 60490
60029, 60303
60303, 60362
60157

TIVOLI AUDIO
TOSHIBA
UNIVERSUM
VICTOR
WARDS

YAMAHA

YBA
YORX

61553
61693, 61694
60437
60072
60032, 60053,
60087, 60157,
60179
60036, 60490,
60868, 60888,
61292, 62907,
62909
60625
60000

CD RECORDER
CLASSIC
71297
DENON
70626, 70766
FISHER
71325
GPX
71296
HARMAN/KARDON
71202
JVC
71294
KENWOOD
70626
LG
71208
MARANTZ
70626
NAD
71208
PHILIPS
70626
PIONEER
71062, 71087
RCA
70053, 70420
SONY
70000, 70100,
71364
TDK
71208
TEAC
70420
YAMAHA
70888, 71292

MD RECORDER
AKAI
DENON
KENWOOD
ONKYO
OPTIMUS
PANASONIC
PIONEER
SANSUI
SHARP
SHERWOOD
SONY
YAMAHA

71688
70873
70681, 70826,
71683
70868, 71685
71063
71682
71063
71760
70861, 71684
71067
70490, 71790
70490, 70888,
72909

TAPE DECK
AIWA
DENON
GARRARD
JVC
KENWOOD
NIKKO
ONKYO
OPTIMUS
PANASONIC
PIONEER

70197
70076, 70371,
70412
70308, 70309
70244, 70273
70070, 70205,
70365
70365
70135, 70282
70027
70229
70027, 70099

RCA
SHARP

70027
70205, 70371,
70412
SONY
70170, 70243,
70291
TEAC
70308, 70309,
70365
TECHNICS
70229
TECHNOVOX 70229
TECHWOOD 70365
VICTOR
70273
WARDS
70027
YAMAHA
70097, 70205,
70524

TUNER
ADC
ADCOM

80531
80616, 81616,
81617
AIWA
80121, 80158,
80189, 81243,
81321, 81347,
81388, 81405,
81641
AKAI
80224, 80346,
81255
ALCO
81390
AMC
81077
AMPLIFIER TECHNOLOGIES
81584
ANAM
81074, 81609
APEX DIGITAL
81257, 81430,
81774
ARCAM
81189
ATLANTIC TECHNOLOGY
81487
AUDIO PRO 80148
AUDIOPHASE 81387
AUDIOTRONIC
81189
AUDIOVOX
81390, 81627
B&K
80701, 80702,
80820, 80840
BEL CANTO DESIGN
81584
BK
80702
BOSE
80639, 81229,
81253, 81933
BRIX
81602
CAIRN
80189
CAMBRIDGE SOUNDWORKS
81477
CAPETRONIC 80531
CARVER
80008, 80121,
80189, 80360,
81189, 81289
CASIO
80195
CLARINETTE 80195
CLASSE
81920
CLATRONIC 80797
COBY
81263
CURTIS
80797, 81263
CURTIS MATHES
80014, 80080
DELL
81383
DELPHI
81414, 81846
DENON
80121, 80386,
81142, 81306,
81311, 81360
ELECTROHOME
82026
EMERSON
80195, 80424,
80531

FISHER

OPTIMUS

80014, 80074,
80080, 80121,
80158, 80163,
80177, 80186,
80195, 80219,
80531, 80670,
80797, 80849,
81023, 81074
ORITRON
81366, 81497
OUTLAW
80391, 81487
PANASONIC 80039, 80309,
80367, 81275,
81288, 81308,
81316, 81350,
81363, 81509,
81518, 81548,
81633, 81675,
81763, 81764,
82967
PENNEY
80039, 80195
PHILIPS
80189, 80391,
80891, 81189,
81266, 81268,
81269, 81283,
81365, 81368
PIONEER
80014, 80080,
80150, 80281,
80346, 80531,
80630, 81023,
81123, 81284,
81343, 81384,
81678, 81823,
81935, 81986
POLK AUDIO 80189, 81289,
81414
PROCEED
81922
PROSCAN
81254
QUASAR
80039
RADIOSHACK 81263, 81609
RCA
80080, 80346,
80360, 80530,
80531, 81023,
81074, 81123,
81254, 81390,
81511, 81609
REALISTIC
80121, 80158,
80163, 80177,
80186, 80195,
81609
REVOX
80189
RIO
81383, 81869
SAMSUNG
81295, 81304,
81500
SANGEAN
82165
SANSUI
80148, 80189,
80346, 81092,
81189, 81764
SANYO
80219, 80360,
81251, 81801
SCOTT
80163, 80322
SEARS
80195, 80424
SHARP
80186, 80262,
81286, 81361,
81386
SHARPER IMAGE
80797, 81263,
81385, 81409,
81410, 81411,
81416
SHERWOOD 81077, 81423,
81567
SIRIUS
81602, 81627,
81770, 81811,
81987
SONIC
80281

SONIC BLUE 81383, 81869
SONY
80158, 80168,
81058, 81131,
81258, 81367,
81371, 81382,
81406, 81441,
81458, 81503,
81529, 81558,
81622, 81658,
81758, 81759,
81858
SOUNDESIGN 80670
STEREOPHONICS
81023
SUNFIRE
81313
SYLVANIA
80797
TEAC
80163, 80463,
81074, 81267,
81390, 81528
TECHNICS
80039, 80208,
80309, 81308,
81384, 81518,
81633, 81675
TECHWOOD 80281
THORENS
81189
TOSHIBA
80080, 80135,
80842, 81123,
81788
VENTURER 80849, 81390
VICTOR
80074
WARDS
80014, 80080,
80158, 80189
XM
81406, 81414,
81846
YAMAHA
80176, 80186,
80376, 81023,
81176, 81276,
81331, 81375,
81476, 81815,
81949, 82176,
82177, 82178,
82179, 82908,
82915, 82918,
82919
YBA
81921
YORX
80195
ZENITH
80281, 80346,
80857

OTHER AUDIO
ACCESSORIES
YAMAHA
(iPod)

82981, 82982,
82983

APPENDIX

80008, 80219,
80360, 80797,
81409, 81801
FOSGATE
81487
GARRARD
80281, 80424,
80463
GATEWAY
81567
GLORY HORSE
81263
GOLDSTAR
80281
GOODMANS 80797
GPX
81299
GRUNDIG
80189, 80281,
81387
HARMAN/KARDON
80110, 80189,
80891, 81289,
81304, 81306
HITACHI
80386, 81273,
81801
INSIGNIA
81030, 81077
INTEGRA
80135, 80842,
81298, 81320,
81805
JBL
80110, 81306
JVC
80074, 80262,
80464, 81058,
81263, 81282,
81374, 81495,
81643, 81665,
81811
KAWASAKI
81390
KENWOOD
80027, 80077,
80186, 80262,
81313, 81363,
81569, 81570,
81770
KLH
81390, 81428
KOSS
80424, 81366,
81497
LEXICON
81076
LG
80281
LINN
80189
LIQUID VIDEO
81497
LLOYD'S
80195
MAGNAVOX 80128, 80189,
80195, 80391,
80531, 81189,
81266, 81269,
81514
MARANTZ
80039, 80128,
80189, 80200,
80891, 81189,
81269, 81289,
81671
MCINTOSH
81289
MCS
80039, 80346
MICROMEGA 80189, 81189
MITSUBISHI 81393, 81920,
81921, 81922,
81957
MODULAIRE 80195
MYRYAD
81189
NAD
80320
NAKAMICHI 80097, 80347,
81092, 81313,
81555
NEC
80235
NIKKO
80322
NIKKODO
80322
ONKYO
80135, 80380,
80842, 81298,
81320, 81677,
81805

xii

HTR-6180_U-cv.fm Page 1 Monday, December 10, 2007 1:32 PM

U

HTR-6180

HTR-6180
AV Receiver

© 2008
YAMAHA ELECTRONICS CORPORATION, USA 6660 ORANGETHORPE AVE., BUENA PARK, CALIF. 90620, U.S.A.
YAMAHA CANADA MUSIC LTD. 135 MILNER AVE., SCARBOROUGH, ONTARIO M1S 3R1, CANADA
YAMAHA ELECTRONIK EUROPA G.m.b.H. SIEMENSSTR. 22-34, 25462 RELLINGEN BEI HAMBURG, GERMANY
YAMAHA ELECTRONIQUE FRANCE S.A. RUE AMBROISE CROIZAT BP70 CROISSY-BEAUBOURG 77312 MARNE-LA-VALLEE CEDEX02, FRANCE
YAMAHA ELECTRONICS (UK) LTD. YAMAHA HOUSE, 200 RICKMANSWORTH ROAD WATFORD, HERTS WD18 7GQ, ENGLAND
YAMAHA SCANDINAVIA A.B. J A WETTERGRENS GATA 1, BOX 30053, 400 43 VÄSTRA FRÖLUNDA, SWEDEN
YAMAHA MUSIC AUSTRALIA PTY, LTD. 17-33 MARKET ST., SOUTH MELBOURNE, 3205 VIC., AUSTRALIA

Black process 45.0° 240.0 LPI

All rights reserved.

OWNER’S MANUAL
Printed in Malaysia

WN24840

00_sheet_HTR-6180_U.book Page 1 Monday, December 10, 2007 1:27 PM

U

HTR-6180
The circled numbers and alphabets correspond to those in the Owner’s Manual.

■ Front panel

B

A

C

D

E

F

G

H

I

J

VOLUME

SPEAKERS

EDIT
SEARCH MODE

BAND

CATEGORY
A/B/C/D/E

PRESET/TUNING/CH

MEMORY

INFO

ZONE 2
ON/OFF

ZONE
CONTROL

SCENE

1

2

3

4

PROGRAM

MAIN ZONE
SYSTEM OFF

PHONES

INPUT

TONE CONTROL

STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

AUDIO SELECT

VIDEO AUX

OPTIMIZER MIC

ON/OFF

SILENT CINEMA

K

Black process 45.0° 240.0 LPI

L

EFFECT

M

N

O

S VIDEO

P

Q

R

S

VIDEO

L

AUDIO

R

OPTICAL

00_sheet_HTR-6180_U.book Page i Monday, December 10, 2007 1:27 PM

■ Remote control

1
2
3

4

B
CODE SET

TRANSMIT

POWER

POWER

TV

AV

TUNER

XM

C
POWER

STANDBY

D
SIRIUS

A

DOCK

CBL

V-AUX

DTV

CD

CD-R

DVD

DVR

VCR

PHONO

MD

AMP

SOURCE

5

TV VOL

TV CH

VOLUME

E
F

K

TV

TV MUTE

PROG
PROG

6

1

2

STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

5

6

MULTI CH IN

AUDIO SEL

9

0

ENHANCER

SUR. DECODE

3

4
PARAMETER

7

PRESET/CH

7

TITLE

MENU

BAND

SRCH MODE

8
9

ENT

SET MENU

LEVEL

1

2

ENHANCER

SUR. DECODE

3

4

STRAIGHT

PURE DIRECT

5

6

MULTI CH IN

AUDIO SEL

9

0

PARAMETER

7

8

8
SLEEP

10

M

G

MUTE

TV INPUT

L

H
I

N O

P

Q

R

ENTER
A-E/CAT.
RETURN

DISPLAY

J

MEMORY
INFO

PRG SELECT

0
REC

SCENE

A

1

2

3

4

Printed in Malaysia

Black process 45.0° 240.0 LPI

WN67520



Source Exif Data:
File Type                       : PDF
File Type Extension             : pdf
MIME Type                       : application/pdf
PDF Version                     : 1.6
Linearized                      : Yes
Encryption                      : Standard V2.3 (128-bit)
User Access                     : Print, Extract, Print high-res
Page Mode                       : UseOutlines
XMP Toolkit                     : Adobe XMP Core 4.0-c316 44.253921, Sun Oct 01 2006 17:14:39
Producer                        : Acrobat Distiller 5.0.5 (Windows)
Create Date                     : 2008:01:24 14:56:46Z
Modify Date                     : 2008:02:04 15:51:23+09:00
Metadata Date                   : 2008:02:04 15:51:23+09:00
Creator Tool                    : FrameMaker 6.0
Format                          : application/pdf
Creator                         : 
Title                           : 
Document ID                     : uuid:823312d0-6105-4e4c-a5e6-45625732c5e0
Instance ID                     : uuid:2e28ebc4-6d21-4ea9-9717-21e3daf3791a
Has XFA                         : No
Page Count                      : 152
Author                          : 
EXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools

Navigation menu